Automatic date update in version.in
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf.c
1 /* ELF executable support for BFD.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1993-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
19 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
20 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23 /*
24 SECTION
25 ELF backends
26
27 BFD support for ELF formats is being worked on.
28 Currently, the best supported back ends are for sparc and i386
29 (running svr4 or Solaris 2).
30
31 Documentation of the internals of the support code still needs
32 to be written. The code is changing quickly enough that we
33 haven't bothered yet. */
34
35 /* For sparc64-cross-sparc32. */
36 #define _SYSCALL32
37 #include "sysdep.h"
38 #include <limits.h>
39 #include "bfd.h"
40 #include "bfdlink.h"
41 #include "libbfd.h"
42 #define ARCH_SIZE 0
43 #include "elf-bfd.h"
44 #include "libiberty.h"
45 #include "safe-ctype.h"
46 #include "elf-linux-core.h"
47
48 #ifdef CORE_HEADER
49 #include CORE_HEADER
50 #endif
51
52 static int elf_sort_sections (const void *, const void *);
53 static bfd_boolean assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *);
54 static bfd_boolean swap_out_syms (bfd *, struct elf_strtab_hash **, int) ;
55 static bfd_boolean elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size,
56 file_ptr offset, size_t align);
57
58 /* Swap version information in and out. The version information is
59 currently size independent. If that ever changes, this code will
60 need to move into elfcode.h. */
61
62 /* Swap in a Verdef structure. */
63
64 void
65 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (bfd *abfd,
66 const Elf_External_Verdef *src,
67 Elf_Internal_Verdef *dst)
68 {
69 dst->vd_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_version);
70 dst->vd_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags);
71 dst->vd_ndx = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx);
72 dst->vd_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt);
73 dst->vd_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash);
74 dst->vd_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux);
75 dst->vd_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vd_next);
76 }
77
78 /* Swap out a Verdef structure. */
79
80 void
81 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_out (bfd *abfd,
82 const Elf_Internal_Verdef *src,
83 Elf_External_Verdef *dst)
84 {
85 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_version, dst->vd_version);
86 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_flags, dst->vd_flags);
87 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_ndx, dst->vd_ndx);
88 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vd_cnt, dst->vd_cnt);
89 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_hash, dst->vd_hash);
90 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_aux, dst->vd_aux);
91 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vd_next, dst->vd_next);
92 }
93
94 /* Swap in a Verdaux structure. */
95
96 void
97 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (bfd *abfd,
98 const Elf_External_Verdaux *src,
99 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *dst)
100 {
101 dst->vda_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_name);
102 dst->vda_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vda_next);
103 }
104
105 /* Swap out a Verdaux structure. */
106
107 void
108 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_out (bfd *abfd,
109 const Elf_Internal_Verdaux *src,
110 Elf_External_Verdaux *dst)
111 {
112 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_name, dst->vda_name);
113 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vda_next, dst->vda_next);
114 }
115
116 /* Swap in a Verneed structure. */
117
118 void
119 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (bfd *abfd,
120 const Elf_External_Verneed *src,
121 Elf_Internal_Verneed *dst)
122 {
123 dst->vn_version = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_version);
124 dst->vn_cnt = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt);
125 dst->vn_file = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_file);
126 dst->vn_aux = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux);
127 dst->vn_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vn_next);
128 }
129
130 /* Swap out a Verneed structure. */
131
132 void
133 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_out (bfd *abfd,
134 const Elf_Internal_Verneed *src,
135 Elf_External_Verneed *dst)
136 {
137 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_version, dst->vn_version);
138 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vn_cnt, dst->vn_cnt);
139 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_file, dst->vn_file);
140 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_aux, dst->vn_aux);
141 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vn_next, dst->vn_next);
142 }
143
144 /* Swap in a Vernaux structure. */
145
146 void
147 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (bfd *abfd,
148 const Elf_External_Vernaux *src,
149 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *dst)
150 {
151 dst->vna_hash = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash);
152 dst->vna_flags = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags);
153 dst->vna_other = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vna_other);
154 dst->vna_name = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_name);
155 dst->vna_next = H_GET_32 (abfd, src->vna_next);
156 }
157
158 /* Swap out a Vernaux structure. */
159
160 void
161 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_out (bfd *abfd,
162 const Elf_Internal_Vernaux *src,
163 Elf_External_Vernaux *dst)
164 {
165 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_hash, dst->vna_hash);
166 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_flags, dst->vna_flags);
167 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vna_other, dst->vna_other);
168 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_name, dst->vna_name);
169 H_PUT_32 (abfd, src->vna_next, dst->vna_next);
170 }
171
172 /* Swap in a Versym structure. */
173
174 void
175 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_in (bfd *abfd,
176 const Elf_External_Versym *src,
177 Elf_Internal_Versym *dst)
178 {
179 dst->vs_vers = H_GET_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers);
180 }
181
182 /* Swap out a Versym structure. */
183
184 void
185 _bfd_elf_swap_versym_out (bfd *abfd,
186 const Elf_Internal_Versym *src,
187 Elf_External_Versym *dst)
188 {
189 H_PUT_16 (abfd, src->vs_vers, dst->vs_vers);
190 }
191
192 /* Standard ELF hash function. Do not change this function; you will
193 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
194
195 unsigned long
196 bfd_elf_hash (const char *namearg)
197 {
198 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
199 unsigned long h = 0;
200 unsigned long g;
201 int ch;
202
203 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
204 {
205 h = (h << 4) + ch;
206 if ((g = (h & 0xf0000000)) != 0)
207 {
208 h ^= g >> 24;
209 /* The ELF ABI says `h &= ~g', but this is equivalent in
210 this case and on some machines one insn instead of two. */
211 h ^= g;
212 }
213 }
214 return h & 0xffffffff;
215 }
216
217 /* DT_GNU_HASH hash function. Do not change this function; you will
218 cause invalid hash tables to be generated. */
219
220 unsigned long
221 bfd_elf_gnu_hash (const char *namearg)
222 {
223 const unsigned char *name = (const unsigned char *) namearg;
224 unsigned long h = 5381;
225 unsigned char ch;
226
227 while ((ch = *name++) != '\0')
228 h = (h << 5) + h + ch;
229 return h & 0xffffffff;
230 }
231
232 /* Create a tdata field OBJECT_SIZE bytes in length, zeroed out and with
233 the object_id field of an elf_obj_tdata field set to OBJECT_ID. */
234 bfd_boolean
235 bfd_elf_allocate_object (bfd *abfd,
236 size_t object_size,
237 enum elf_target_id object_id)
238 {
239 BFD_ASSERT (object_size >= sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata));
240 abfd->tdata.any = bfd_zalloc (abfd, object_size);
241 if (abfd->tdata.any == NULL)
242 return FALSE;
243
244 elf_object_id (abfd) = object_id;
245 if (abfd->direction != read_direction)
246 {
247 struct output_elf_obj_tdata *o = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof *o);
248 if (o == NULL)
249 return FALSE;
250 elf_tdata (abfd)->o = o;
251 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = (bfd_size_type) -1;
252 }
253 return TRUE;
254 }
255
256
257 bfd_boolean
258 bfd_elf_make_object (bfd *abfd)
259 {
260 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
261 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct elf_obj_tdata),
262 bed->target_id);
263 }
264
265 bfd_boolean
266 bfd_elf_mkcorefile (bfd *abfd)
267 {
268 /* I think this can be done just like an object file. */
269 if (!abfd->xvec->_bfd_set_format[(int) bfd_object] (abfd))
270 return FALSE;
271 elf_tdata (abfd)->core = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*elf_tdata (abfd)->core));
272 return elf_tdata (abfd)->core != NULL;
273 }
274
275 char *
276 bfd_elf_get_str_section (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
277 {
278 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
279 bfd_byte *shstrtab = NULL;
280 file_ptr offset;
281 bfd_size_type shstrtabsize;
282
283 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
284 if (i_shdrp == 0
285 || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd)
286 || i_shdrp[shindex] == 0)
287 return NULL;
288
289 shstrtab = i_shdrp[shindex]->contents;
290 if (shstrtab == NULL)
291 {
292 /* No cached one, attempt to read, and cache what we read. */
293 offset = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_offset;
294 shstrtabsize = i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size;
295
296 /* Allocate and clear an extra byte at the end, to prevent crashes
297 in case the string table is not terminated. */
298 if (shstrtabsize + 1 <= 1
299 || bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
300 || (shstrtab = _bfd_alloc_and_read (abfd, shstrtabsize + 1,
301 shstrtabsize)) == NULL)
302 {
303 /* Once we've failed to read it, make sure we don't keep
304 trying. Otherwise, we'll keep allocating space for
305 the string table over and over. */
306 i_shdrp[shindex]->sh_size = 0;
307 }
308 else
309 shstrtab[shstrtabsize] = '\0';
310 i_shdrp[shindex]->contents = shstrtab;
311 }
312 return (char *) shstrtab;
313 }
314
315 char *
316 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (bfd *abfd,
317 unsigned int shindex,
318 unsigned int strindex)
319 {
320 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
321
322 if (strindex == 0)
323 return "";
324
325 if (elf_elfsections (abfd) == NULL || shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
326 return NULL;
327
328 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
329
330 if (hdr->contents == NULL)
331 {
332 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB && hdr->sh_type < SHT_LOOS)
333 {
334 /* PR 17512: file: f057ec89. */
335 /* xgettext:c-format */
336 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: attempt to load strings from"
337 " a non-string section (number %d)"),
338 abfd, shindex);
339 return NULL;
340 }
341
342 if (bfd_elf_get_str_section (abfd, shindex) == NULL)
343 return NULL;
344 }
345 else
346 {
347 /* PR 24273: The string section's contents may have already
348 been loaded elsewhere, eg because a corrupt file has the
349 string section index in the ELF header pointing at a group
350 section. So be paranoid, and test that the last byte of
351 the section is zero. */
352 if (hdr->sh_size == 0 || hdr->contents[hdr->sh_size - 1] != 0)
353 return NULL;
354 }
355
356 if (strindex >= hdr->sh_size)
357 {
358 unsigned int shstrndx = elf_elfheader(abfd)->e_shstrndx;
359 _bfd_error_handler
360 /* xgettext:c-format */
361 (_("%pB: invalid string offset %u >= %" PRIu64 " for section `%s'"),
362 abfd, strindex, (uint64_t) hdr->sh_size,
363 (shindex == shstrndx && strindex == hdr->sh_name
364 ? ".shstrtab"
365 : bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shstrndx, hdr->sh_name)));
366 return NULL;
367 }
368
369 return ((char *) hdr->contents) + strindex;
370 }
371
372 /* Read and convert symbols to internal format.
373 SYMCOUNT specifies the number of symbols to read, starting from
374 symbol SYMOFFSET. If any of INTSYM_BUF, EXTSYM_BUF or EXTSHNDX_BUF
375 are non-NULL, they are used to store the internal symbols, external
376 symbols, and symbol section index extensions, respectively.
377 Returns a pointer to the internal symbol buffer (malloced if necessary)
378 or NULL if there were no symbols or some kind of problem. */
379
380 Elf_Internal_Sym *
381 bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (bfd *ibfd,
382 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
383 size_t symcount,
384 size_t symoffset,
385 Elf_Internal_Sym *intsym_buf,
386 void *extsym_buf,
387 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *extshndx_buf)
388 {
389 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shndx_hdr;
390 void *alloc_ext;
391 const bfd_byte *esym;
392 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *alloc_extshndx;
393 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *shndx;
394 Elf_Internal_Sym *alloc_intsym;
395 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
396 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
397 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
398 size_t extsym_size;
399 size_t amt;
400 file_ptr pos;
401
402 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
403 abort ();
404
405 if (symcount == 0)
406 return intsym_buf;
407
408 /* Normal syms might have section extension entries. */
409 shndx_hdr = NULL;
410 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd) != NULL)
411 {
412 elf_section_list * entry;
413 Elf_Internal_Shdr **sections = elf_elfsections (ibfd);
414
415 /* Find an index section that is linked to this symtab section. */
416 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
417 {
418 /* PR 20063. */
419 if (entry->hdr.sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
420 continue;
421
422 if (sections[entry->hdr.sh_link] == symtab_hdr)
423 {
424 shndx_hdr = & entry->hdr;
425 break;
426 };
427 }
428
429 if (shndx_hdr == NULL)
430 {
431 if (symtab_hdr == & elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd))
432 /* Not really accurate, but this was how the old code used to work. */
433 shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)->hdr;
434 /* Otherwise we do nothing. The assumption is that
435 the index table will not be needed. */
436 }
437 }
438
439 /* Read the symbols. */
440 alloc_ext = NULL;
441 alloc_extshndx = NULL;
442 alloc_intsym = NULL;
443 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
444 extsym_size = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
445 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount, extsym_size, &amt))
446 {
447 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
448 intsym_buf = NULL;
449 goto out;
450 }
451 pos = symtab_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * extsym_size;
452 if (extsym_buf == NULL)
453 {
454 alloc_ext = bfd_malloc (amt);
455 extsym_buf = alloc_ext;
456 }
457 if (extsym_buf == NULL
458 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
459 || bfd_bread (extsym_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
460 {
461 intsym_buf = NULL;
462 goto out;
463 }
464
465 if (shndx_hdr == NULL || shndx_hdr->sh_size == 0)
466 extshndx_buf = NULL;
467 else
468 {
469 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount, sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx), &amt))
470 {
471 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
472 intsym_buf = NULL;
473 goto out;
474 }
475 pos = shndx_hdr->sh_offset + symoffset * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
476 if (extshndx_buf == NULL)
477 {
478 alloc_extshndx = (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx *) bfd_malloc (amt);
479 extshndx_buf = alloc_extshndx;
480 }
481 if (extshndx_buf == NULL
482 || bfd_seek (ibfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
483 || bfd_bread (extshndx_buf, amt, ibfd) != amt)
484 {
485 intsym_buf = NULL;
486 goto out;
487 }
488 }
489
490 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
491 {
492 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Sym), &amt))
493 {
494 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
495 goto out;
496 }
497 alloc_intsym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) bfd_malloc (amt);
498 intsym_buf = alloc_intsym;
499 if (intsym_buf == NULL)
500 goto out;
501 }
502
503 /* Convert the symbols to internal form. */
504 isymend = intsym_buf + symcount;
505 for (esym = (const bfd_byte *) extsym_buf, isym = intsym_buf,
506 shndx = extshndx_buf;
507 isym < isymend;
508 esym += extsym_size, isym++, shndx = shndx != NULL ? shndx + 1 : NULL)
509 if (!(*bed->s->swap_symbol_in) (ibfd, esym, shndx, isym))
510 {
511 symoffset += (esym - (bfd_byte *) extsym_buf) / extsym_size;
512 /* xgettext:c-format */
513 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB symbol number %lu references"
514 " nonexistent SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX section"),
515 ibfd, (unsigned long) symoffset);
516 if (alloc_intsym != NULL)
517 free (alloc_intsym);
518 intsym_buf = NULL;
519 goto out;
520 }
521
522 out:
523 if (alloc_ext != NULL)
524 free (alloc_ext);
525 if (alloc_extshndx != NULL)
526 free (alloc_extshndx);
527
528 return intsym_buf;
529 }
530
531 /* Look up a symbol name. */
532 const char *
533 bfd_elf_sym_name (bfd *abfd,
534 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
535 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
536 asection *sym_sec)
537 {
538 const char *name;
539 unsigned int iname = isym->st_name;
540 unsigned int shindex = symtab_hdr->sh_link;
541
542 if (iname == 0 && ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
543 /* Check for a bogus st_shndx to avoid crashing. */
544 && isym->st_shndx < elf_numsections (abfd))
545 {
546 iname = elf_elfsections (abfd)[isym->st_shndx]->sh_name;
547 shindex = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx;
548 }
549
550 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shindex, iname);
551 if (name == NULL)
552 name = "(null)";
553 else if (sym_sec && *name == '\0')
554 name = bfd_section_name (sym_sec);
555
556 return name;
557 }
558
559 /* Elf_Internal_Shdr->contents is an array of these for SHT_GROUP
560 sections. The first element is the flags, the rest are section
561 pointers. */
562
563 typedef union elf_internal_group {
564 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr;
565 unsigned int flags;
566 } Elf_Internal_Group;
567
568 /* Return the name of the group signature symbol. Why isn't the
569 signature just a string? */
570
571 static const char *
572 group_signature (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *ghdr)
573 {
574 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
575 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
576 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
577 Elf_Internal_Sym isym;
578
579 /* First we need to ensure the symbol table is available. Make sure
580 that it is a symbol table section. */
581 if (ghdr->sh_link >= elf_numsections (abfd))
582 return NULL;
583 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd) [ghdr->sh_link];
584 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
585 || ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, ghdr->sh_link))
586 return NULL;
587
588 /* Go read the symbol. */
589 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
590 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, hdr, 1, ghdr->sh_info,
591 &isym, esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
592 return NULL;
593
594 return bfd_elf_sym_name (abfd, hdr, &isym, NULL);
595 }
596
597 /* Set next_in_group list pointer, and group name for NEWSECT. */
598
599 static bfd_boolean
600 setup_group (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *newsect)
601 {
602 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
603
604 /* If num_group is zero, read in all SHT_GROUP sections. The count
605 is set to -1 if there are no SHT_GROUP sections. */
606 if (num_group == 0)
607 {
608 unsigned int i, shnum;
609
610 /* First count the number of groups. If we have a SHT_GROUP
611 section with just a flag word (ie. sh_size is 4), ignore it. */
612 shnum = elf_numsections (abfd);
613 num_group = 0;
614
615 #define IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER(shdr, minsize) \
616 ( (shdr)->sh_type == SHT_GROUP \
617 && (shdr)->sh_size >= minsize \
618 && (shdr)->sh_entsize == GRP_ENTRY_SIZE \
619 && ((shdr)->sh_size % GRP_ENTRY_SIZE) == 0)
620
621 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
622 {
623 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
624
625 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
626 num_group += 1;
627 }
628
629 if (num_group == 0)
630 {
631 num_group = (unsigned) -1;
632 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
633 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
634 }
635 else
636 {
637 /* We keep a list of elf section headers for group sections,
638 so we can find them quickly. */
639 size_t amt;
640
641 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
642 amt = num_group * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *);
643 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr
644 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
645 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr == NULL)
646 return FALSE;
647 num_group = 0;
648
649 for (i = 0; i < shnum; i++)
650 {
651 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
652
653 if (IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (shdr, 2 * GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
654 {
655 unsigned char *src;
656 Elf_Internal_Group *dest;
657
658 /* Make sure the group section has a BFD section
659 attached to it. */
660 if (!bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
661 return FALSE;
662
663 /* Add to list of sections. */
664 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[num_group] = shdr;
665 num_group += 1;
666
667 /* Read the raw contents. */
668 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (*dest) >= 4 && sizeof (*dest) % 4 == 0);
669 shdr->contents = NULL;
670 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (shdr->sh_size,
671 sizeof (*dest) / 4, &amt)
672 || bfd_seek (abfd, shdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
673 || !(shdr->contents
674 = _bfd_alloc_and_read (abfd, amt, shdr->sh_size)))
675 {
676 _bfd_error_handler
677 /* xgettext:c-format */
678 (_("%pB: invalid size field in group section"
679 " header: %#" PRIx64 ""),
680 abfd, (uint64_t) shdr->sh_size);
681 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
682 -- num_group;
683 continue;
684 }
685
686 /* Translate raw contents, a flag word followed by an
687 array of elf section indices all in target byte order,
688 to the flag word followed by an array of elf section
689 pointers. */
690 src = shdr->contents + shdr->sh_size;
691 dest = (Elf_Internal_Group *) (shdr->contents + amt);
692
693 while (1)
694 {
695 unsigned int idx;
696
697 src -= 4;
698 --dest;
699 idx = H_GET_32 (abfd, src);
700 if (src == shdr->contents)
701 {
702 dest->shdr = NULL;
703 dest->flags = idx;
704 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL && (idx & GRP_COMDAT))
705 shdr->bfd_section->flags
706 |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
707 break;
708 }
709 if (idx < shnum)
710 {
711 dest->shdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[idx];
712 /* PR binutils/23199: All sections in a
713 section group should be marked with
714 SHF_GROUP. But some tools generate
715 broken objects without SHF_GROUP. Fix
716 them up here. */
717 dest->shdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
718 }
719 if (idx >= shnum
720 || dest->shdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
721 {
722 _bfd_error_handler
723 (_("%pB: invalid entry in SHT_GROUP section [%u]"),
724 abfd, i);
725 dest->shdr = NULL;
726 }
727 }
728 }
729 }
730
731 /* PR 17510: Corrupt binaries might contain invalid groups. */
732 if (num_group != (unsigned) elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group)
733 {
734 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group;
735
736 /* If all groups are invalid then fail. */
737 if (num_group == 0)
738 {
739 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr = NULL;
740 elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group = num_group = -1;
741 _bfd_error_handler
742 (_("%pB: no valid group sections found"), abfd);
743 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
744 }
745 }
746 }
747 }
748
749 if (num_group != (unsigned) -1)
750 {
751 unsigned int search_offset = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset;
752 unsigned int j;
753
754 for (j = 0; j < num_group; j++)
755 {
756 /* Begin search from previous found group. */
757 unsigned i = (j + search_offset) % num_group;
758
759 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
760 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
761 bfd_size_type n_elt;
762
763 if (shdr == NULL)
764 continue;
765
766 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
767 if (idx == NULL || shdr->sh_size < 4)
768 {
769 /* See PR 21957 for a reproducer. */
770 /* xgettext:c-format */
771 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: group section '%pA' has no contents"),
772 abfd, shdr->bfd_section);
773 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i] = NULL;
774 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
775 return FALSE;
776 }
777 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
778
779 /* Look through this group's sections to see if current
780 section is a member. */
781 while (--n_elt != 0)
782 if ((++idx)->shdr == hdr)
783 {
784 asection *s = NULL;
785
786 /* We are a member of this group. Go looking through
787 other members to see if any others are linked via
788 next_in_group. */
789 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
790 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
791 while (--n_elt != 0)
792 if ((++idx)->shdr != NULL
793 && (s = idx->shdr->bfd_section) != NULL
794 && elf_next_in_group (s) != NULL)
795 break;
796 if (n_elt != 0)
797 {
798 /* Snarf the group name from other member, and
799 insert current section in circular list. */
800 elf_group_name (newsect) = elf_group_name (s);
801 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = elf_next_in_group (s);
802 elf_next_in_group (s) = newsect;
803 }
804 else
805 {
806 const char *gname;
807
808 gname = group_signature (abfd, shdr);
809 if (gname == NULL)
810 return FALSE;
811 elf_group_name (newsect) = gname;
812
813 /* Start a circular list with one element. */
814 elf_next_in_group (newsect) = newsect;
815 }
816
817 /* If the group section has been created, point to the
818 new member. */
819 if (shdr->bfd_section != NULL)
820 elf_next_in_group (shdr->bfd_section) = newsect;
821
822 elf_tdata (abfd)->group_search_offset = i;
823 j = num_group - 1;
824 break;
825 }
826 }
827 }
828
829 if (elf_group_name (newsect) == NULL)
830 {
831 /* xgettext:c-format */
832 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: no group info for section '%pA'"),
833 abfd, newsect);
834 return FALSE;
835 }
836 return TRUE;
837 }
838
839 bfd_boolean
840 _bfd_elf_setup_sections (bfd *abfd)
841 {
842 unsigned int i;
843 unsigned int num_group = elf_tdata (abfd)->num_group;
844 bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
845 asection *s;
846
847 /* Process SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
848 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
849 {
850 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr = &elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr;
851 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
852 {
853 unsigned int elfsec = this_hdr->sh_link;
854 /* FIXME: The old Intel compiler and old strip/objcopy may
855 not set the sh_link or sh_info fields. Hence we could
856 get the situation where elfsec is 0. */
857 if (elfsec == 0)
858 {
859 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
860 bed->link_order_error_handler
861 /* xgettext:c-format */
862 (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
863 abfd, s);
864 }
865 else
866 {
867 asection *linksec = NULL;
868
869 if (elfsec < elf_numsections (abfd))
870 {
871 this_hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec];
872 linksec = this_hdr->bfd_section;
873 }
874
875 /* PR 1991, 2008:
876 Some strip/objcopy may leave an incorrect value in
877 sh_link. We don't want to proceed. */
878 if (linksec == NULL)
879 {
880 _bfd_error_handler
881 /* xgettext:c-format */
882 (_("%pB: sh_link [%d] in section `%pA' is incorrect"),
883 s->owner, elfsec, s);
884 result = FALSE;
885 }
886
887 elf_linked_to_section (s) = linksec;
888 }
889 }
890 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP
891 && elf_next_in_group (s) == NULL)
892 {
893 _bfd_error_handler
894 /* xgettext:c-format */
895 (_("%pB: SHT_GROUP section [index %d] has no SHF_GROUP sections"),
896 abfd, elf_section_data (s)->this_idx);
897 result = FALSE;
898 }
899 }
900
901 /* Process section groups. */
902 if (num_group == (unsigned) -1)
903 return result;
904
905 for (i = 0; i < num_group; i++)
906 {
907 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->group_sect_ptr[i];
908 Elf_Internal_Group *idx;
909 unsigned int n_elt;
910
911 /* PR binutils/18758: Beware of corrupt binaries with invalid group data. */
912 if (shdr == NULL || shdr->bfd_section == NULL || shdr->contents == NULL)
913 {
914 _bfd_error_handler
915 /* xgettext:c-format */
916 (_("%pB: section group entry number %u is corrupt"),
917 abfd, i);
918 result = FALSE;
919 continue;
920 }
921
922 idx = (Elf_Internal_Group *) shdr->contents;
923 n_elt = shdr->sh_size / 4;
924
925 while (--n_elt != 0)
926 {
927 ++ idx;
928
929 if (idx->shdr == NULL)
930 continue;
931 else if (idx->shdr->bfd_section)
932 elf_sec_group (idx->shdr->bfd_section) = shdr->bfd_section;
933 else if (idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA
934 && idx->shdr->sh_type != SHT_REL)
935 {
936 /* There are some unknown sections in the group. */
937 _bfd_error_handler
938 /* xgettext:c-format */
939 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s' in group [%pA]"),
940 abfd,
941 idx->shdr->sh_type,
942 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd,
943 (elf_elfheader (abfd)
944 ->e_shstrndx),
945 idx->shdr->sh_name),
946 shdr->bfd_section);
947 result = FALSE;
948 }
949 }
950 }
951
952 return result;
953 }
954
955 bfd_boolean
956 bfd_elf_is_group_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
957 {
958 return elf_next_in_group (sec) != NULL;
959 }
960
961 const char *
962 bfd_elf_group_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const asection *sec)
963 {
964 if (elf_sec_group (sec) != NULL)
965 return elf_group_name (sec);
966 return NULL;
967 }
968
969 static char *
970 convert_debug_to_zdebug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
971 {
972 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
973 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 2);
974 if (new_name == NULL)
975 return NULL;
976 new_name[0] = '.';
977 new_name[1] = 'z';
978 memcpy (new_name + 2, name + 1, len);
979 return new_name;
980 }
981
982 static char *
983 convert_zdebug_to_debug (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
984 {
985 unsigned int len = strlen (name);
986 char *new_name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
987 if (new_name == NULL)
988 return NULL;
989 new_name[0] = '.';
990 memcpy (new_name + 1, name + 2, len - 1);
991 return new_name;
992 }
993
994 /* This a copy of lto_section defined in GCC (lto-streamer.h). */
995
996 struct lto_section
997 {
998 int16_t major_version;
999 int16_t minor_version;
1000 unsigned char slim_object;
1001
1002 /* Flags is a private field that is not defined publicly. */
1003 uint16_t flags;
1004 };
1005
1006 /* Make a BFD section from an ELF section. We store a pointer to the
1007 BFD section in the bfd_section field of the header. */
1008
1009 bfd_boolean
1010 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1011 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1012 const char *name,
1013 int shindex)
1014 {
1015 asection *newsect;
1016 flagword flags;
1017 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1018 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
1019
1020 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
1021 return TRUE;
1022
1023 newsect = bfd_make_section_anyway (abfd, name);
1024 if (newsect == NULL)
1025 return FALSE;
1026
1027 hdr->bfd_section = newsect;
1028 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_hdr = *hdr;
1029 elf_section_data (newsect)->this_idx = shindex;
1030
1031 /* Always use the real type/flags. */
1032 elf_section_type (newsect) = hdr->sh_type;
1033 elf_section_flags (newsect) = hdr->sh_flags;
1034
1035 newsect->filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
1036
1037 flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
1038 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1039 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
1040 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
1041 flags |= SEC_GROUP;
1042 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
1043 {
1044 flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
1045 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
1046 flags |= SEC_LOAD;
1047 }
1048 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) == 0)
1049 flags |= SEC_READONLY;
1050 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
1051 flags |= SEC_CODE;
1052 else if ((flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1053 flags |= SEC_DATA;
1054 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_MERGE) != 0)
1055 {
1056 flags |= SEC_MERGE;
1057 newsect->entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
1058 }
1059 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_STRINGS) != 0)
1060 flags |= SEC_STRINGS;
1061 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP)
1062 if (!setup_group (abfd, hdr, newsect))
1063 return FALSE;
1064 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0)
1065 flags |= SEC_THREAD_LOCAL;
1066 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE) != 0)
1067 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1068
1069 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI])
1070 {
1071 /* FIXME: We should not recognize SHF_GNU_MBIND for ELFOSABI_NONE,
1072 but binutils as of 2019-07-23 did not set the EI_OSABI header
1073 byte. */
1074 case ELFOSABI_NONE:
1075 case ELFOSABI_GNU:
1076 case ELFOSABI_FREEBSD:
1077 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0)
1078 elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi |= elf_gnu_osabi_mbind;
1079 break;
1080 }
1081
1082 if ((flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
1083 {
1084 /* The debugging sections appear to be recognized only by name,
1085 not any sort of flag. Their SEC_ALLOC bits are cleared. */
1086 if (name [0] == '.')
1087 {
1088 if (strncmp (name, ".debug", 6) == 0
1089 || strncmp (name, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.", 17) == 0
1090 || strncmp (name, ".zdebug", 7) == 0)
1091 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING | SEC_ELF_OCTETS;
1092 else if (strncmp (name, GNU_BUILD_ATTRS_SECTION_NAME, 21) == 0
1093 || strncmp (name, ".note.gnu", 9) == 0)
1094 {
1095 flags |= SEC_ELF_OCTETS;
1096 opb = 1;
1097 }
1098 else if (strncmp (name, ".line", 5) == 0
1099 || strncmp (name, ".stab", 5) == 0
1100 || strcmp (name, ".gdb_index") == 0)
1101 flags |= SEC_DEBUGGING;
1102 }
1103 }
1104
1105 if (!bfd_set_section_vma (newsect, hdr->sh_addr / opb)
1106 || !bfd_set_section_size (newsect, hdr->sh_size)
1107 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (newsect, bfd_log2 (hdr->sh_addralign)))
1108 return FALSE;
1109
1110 /* As a GNU extension, if the name begins with .gnu.linkonce, we
1111 only link a single copy of the section. This is used to support
1112 g++. g++ will emit each template expansion in its own section.
1113 The symbols will be defined as weak, so that multiple definitions
1114 are permitted. The GNU linker extension is to actually discard
1115 all but one of the sections. */
1116 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gnu.linkonce")
1117 && elf_next_in_group (newsect) == NULL)
1118 flags |= SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_DISCARD;
1119
1120 if (!bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, flags))
1121 return FALSE;
1122
1123 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1124 if (bed->elf_backend_section_flags)
1125 if (!bed->elf_backend_section_flags (hdr))
1126 return FALSE;
1127
1128 /* We do not parse the PT_NOTE segments as we are interested even in the
1129 separate debug info files which may have the segments offsets corrupted.
1130 PT_NOTEs from the core files are currently not parsed using BFD. */
1131 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOTE)
1132 {
1133 bfd_byte *contents;
1134
1135 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, newsect, &contents))
1136 return FALSE;
1137
1138 elf_parse_notes (abfd, (char *) contents, hdr->sh_size,
1139 hdr->sh_offset, hdr->sh_addralign);
1140 free (contents);
1141 }
1142
1143 if ((newsect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1144 {
1145 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr;
1146 unsigned int i, nload;
1147
1148 /* Some ELF linkers produce binaries with all the program header
1149 p_paddr fields zero. If we have such a binary with more than
1150 one PT_LOAD header, then leave the section lma equal to vma
1151 so that we don't create sections with overlapping lma. */
1152 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1153 for (nload = 0, i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1154 if (phdr->p_paddr != 0)
1155 break;
1156 else if (phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD && phdr->p_memsz != 0)
1157 ++nload;
1158 if (i >= elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum && nload > 1)
1159 return TRUE;
1160
1161 phdr = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1162 for (i = 0; i < elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum; i++, phdr++)
1163 {
1164 if (((phdr->p_type == PT_LOAD
1165 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
1166 || phdr->p_type == PT_TLS)
1167 && ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (hdr, phdr))
1168 {
1169 if ((newsect->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
1170 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1171 + hdr->sh_addr - phdr->p_vaddr) / opb;
1172 else
1173 /* We used to use the same adjustment for SEC_LOAD
1174 sections, but that doesn't work if the segment
1175 is packed with code from multiple VMAs.
1176 Instead we calculate the section LMA based on
1177 the segment LMA. It is assumed that the
1178 segment will contain sections with contiguous
1179 LMAs, even if the VMAs are not. */
1180 newsect->lma = (phdr->p_paddr
1181 + hdr->sh_offset - phdr->p_offset) / opb;
1182
1183 /* With contiguous segments, we can't tell from file
1184 offsets whether a section with zero size should
1185 be placed at the end of one segment or the
1186 beginning of the next. Decide based on vaddr. */
1187 if (hdr->sh_addr >= phdr->p_vaddr
1188 && (hdr->sh_addr + hdr->sh_size
1189 <= phdr->p_vaddr + phdr->p_memsz))
1190 break;
1191 }
1192 }
1193 }
1194
1195 /* Compress/decompress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_* and
1196 .zdebug_*, after the section flags is set. */
1197 if ((newsect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
1198 && ((name[1] == 'd' && name[6] == '_')
1199 || (name[1] == 'z' && name[7] == '_')))
1200 {
1201 enum { nothing, compress, decompress } action = nothing;
1202 int compression_header_size;
1203 bfd_size_type uncompressed_size;
1204 unsigned int uncompressed_align_power;
1205 bfd_boolean compressed
1206 = bfd_is_section_compressed_with_header (abfd, newsect,
1207 &compression_header_size,
1208 &uncompressed_size,
1209 &uncompressed_align_power);
1210 if (compressed)
1211 {
1212 /* Compressed section. Check if we should decompress. */
1213 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS))
1214 action = decompress;
1215 }
1216
1217 /* Compress the uncompressed section or convert from/to .zdebug*
1218 section. Check if we should compress. */
1219 if (action == nothing)
1220 {
1221 if (newsect->size != 0
1222 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS)
1223 && compression_header_size >= 0
1224 && uncompressed_size > 0
1225 && (!compressed
1226 || ((compression_header_size > 0)
1227 != ((abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0))))
1228 action = compress;
1229 else
1230 return TRUE;
1231 }
1232
1233 if (action == compress)
1234 {
1235 if (!bfd_init_section_compress_status (abfd, newsect))
1236 {
1237 _bfd_error_handler
1238 /* xgettext:c-format */
1239 (_("%pB: unable to initialize compress status for section %s"),
1240 abfd, name);
1241 return FALSE;
1242 }
1243 }
1244 else
1245 {
1246 if (!bfd_init_section_decompress_status (abfd, newsect))
1247 {
1248 _bfd_error_handler
1249 /* xgettext:c-format */
1250 (_("%pB: unable to initialize decompress status for section %s"),
1251 abfd, name);
1252 return FALSE;
1253 }
1254 }
1255
1256 if (abfd->is_linker_input)
1257 {
1258 if (name[1] == 'z'
1259 && (action == decompress
1260 || (action == compress
1261 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) != 0)))
1262 {
1263 /* Convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* so
1264 that linker will consider this section as a debug
1265 section. */
1266 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
1267 if (new_name == NULL)
1268 return FALSE;
1269 bfd_rename_section (newsect, new_name);
1270 }
1271 }
1272 else
1273 /* For objdump, don't rename the section. For objcopy, delay
1274 section rename to elf_fake_sections. */
1275 newsect->flags |= SEC_ELF_RENAME;
1276 }
1277
1278 /* GCC uses .gnu.lto_.lto.<some_hash> as a LTO bytecode information
1279 section. */
1280 const char *lto_section_name = ".gnu.lto_.lto.";
1281 if (strncmp (name, lto_section_name, strlen (lto_section_name)) == 0)
1282 {
1283 struct lto_section lsection;
1284 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, newsect, &lsection, 0,
1285 sizeof (struct lto_section)))
1286 abfd->lto_slim_object = lsection.slim_object;
1287 }
1288
1289 return TRUE;
1290 }
1291
1292 const char *const bfd_elf_section_type_names[] =
1293 {
1294 "SHT_NULL", "SHT_PROGBITS", "SHT_SYMTAB", "SHT_STRTAB",
1295 "SHT_RELA", "SHT_HASH", "SHT_DYNAMIC", "SHT_NOTE",
1296 "SHT_NOBITS", "SHT_REL", "SHT_SHLIB", "SHT_DYNSYM",
1297 };
1298
1299 /* ELF relocs are against symbols. If we are producing relocatable
1300 output, and the reloc is against an external symbol, and nothing
1301 has given us any additional addend, the resulting reloc will also
1302 be against the same symbol. In such a case, we don't want to
1303 change anything about the way the reloc is handled, since it will
1304 all be done at final link time. Rather than put special case code
1305 into bfd_perform_relocation, all the reloc types use this howto
1306 function. It just short circuits the reloc if producing
1307 relocatable output against an external symbol. */
1308
1309 bfd_reloc_status_type
1310 bfd_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1311 arelent *reloc_entry,
1312 asymbol *symbol,
1313 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1314 asection *input_section,
1315 bfd *output_bfd,
1316 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1317 {
1318 if (output_bfd != NULL
1319 && (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
1320 && (! reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace
1321 || reloc_entry->addend == 0))
1322 {
1323 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
1324 return bfd_reloc_ok;
1325 }
1326
1327 return bfd_reloc_continue;
1328 }
1329 \f
1330 /* Returns TRUE if section A matches section B.
1331 Names, addresses and links may be different, but everything else
1332 should be the same. */
1333
1334 static bfd_boolean
1335 section_match (const Elf_Internal_Shdr * a,
1336 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * b)
1337 {
1338 if (a->sh_type != b->sh_type
1339 || ((a->sh_flags ^ b->sh_flags) & ~SHF_INFO_LINK) != 0
1340 || a->sh_addralign != b->sh_addralign
1341 || a->sh_entsize != b->sh_entsize)
1342 return FALSE;
1343 if (a->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
1344 || a->sh_type == SHT_STRTAB)
1345 return TRUE;
1346 return a->sh_size == b->sh_size;
1347 }
1348
1349 /* Find a section in OBFD that has the same characteristics
1350 as IHEADER. Return the index of this section or SHN_UNDEF if
1351 none can be found. Check's section HINT first, as this is likely
1352 to be the correct section. */
1353
1354 static unsigned int
1355 find_link (const bfd *obfd, const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1356 const unsigned int hint)
1357 {
1358 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1359 unsigned int i;
1360
1361 BFD_ASSERT (iheader != NULL);
1362
1363 /* See PR 20922 for a reproducer of the NULL test. */
1364 if (hint < elf_numsections (obfd)
1365 && oheaders[hint] != NULL
1366 && section_match (oheaders[hint], iheader))
1367 return hint;
1368
1369 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1370 {
1371 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1372
1373 if (oheader == NULL)
1374 continue;
1375 if (section_match (oheader, iheader))
1376 /* FIXME: Do we care if there is a potential for
1377 multiple matches ? */
1378 return i;
1379 }
1380
1381 return SHN_UNDEF;
1382 }
1383
1384 /* PR 19938: Attempt to set the ELF section header fields of an OS or
1385 Processor specific section, based upon a matching input section.
1386 Returns TRUE upon success, FALSE otherwise. */
1387
1388 static bfd_boolean
1389 copy_special_section_fields (const bfd *ibfd,
1390 bfd *obfd,
1391 const Elf_Internal_Shdr *iheader,
1392 Elf_Internal_Shdr *oheader,
1393 const unsigned int secnum)
1394 {
1395 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1396 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1397 bfd_boolean changed = FALSE;
1398 unsigned int sh_link;
1399
1400 if (oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS)
1401 {
1402 /* This is a feature for objcopy --only-keep-debug:
1403 When a section's type is changed to NOBITS, we preserve
1404 the sh_link and sh_info fields so that they can be
1405 matched up with the original.
1406
1407 Note: Strictly speaking these assignments are wrong.
1408 The sh_link and sh_info fields should point to the
1409 relevent sections in the output BFD, which may not be in
1410 the same location as they were in the input BFD. But
1411 the whole point of this action is to preserve the
1412 original values of the sh_link and sh_info fields, so
1413 that they can be matched up with the section headers in
1414 the original file. So strictly speaking we may be
1415 creating an invalid ELF file, but it is only for a file
1416 that just contains debug info and only for sections
1417 without any contents. */
1418 if (oheader->sh_link == 0)
1419 oheader->sh_link = iheader->sh_link;
1420 if (oheader->sh_info == 0)
1421 oheader->sh_info = iheader->sh_info;
1422 return TRUE;
1423 }
1424
1425 /* Allow the target a chance to decide how these fields should be set. */
1426 if (bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd,
1427 iheader, oheader))
1428 return TRUE;
1429
1430 /* We have an iheader which might match oheader, and which has non-zero
1431 sh_info and/or sh_link fields. Attempt to follow those links and find
1432 the section in the output bfd which corresponds to the linked section
1433 in the input bfd. */
1434 if (iheader->sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1435 {
1436 /* See PR 20931 for a reproducer. */
1437 if (iheader->sh_link >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
1438 {
1439 _bfd_error_handler
1440 /* xgettext:c-format */
1441 (_("%pB: invalid sh_link field (%d) in section number %d"),
1442 ibfd, iheader->sh_link, secnum);
1443 return FALSE;
1444 }
1445
1446 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_link], iheader->sh_link);
1447 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1448 {
1449 oheader->sh_link = sh_link;
1450 changed = TRUE;
1451 }
1452 else
1453 /* FIXME: Should we install iheader->sh_link
1454 if we could not find a match ? */
1455 _bfd_error_handler
1456 /* xgettext:c-format */
1457 (_("%pB: failed to find link section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1458 }
1459
1460 if (iheader->sh_info)
1461 {
1462 /* The sh_info field can hold arbitrary information, but if the
1463 SHF_LINK_INFO flag is set then it should be interpreted as a
1464 section index. */
1465 if (iheader->sh_flags & SHF_INFO_LINK)
1466 {
1467 sh_link = find_link (obfd, iheaders[iheader->sh_info],
1468 iheader->sh_info);
1469 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1470 oheader->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
1471 }
1472 else
1473 /* No idea what it means - just copy it. */
1474 sh_link = iheader->sh_info;
1475
1476 if (sh_link != SHN_UNDEF)
1477 {
1478 oheader->sh_info = sh_link;
1479 changed = TRUE;
1480 }
1481 else
1482 _bfd_error_handler
1483 /* xgettext:c-format */
1484 (_("%pB: failed to find info section for section %d"), obfd, secnum);
1485 }
1486
1487 return changed;
1488 }
1489
1490 /* Copy the program header and other data from one object module to
1491 another. */
1492
1493 bfd_boolean
1494 _bfd_elf_copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
1495 {
1496 const Elf_Internal_Shdr **iheaders = (const Elf_Internal_Shdr **) elf_elfsections (ibfd);
1497 Elf_Internal_Shdr **oheaders = elf_elfsections (obfd);
1498 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1499 unsigned int i;
1500
1501 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
1502 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
1503 return TRUE;
1504
1505 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
1506 {
1507 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
1508 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
1509 }
1510
1511 elf_gp (obfd) = elf_gp (ibfd);
1512
1513 /* Also copy the EI_OSABI field. */
1514 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI] =
1515 elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_OSABI];
1516
1517 /* If set, copy the EI_ABIVERSION field. */
1518 if (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION])
1519 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION]
1520 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION];
1521
1522 /* Copy object attributes. */
1523 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
1524
1525 if (iheaders == NULL || oheaders == NULL)
1526 return TRUE;
1527
1528 bed = get_elf_backend_data (obfd);
1529
1530 /* Possibly copy other fields in the section header. */
1531 for (i = 1; i < elf_numsections (obfd); i++)
1532 {
1533 unsigned int j;
1534 Elf_Internal_Shdr * oheader = oheaders[i];
1535
1536 /* Ignore ordinary sections. SHT_NOBITS sections are considered however
1537 because of a special case need for generating separate debug info
1538 files. See below for more details. */
1539 if (oheader == NULL
1540 || (oheader->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
1541 && oheader->sh_type < SHT_LOOS))
1542 continue;
1543
1544 /* Ignore empty sections, and sections whose
1545 fields have already been initialised. */
1546 if (oheader->sh_size == 0
1547 || (oheader->sh_info != 0 && oheader->sh_link != 0))
1548 continue;
1549
1550 /* Scan for the matching section in the input bfd.
1551 First we try for a direct mapping between the input and output sections. */
1552 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1553 {
1554 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1555
1556 if (iheader == NULL)
1557 continue;
1558
1559 if (oheader->bfd_section != NULL
1560 && iheader->bfd_section != NULL
1561 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section != NULL
1562 && iheader->bfd_section->output_section == oheader->bfd_section)
1563 {
1564 /* We have found a connection from the input section to the
1565 output section. Attempt to copy the header fields. If
1566 this fails then do not try any further sections - there
1567 should only be a one-to-one mapping between input and output. */
1568 if (! copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1569 j = elf_numsections (ibfd);
1570 break;
1571 }
1572 }
1573
1574 if (j < elf_numsections (ibfd))
1575 continue;
1576
1577 /* That failed. So try to deduce the corresponding input section.
1578 Unfortunately we cannot compare names as the output string table
1579 is empty, so instead we check size, address and type. */
1580 for (j = 1; j < elf_numsections (ibfd); j++)
1581 {
1582 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * iheader = iheaders[j];
1583
1584 if (iheader == NULL)
1585 continue;
1586
1587 /* Try matching fields in the input section's header.
1588 Since --only-keep-debug turns all non-debug sections into
1589 SHT_NOBITS sections, the output SHT_NOBITS type matches any
1590 input type. */
1591 if ((oheader->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
1592 || iheader->sh_type == oheader->sh_type)
1593 && (iheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1594 == (oheader->sh_flags & ~ SHF_INFO_LINK)
1595 && iheader->sh_addralign == oheader->sh_addralign
1596 && iheader->sh_entsize == oheader->sh_entsize
1597 && iheader->sh_size == oheader->sh_size
1598 && iheader->sh_addr == oheader->sh_addr
1599 && (iheader->sh_info != oheader->sh_info
1600 || iheader->sh_link != oheader->sh_link))
1601 {
1602 if (copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd, iheader, oheader, i))
1603 break;
1604 }
1605 }
1606
1607 if (j == elf_numsections (ibfd) && oheader->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS)
1608 {
1609 /* Final attempt. Call the backend copy function
1610 with a NULL input section. */
1611 (void) bed->elf_backend_copy_special_section_fields (ibfd, obfd,
1612 NULL, oheader);
1613 }
1614 }
1615
1616 return TRUE;
1617 }
1618
1619 static const char *
1620 get_segment_type (unsigned int p_type)
1621 {
1622 const char *pt;
1623 switch (p_type)
1624 {
1625 case PT_NULL: pt = "NULL"; break;
1626 case PT_LOAD: pt = "LOAD"; break;
1627 case PT_DYNAMIC: pt = "DYNAMIC"; break;
1628 case PT_INTERP: pt = "INTERP"; break;
1629 case PT_NOTE: pt = "NOTE"; break;
1630 case PT_SHLIB: pt = "SHLIB"; break;
1631 case PT_PHDR: pt = "PHDR"; break;
1632 case PT_TLS: pt = "TLS"; break;
1633 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME: pt = "EH_FRAME"; break;
1634 case PT_GNU_STACK: pt = "STACK"; break;
1635 case PT_GNU_RELRO: pt = "RELRO"; break;
1636 default: pt = NULL; break;
1637 }
1638 return pt;
1639 }
1640
1641 /* Print out the program headers. */
1642
1643 bfd_boolean
1644 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *farg)
1645 {
1646 FILE *f = (FILE *) farg;
1647 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
1648 asection *s;
1649 bfd_byte *dynbuf = NULL;
1650
1651 p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
1652 if (p != NULL)
1653 {
1654 unsigned int i, c;
1655
1656 fprintf (f, _("\nProgram Header:\n"));
1657 c = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
1658 for (i = 0; i < c; i++, p++)
1659 {
1660 const char *pt = get_segment_type (p->p_type);
1661 char buf[20];
1662
1663 if (pt == NULL)
1664 {
1665 sprintf (buf, "0x%lx", p->p_type);
1666 pt = buf;
1667 }
1668 fprintf (f, "%8s off 0x", pt);
1669 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_offset);
1670 fprintf (f, " vaddr 0x");
1671 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_vaddr);
1672 fprintf (f, " paddr 0x");
1673 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_paddr);
1674 fprintf (f, " align 2**%u\n", bfd_log2 (p->p_align));
1675 fprintf (f, " filesz 0x");
1676 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_filesz);
1677 fprintf (f, " memsz 0x");
1678 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, p->p_memsz);
1679 fprintf (f, " flags %c%c%c",
1680 (p->p_flags & PF_R) != 0 ? 'r' : '-',
1681 (p->p_flags & PF_W) != 0 ? 'w' : '-',
1682 (p->p_flags & PF_X) != 0 ? 'x' : '-');
1683 if ((p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X)) != 0)
1684 fprintf (f, " %lx", p->p_flags &~ (unsigned) (PF_R | PF_W | PF_X));
1685 fprintf (f, "\n");
1686 }
1687 }
1688
1689 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1690 if (s != NULL)
1691 {
1692 unsigned int elfsec;
1693 unsigned long shlink;
1694 bfd_byte *extdyn, *extdynend;
1695 size_t extdynsize;
1696 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1697
1698 fprintf (f, _("\nDynamic Section:\n"));
1699
1700 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &dynbuf))
1701 goto error_return;
1702
1703 elfsec = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, s);
1704 if (elfsec == SHN_BAD)
1705 goto error_return;
1706 shlink = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elfsec]->sh_link;
1707
1708 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1709 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1710
1711 extdyn = dynbuf;
1712 /* PR 17512: file: 6f427532. */
1713 if (s->size < extdynsize)
1714 goto error_return;
1715 extdynend = extdyn + s->size;
1716 /* PR 17512: file: id:000006,sig:06,src:000000,op:flip4,pos:5664.
1717 Fix range check. */
1718 for (; extdyn <= (extdynend - extdynsize); extdyn += extdynsize)
1719 {
1720 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1721 const char *name = "";
1722 char ab[20];
1723 bfd_boolean stringp;
1724 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1725
1726 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1727
1728 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1729 break;
1730
1731 stringp = FALSE;
1732 switch (dyn.d_tag)
1733 {
1734 default:
1735 if (bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag)
1736 name = (*bed->elf_backend_get_target_dtag) (dyn.d_tag);
1737
1738 if (!strcmp (name, ""))
1739 {
1740 sprintf (ab, "%#" BFD_VMA_FMT "x", dyn.d_tag);
1741 name = ab;
1742 }
1743 break;
1744
1745 case DT_NEEDED: name = "NEEDED"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1746 case DT_PLTRELSZ: name = "PLTRELSZ"; break;
1747 case DT_PLTGOT: name = "PLTGOT"; break;
1748 case DT_HASH: name = "HASH"; break;
1749 case DT_STRTAB: name = "STRTAB"; break;
1750 case DT_SYMTAB: name = "SYMTAB"; break;
1751 case DT_RELA: name = "RELA"; break;
1752 case DT_RELASZ: name = "RELASZ"; break;
1753 case DT_RELAENT: name = "RELAENT"; break;
1754 case DT_STRSZ: name = "STRSZ"; break;
1755 case DT_SYMENT: name = "SYMENT"; break;
1756 case DT_INIT: name = "INIT"; break;
1757 case DT_FINI: name = "FINI"; break;
1758 case DT_SONAME: name = "SONAME"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1759 case DT_RPATH: name = "RPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1760 case DT_SYMBOLIC: name = "SYMBOLIC"; break;
1761 case DT_REL: name = "REL"; break;
1762 case DT_RELSZ: name = "RELSZ"; break;
1763 case DT_RELENT: name = "RELENT"; break;
1764 case DT_PLTREL: name = "PLTREL"; break;
1765 case DT_DEBUG: name = "DEBUG"; break;
1766 case DT_TEXTREL: name = "TEXTREL"; break;
1767 case DT_JMPREL: name = "JMPREL"; break;
1768 case DT_BIND_NOW: name = "BIND_NOW"; break;
1769 case DT_INIT_ARRAY: name = "INIT_ARRAY"; break;
1770 case DT_FINI_ARRAY: name = "FINI_ARRAY"; break;
1771 case DT_INIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "INIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1772 case DT_FINI_ARRAYSZ: name = "FINI_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1773 case DT_RUNPATH: name = "RUNPATH"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1774 case DT_FLAGS: name = "FLAGS"; break;
1775 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAY: name = "PREINIT_ARRAY"; break;
1776 case DT_PREINIT_ARRAYSZ: name = "PREINIT_ARRAYSZ"; break;
1777 case DT_CHECKSUM: name = "CHECKSUM"; break;
1778 case DT_PLTPADSZ: name = "PLTPADSZ"; break;
1779 case DT_MOVEENT: name = "MOVEENT"; break;
1780 case DT_MOVESZ: name = "MOVESZ"; break;
1781 case DT_FEATURE: name = "FEATURE"; break;
1782 case DT_POSFLAG_1: name = "POSFLAG_1"; break;
1783 case DT_SYMINSZ: name = "SYMINSZ"; break;
1784 case DT_SYMINENT: name = "SYMINENT"; break;
1785 case DT_CONFIG: name = "CONFIG"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1786 case DT_DEPAUDIT: name = "DEPAUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1787 case DT_AUDIT: name = "AUDIT"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1788 case DT_PLTPAD: name = "PLTPAD"; break;
1789 case DT_MOVETAB: name = "MOVETAB"; break;
1790 case DT_SYMINFO: name = "SYMINFO"; break;
1791 case DT_RELACOUNT: name = "RELACOUNT"; break;
1792 case DT_RELCOUNT: name = "RELCOUNT"; break;
1793 case DT_FLAGS_1: name = "FLAGS_1"; break;
1794 case DT_VERSYM: name = "VERSYM"; break;
1795 case DT_VERDEF: name = "VERDEF"; break;
1796 case DT_VERDEFNUM: name = "VERDEFNUM"; break;
1797 case DT_VERNEED: name = "VERNEED"; break;
1798 case DT_VERNEEDNUM: name = "VERNEEDNUM"; break;
1799 case DT_AUXILIARY: name = "AUXILIARY"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1800 case DT_USED: name = "USED"; break;
1801 case DT_FILTER: name = "FILTER"; stringp = TRUE; break;
1802 case DT_GNU_HASH: name = "GNU_HASH"; break;
1803 }
1804
1805 fprintf (f, " %-20s ", name);
1806 if (! stringp)
1807 {
1808 fprintf (f, "0x");
1809 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, f, dyn.d_un.d_val);
1810 }
1811 else
1812 {
1813 const char *string;
1814 unsigned int tagv = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1815
1816 string = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, shlink, tagv);
1817 if (string == NULL)
1818 goto error_return;
1819 fprintf (f, "%s", string);
1820 }
1821 fprintf (f, "\n");
1822 }
1823
1824 free (dynbuf);
1825 dynbuf = NULL;
1826 }
1827
1828 if ((elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
1829 || (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0 && elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL))
1830 {
1831 if (! _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (abfd, FALSE))
1832 return FALSE;
1833 }
1834
1835 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
1836 {
1837 Elf_Internal_Verdef *t;
1838
1839 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion definitions:\n"));
1840 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef; t != NULL; t = t->vd_nextdef)
1841 {
1842 fprintf (f, "%d 0x%2.2x 0x%8.8lx %s\n", t->vd_ndx,
1843 t->vd_flags, t->vd_hash,
1844 t->vd_nodename ? t->vd_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1845 if (t->vd_auxptr != NULL && t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr != NULL)
1846 {
1847 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *a;
1848
1849 fprintf (f, "\t");
1850 for (a = t->vd_auxptr->vda_nextptr;
1851 a != NULL;
1852 a = a->vda_nextptr)
1853 fprintf (f, "%s ",
1854 a->vda_nodename ? a->vda_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1855 fprintf (f, "\n");
1856 }
1857 }
1858 }
1859
1860 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
1861 {
1862 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1863
1864 fprintf (f, _("\nVersion References:\n"));
1865 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref; t != NULL; t = t->vn_nextref)
1866 {
1867 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1868
1869 fprintf (f, _(" required from %s:\n"),
1870 t->vn_filename ? t->vn_filename : "<corrupt>");
1871 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1872 fprintf (f, " 0x%8.8lx 0x%2.2x %2.2d %s\n", a->vna_hash,
1873 a->vna_flags, a->vna_other,
1874 a->vna_nodename ? a->vna_nodename : "<corrupt>");
1875 }
1876 }
1877
1878 return TRUE;
1879
1880 error_return:
1881 if (dynbuf != NULL)
1882 free (dynbuf);
1883 return FALSE;
1884 }
1885
1886 /* Get version name. If BASE_P is TRUE, return "Base" for VER_FLG_BASE
1887 and return symbol version for symbol version itself. */
1888
1889 const char *
1890 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
1891 bfd_boolean base_p,
1892 bfd_boolean *hidden)
1893 {
1894 const char *version_string = NULL;
1895 if (elf_dynversym (abfd) != 0
1896 && (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0 || elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0))
1897 {
1898 unsigned int vernum = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->version;
1899
1900 *hidden = (vernum & VERSYM_HIDDEN) != 0;
1901 vernum &= VERSYM_VERSION;
1902
1903 if (vernum == 0)
1904 version_string = "";
1905 else if (vernum == 1
1906 && (vernum > elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs
1907 || (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[0].vd_flags
1908 == VER_FLG_BASE)))
1909 version_string = base_p ? "Base" : "";
1910 else if (vernum <= elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs)
1911 {
1912 const char *nodename
1913 = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[vernum - 1].vd_nodename;
1914 version_string = ((base_p || strcmp (symbol->name, nodename))
1915 ? nodename : "");
1916 }
1917 else
1918 {
1919 Elf_Internal_Verneed *t;
1920
1921 version_string = _("<corrupt>");
1922 for (t = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
1923 t != NULL;
1924 t = t->vn_nextref)
1925 {
1926 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *a;
1927
1928 for (a = t->vn_auxptr; a != NULL; a = a->vna_nextptr)
1929 {
1930 if (a->vna_other == vernum)
1931 {
1932 version_string = a->vna_nodename;
1933 break;
1934 }
1935 }
1936 }
1937 }
1938 }
1939 return version_string;
1940 }
1941
1942 /* Display ELF-specific fields of a symbol. */
1943
1944 void
1945 bfd_elf_print_symbol (bfd *abfd,
1946 void *filep,
1947 asymbol *symbol,
1948 bfd_print_symbol_type how)
1949 {
1950 FILE *file = (FILE *) filep;
1951 switch (how)
1952 {
1953 case bfd_print_symbol_name:
1954 fprintf (file, "%s", symbol->name);
1955 break;
1956 case bfd_print_symbol_more:
1957 fprintf (file, "elf ");
1958 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, symbol->value);
1959 fprintf (file, " %x", symbol->flags);
1960 break;
1961 case bfd_print_symbol_all:
1962 {
1963 const char *section_name;
1964 const char *name = NULL;
1965 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
1966 unsigned char st_other;
1967 bfd_vma val;
1968 const char *version_string;
1969 bfd_boolean hidden;
1970
1971 section_name = symbol->section ? symbol->section->name : "(*none*)";
1972
1973 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
1974 if (bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all)
1975 name = (*bed->elf_backend_print_symbol_all) (abfd, filep, symbol);
1976
1977 if (name == NULL)
1978 {
1979 name = symbol->name;
1980 bfd_print_symbol_vandf (abfd, file, symbol);
1981 }
1982
1983 fprintf (file, " %s\t", section_name);
1984 /* Print the "other" value for a symbol. For common symbols,
1985 we've already printed the size; now print the alignment.
1986 For other symbols, we have no specified alignment, and
1987 we've printed the address; now print the size. */
1988 if (symbol->section && bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
1989 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
1990 else
1991 val = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
1992 bfd_fprintf_vma (abfd, file, val);
1993
1994 /* If we have version information, print it. */
1995 version_string = _bfd_elf_get_symbol_version_string (abfd,
1996 symbol,
1997 TRUE,
1998 &hidden);
1999 if (version_string)
2000 {
2001 if (!hidden)
2002 fprintf (file, " %-11s", version_string);
2003 else
2004 {
2005 int i;
2006
2007 fprintf (file, " (%s)", version_string);
2008 for (i = 10 - strlen (version_string); i > 0; --i)
2009 putc (' ', file);
2010 }
2011 }
2012
2013 /* If the st_other field is not zero, print it. */
2014 st_other = ((elf_symbol_type *) symbol)->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
2015
2016 switch (st_other)
2017 {
2018 case 0: break;
2019 case STV_INTERNAL: fprintf (file, " .internal"); break;
2020 case STV_HIDDEN: fprintf (file, " .hidden"); break;
2021 case STV_PROTECTED: fprintf (file, " .protected"); break;
2022 default:
2023 /* Some other non-defined flags are also present, so print
2024 everything hex. */
2025 fprintf (file, " 0x%02x", (unsigned int) st_other);
2026 }
2027
2028 fprintf (file, " %s", name);
2029 }
2030 break;
2031 }
2032 }
2033 \f
2034 /* ELF .o/exec file reading */
2035
2036 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF section header. */
2037
2038 bfd_boolean
2039 bfd_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd, unsigned int shindex)
2040 {
2041 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
2042 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *ehdr;
2043 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2044 const char *name;
2045 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
2046 static bfd_boolean * sections_being_created = NULL;
2047 static bfd * sections_being_created_abfd = NULL;
2048 static unsigned int nesting = 0;
2049
2050 if (shindex >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2051 return FALSE;
2052
2053 if (++ nesting > 3)
2054 {
2055 /* PR17512: A corrupt ELF binary might contain a recursive group of
2056 sections, with each the string indices pointing to the next in the
2057 loop. Detect this here, by refusing to load a section that we are
2058 already in the process of loading. We only trigger this test if
2059 we have nested at least three sections deep as normal ELF binaries
2060 can expect to recurse at least once.
2061
2062 FIXME: It would be better if this array was attached to the bfd,
2063 rather than being held in a static pointer. */
2064
2065 if (sections_being_created_abfd != abfd)
2066 sections_being_created = NULL;
2067 if (sections_being_created == NULL)
2068 {
2069 size_t amt = elf_numsections (abfd) * sizeof (bfd_boolean);
2070 sections_being_created = (bfd_boolean *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2071 if (sections_being_created == NULL)
2072 return FALSE;
2073 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2074 }
2075 if (sections_being_created [shindex])
2076 {
2077 _bfd_error_handler
2078 (_("%pB: warning: loop in section dependencies detected"), abfd);
2079 return FALSE;
2080 }
2081 sections_being_created [shindex] = TRUE;
2082 }
2083
2084 hdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex];
2085 ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
2086 name = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, ehdr->e_shstrndx,
2087 hdr->sh_name);
2088 if (name == NULL)
2089 goto fail;
2090
2091 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2092 switch (hdr->sh_type)
2093 {
2094 case SHT_NULL:
2095 /* Inactive section. Throw it away. */
2096 goto success;
2097
2098 case SHT_PROGBITS: /* Normal section with contents. */
2099 case SHT_NOBITS: /* .bss section. */
2100 case SHT_HASH: /* .hash section. */
2101 case SHT_NOTE: /* .note section. */
2102 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY: /* .init_array section. */
2103 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY: /* .fini_array section. */
2104 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY: /* .preinit_array section. */
2105 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST: /* .gnu.liblist section. */
2106 case SHT_GNU_HASH: /* .gnu.hash section. */
2107 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2108 goto success;
2109
2110 case SHT_DYNAMIC: /* Dynamic linking information. */
2111 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2112 goto fail;
2113
2114 if (hdr->sh_link > elf_numsections (abfd))
2115 {
2116 /* PR 10478: Accept Solaris binaries with a sh_link
2117 field set to SHN_BEFORE or SHN_AFTER. */
2118 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
2119 {
2120 case bfd_arch_i386:
2121 case bfd_arch_sparc:
2122 if (hdr->sh_link == (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xffff) /* SHN_BEFORE */
2123 || hdr->sh_link == ((SHN_LORESERVE + 1) & 0xffff) /* SHN_AFTER */)
2124 break;
2125 /* Otherwise fall through. */
2126 default:
2127 goto fail;
2128 }
2129 }
2130 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link] == NULL)
2131 goto fail;
2132 else if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_STRTAB)
2133 {
2134 Elf_Internal_Shdr *dynsymhdr;
2135
2136 /* The shared libraries distributed with hpux11 have a bogus
2137 sh_link field for the ".dynamic" section. Find the
2138 string table for the ".dynsym" section instead. */
2139 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2140 {
2141 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)];
2142 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2143 }
2144 else
2145 {
2146 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2147
2148 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2149 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2150 {
2151 dynsymhdr = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2152 if (dynsymhdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2153 {
2154 hdr->sh_link = dynsymhdr->sh_link;
2155 break;
2156 }
2157 }
2158 }
2159 }
2160 goto success;
2161
2162 case SHT_SYMTAB: /* A symbol table. */
2163 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2164 goto success;
2165
2166 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2167 goto fail;
2168
2169 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2170 {
2171 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2172 goto fail;
2173 /* Some assemblers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2174 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2175 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2176 hdr->sh_info = 0;
2177 goto success;
2178 }
2179
2180 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one symbol table.
2181 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2182 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) != 0)
2183 {
2184 _bfd_error_handler
2185 /* xgettext:c-format */
2186 (_("%pB: warning: multiple symbol tables detected"
2187 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2188 abfd, shindex);
2189 goto success;
2190 }
2191 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2192 elf_symtab_hdr (abfd) = *hdr;
2193 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2194 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2195
2196 /* Sometimes a shared object will map in the symbol table. If
2197 SHF_ALLOC is set, and this is a shared object, then we also
2198 treat this section as a BFD section. We can not base the
2199 decision purely on SHF_ALLOC, because that flag is sometimes
2200 set in a relocatable object file, which would confuse the
2201 linker. */
2202 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
2203 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
2204 && ! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2205 shindex))
2206 goto fail;
2207
2208 /* Go looking for SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX too, since if there is one we
2209 can't read symbols without that section loaded as well. It
2210 is most likely specified by the next section header. */
2211 {
2212 elf_section_list * entry;
2213 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2214
2215 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2216 if (entry->hdr.sh_link == shindex)
2217 goto success;
2218
2219 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2220 for (i = shindex + 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2221 {
2222 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2223
2224 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2225 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2226 break;
2227 }
2228
2229 if (i == num_sec)
2230 for (i = 1; i < shindex; i++)
2231 {
2232 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2233
2234 if (hdr2->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX
2235 && hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2236 break;
2237 }
2238
2239 if (i != shindex)
2240 ret = bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i);
2241 /* else FIXME: we have failed to find the symbol table - should we issue an error ? */
2242 goto success;
2243 }
2244
2245 case SHT_DYNSYM: /* A dynamic symbol table. */
2246 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == shindex)
2247 goto success;
2248
2249 if (hdr->sh_entsize != bed->s->sizeof_sym)
2250 goto fail;
2251
2252 if (hdr->sh_info * hdr->sh_entsize > hdr->sh_size)
2253 {
2254 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2255 goto fail;
2256
2257 /* Some linkers erroneously set sh_info to one with a
2258 zero sh_size. ld sees this as a global symbol count
2259 of (unsigned) -1. Fix it here. */
2260 hdr->sh_info = 0;
2261 goto success;
2262 }
2263
2264 /* PR 18854: A binary might contain more than one dynamic symbol table.
2265 Unusual, but possible. Warn, but continue. */
2266 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) != 0)
2267 {
2268 _bfd_error_handler
2269 /* xgettext:c-format */
2270 (_("%pB: warning: multiple dynamic symbol tables detected"
2271 " - ignoring the table in section %u"),
2272 abfd, shindex);
2273 goto success;
2274 }
2275 elf_dynsymtab (abfd) = shindex;
2276 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr = *hdr;
2277 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
2278 abfd->flags |= HAS_SYMS;
2279
2280 /* Besides being a symbol table, we also treat this as a regular
2281 section, so that objcopy can handle it. */
2282 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2283 goto success;
2284
2285 case SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX: /* Symbol section indices when >64k sections. */
2286 {
2287 elf_section_list * entry;
2288
2289 for (entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd); entry != NULL; entry = entry->next)
2290 if (entry->ndx == shindex)
2291 goto success;
2292
2293 entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
2294 if (entry == NULL)
2295 goto fail;
2296 entry->ndx = shindex;
2297 entry->hdr = * hdr;
2298 entry->next = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
2299 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
2300 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = & entry->hdr;
2301 goto success;
2302 }
2303
2304 case SHT_STRTAB: /* A string table. */
2305 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
2306 goto success;
2307
2308 if (ehdr->e_shstrndx == shindex)
2309 {
2310 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2311 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
2312 goto success;
2313 }
2314
2315 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2316 {
2317 symtab_strtab:
2318 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr = *hdr;
2319 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
2320 goto success;
2321 }
2322
2323 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[elf_dynsymtab (abfd)]->sh_link == shindex)
2324 {
2325 dynsymtab_strtab:
2326 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr = *hdr;
2327 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynstrtab_hdr;
2328 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr;
2329 /* We also treat this as a regular section, so that objcopy
2330 can handle it. */
2331 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2332 shindex);
2333 goto success;
2334 }
2335
2336 /* If the string table isn't one of the above, then treat it as a
2337 regular section. We need to scan all the headers to be sure,
2338 just in case this strtab section appeared before the above. */
2339 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == 0 || elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
2340 {
2341 unsigned int i, num_sec;
2342
2343 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2344 for (i = 1; i < num_sec; i++)
2345 {
2346 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2 = elf_elfsections (abfd)[i];
2347 if (hdr2->sh_link == shindex)
2348 {
2349 /* Prevent endless recursion on broken objects. */
2350 if (i == shindex)
2351 goto fail;
2352 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, i))
2353 goto fail;
2354 if (elf_onesymtab (abfd) == i)
2355 goto symtab_strtab;
2356 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == i)
2357 goto dynsymtab_strtab;
2358 }
2359 }
2360 }
2361 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2362 goto success;
2363
2364 case SHT_REL:
2365 case SHT_RELA:
2366 /* *These* do a lot of work -- but build no sections! */
2367 {
2368 asection *target_sect;
2369 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr2, **p_hdr;
2370 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
2371 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esdt;
2372
2373 if (hdr->sh_entsize
2374 != (bfd_size_type) (hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL
2375 ? bed->s->sizeof_rel : bed->s->sizeof_rela))
2376 goto fail;
2377
2378 /* Check for a bogus link to avoid crashing. */
2379 if (hdr->sh_link >= num_sec)
2380 {
2381 _bfd_error_handler
2382 /* xgettext:c-format */
2383 (_("%pB: invalid link %u for reloc section %s (index %u)"),
2384 abfd, hdr->sh_link, name, shindex);
2385 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2386 shindex);
2387 goto success;
2388 }
2389
2390 /* For some incomprehensible reason Oracle distributes
2391 libraries for Solaris in which some of the objects have
2392 bogus sh_link fields. It would be nice if we could just
2393 reject them, but, unfortunately, some people need to use
2394 them. We scan through the section headers; if we find only
2395 one suitable symbol table, we clobber the sh_link to point
2396 to it. I hope this doesn't break anything.
2397
2398 Don't do it on executable nor shared library. */
2399 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0
2400 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_SYMTAB
2401 && elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type != SHT_DYNSYM)
2402 {
2403 unsigned int scan;
2404 int found;
2405
2406 found = 0;
2407 for (scan = 1; scan < num_sec; scan++)
2408 {
2409 if (elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2410 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[scan]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2411 {
2412 if (found != 0)
2413 {
2414 found = 0;
2415 break;
2416 }
2417 found = scan;
2418 }
2419 }
2420 if (found != 0)
2421 hdr->sh_link = found;
2422 }
2423
2424 /* Get the symbol table. */
2425 if ((elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
2426 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_link]->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM)
2427 && ! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_link))
2428 goto fail;
2429
2430 /* If this is an alloc section in an executable or shared
2431 library, or the reloc section does not use the main symbol
2432 table we don't treat it as a reloc section. BFD can't
2433 adequately represent such a section, so at least for now,
2434 we don't try. We just present it as a normal section. We
2435 also can't use it as a reloc section if it points to the
2436 null section, an invalid section, another reloc section, or
2437 its sh_link points to the null section. */
2438 if (((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) != 0
2439 && (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2440 || hdr->sh_link == SHN_UNDEF
2441 || hdr->sh_link != elf_onesymtab (abfd)
2442 || hdr->sh_info == SHN_UNDEF
2443 || hdr->sh_info >= num_sec
2444 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_REL
2445 || elf_elfsections (abfd)[hdr->sh_info]->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2446 {
2447 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2448 shindex);
2449 goto success;
2450 }
2451
2452 if (! bfd_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr->sh_info))
2453 goto fail;
2454
2455 target_sect = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, hdr->sh_info);
2456 if (target_sect == NULL)
2457 goto fail;
2458
2459 esdt = elf_section_data (target_sect);
2460 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2461 p_hdr = &esdt->rela.hdr;
2462 else
2463 p_hdr = &esdt->rel.hdr;
2464
2465 /* PR 17512: file: 0b4f81b7.
2466 Also see PR 24456, for a file which deliberately has two reloc
2467 sections. */
2468 if (*p_hdr != NULL)
2469 {
2470 if (!bed->init_secondary_reloc_section (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2471 {
2472 _bfd_error_handler
2473 /* xgettext:c-format */
2474 (_("%pB: warning: secondary relocation section '%s' "
2475 "for section %pA found - ignoring"),
2476 abfd, name, target_sect);
2477 }
2478 goto success;
2479 }
2480
2481 hdr2 = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*hdr2));
2482 if (hdr2 == NULL)
2483 goto fail;
2484 *hdr2 = *hdr;
2485 *p_hdr = hdr2;
2486 elf_elfsections (abfd)[shindex] = hdr2;
2487 target_sect->reloc_count += (NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr)
2488 * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel);
2489 target_sect->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
2490 target_sect->relocation = NULL;
2491 target_sect->rel_filepos = hdr->sh_offset;
2492 /* In the section to which the relocations apply, mark whether
2493 its relocations are of the REL or RELA variety. */
2494 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
2495 {
2496 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
2497 target_sect->use_rela_p = 1;
2498 }
2499 abfd->flags |= HAS_RELOC;
2500 goto success;
2501 }
2502
2503 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
2504 elf_dynverdef (abfd) = shindex;
2505 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr = *hdr;
2506 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2507 goto success;
2508
2509 case SHT_GNU_versym:
2510 if (hdr->sh_entsize != sizeof (Elf_External_Versym))
2511 goto fail;
2512
2513 elf_dynversym (abfd) = shindex;
2514 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynversym_hdr = *hdr;
2515 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2516 goto success;
2517
2518 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
2519 elf_dynverref (abfd) = shindex;
2520 elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr = *hdr;
2521 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2522 goto success;
2523
2524 case SHT_SHLIB:
2525 goto success;
2526
2527 case SHT_GROUP:
2528 if (! IS_VALID_GROUP_SECTION_HEADER (hdr, GRP_ENTRY_SIZE))
2529 goto fail;
2530
2531 if (!_bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2532 goto fail;
2533
2534 goto success;
2535
2536 default:
2537 /* Possibly an attributes section. */
2538 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_ATTRIBUTES
2539 || hdr->sh_type == bed->obj_attrs_section_type)
2540 {
2541 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2542 goto fail;
2543 _bfd_elf_parse_attributes (abfd, hdr);
2544 goto success;
2545 }
2546
2547 /* Check for any processor-specific section types. */
2548 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
2549 goto success;
2550
2551 if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOUSER && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIUSER)
2552 {
2553 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
2554 /* FIXME: How to properly handle allocated section reserved
2555 for applications? */
2556 _bfd_error_handler
2557 /* xgettext:c-format */
2558 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2559 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2560 else
2561 {
2562 /* Allow sections reserved for applications. */
2563 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name,
2564 shindex);
2565 goto success;
2566 }
2567 }
2568 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOPROC
2569 && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIPROC)
2570 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2571 _bfd_error_handler
2572 /* xgettext:c-format */
2573 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2574 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2575 else if (hdr->sh_type >= SHT_LOOS && hdr->sh_type <= SHT_HIOS)
2576 {
2577 /* Unrecognised OS-specific sections. */
2578 if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING) != 0)
2579 /* SHF_OS_NONCONFORMING indicates that special knowledge is
2580 required to correctly process the section and the file should
2581 be rejected with an error message. */
2582 _bfd_error_handler
2583 /* xgettext:c-format */
2584 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2585 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2586 else
2587 {
2588 /* Otherwise it should be processed. */
2589 ret = _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
2590 goto success;
2591 }
2592 }
2593 else
2594 /* FIXME: We should handle this section. */
2595 _bfd_error_handler
2596 /* xgettext:c-format */
2597 (_("%pB: unknown type [%#x] section `%s'"),
2598 abfd, hdr->sh_type, name);
2599
2600 goto fail;
2601 }
2602
2603 fail:
2604 ret = FALSE;
2605 success:
2606 if (sections_being_created && sections_being_created_abfd == abfd)
2607 sections_being_created [shindex] = FALSE;
2608 if (-- nesting == 0)
2609 {
2610 sections_being_created = NULL;
2611 sections_being_created_abfd = abfd;
2612 }
2613 return ret;
2614 }
2615
2616 /* Return the local symbol specified by ABFD, R_SYMNDX. */
2617
2618 Elf_Internal_Sym *
2619 bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (struct sym_cache *cache,
2620 bfd *abfd,
2621 unsigned long r_symndx)
2622 {
2623 unsigned int ent = r_symndx % LOCAL_SYM_CACHE_SIZE;
2624
2625 if (cache->abfd != abfd || cache->indx[ent] != r_symndx)
2626 {
2627 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2628 unsigned char esym[sizeof (Elf64_External_Sym)];
2629 Elf_External_Sym_Shndx eshndx;
2630
2631 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
2632 if (bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr, 1, r_symndx,
2633 &cache->sym[ent], esym, &eshndx) == NULL)
2634 return NULL;
2635
2636 if (cache->abfd != abfd)
2637 {
2638 memset (cache->indx, -1, sizeof (cache->indx));
2639 cache->abfd = abfd;
2640 }
2641 cache->indx[ent] = r_symndx;
2642 }
2643
2644 return &cache->sym[ent];
2645 }
2646
2647 /* Given an ELF section number, retrieve the corresponding BFD
2648 section. */
2649
2650 asection *
2651 bfd_section_from_elf_index (bfd *abfd, unsigned int sec_index)
2652 {
2653 if (sec_index >= elf_numsections (abfd))
2654 return NULL;
2655 return elf_elfsections (abfd)[sec_index]->bfd_section;
2656 }
2657
2658 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_b[] =
2659 {
2660 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".bss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2661 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2662 };
2663
2664 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_c[] =
2665 {
2666 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".comment"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2667 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".ctf"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2668 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2669 };
2670
2671 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_d[] =
2672 {
2673 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2674 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".data1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2675 /* There are more DWARF sections than these, but they needn't be added here
2676 unless you have to cope with broken compilers that don't emit section
2677 attributes or you want to help the user writing assembler. */
2678 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2679 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2680 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2681 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2682 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".debug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2683 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynamic"), 0, SHT_DYNAMIC, SHF_ALLOC },
2684 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynstr"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, SHF_ALLOC },
2685 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".dynsym"), 0, SHT_DYNSYM, SHF_ALLOC },
2686 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2687 };
2688
2689 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_f[] =
2690 {
2691 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2692 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".fini_array"), -2, SHT_FINI_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2693 { NULL, 0 , 0, 0, 0 }
2694 };
2695
2696 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_g[] =
2697 {
2698 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.linkonce.b"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2699 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.lto_"), -1, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_EXCLUDE },
2700 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".got"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2701 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version"), 0, SHT_GNU_versym, 0 },
2702 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_d"), 0, SHT_GNU_verdef, 0 },
2703 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.version_r"), 0, SHT_GNU_verneed, 0 },
2704 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.liblist"), 0, SHT_GNU_LIBLIST, SHF_ALLOC },
2705 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.conflict"), 0, SHT_RELA, SHF_ALLOC },
2706 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".gnu.hash"), 0, SHT_GNU_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2707 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2708 };
2709
2710 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_h[] =
2711 {
2712 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".hash"), 0, SHT_HASH, SHF_ALLOC },
2713 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2714 };
2715
2716 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_i[] =
2717 {
2718 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2719 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".init_array"), -2, SHT_INIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2720 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".interp"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2721 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2722 };
2723
2724 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_l[] =
2725 {
2726 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2727 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2728 };
2729
2730 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_n[] =
2731 {
2732 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note.GNU-stack"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2733 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".note"), -1, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
2734 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2735 };
2736
2737 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_p[] =
2738 {
2739 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".preinit_array"), -2, SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
2740 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2741 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2742 };
2743
2744 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_r[] =
2745 {
2746 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2747 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rodata1"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
2748 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rela"), -1, SHT_RELA, 0 },
2749 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".rel"), -1, SHT_REL, 0 },
2750 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2751 };
2752
2753 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_s[] =
2754 {
2755 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".shstrtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2756 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".strtab"), 0, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2757 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".symtab"), 0, SHT_SYMTAB, 0 },
2758 /* See struct bfd_elf_special_section declaration for the semantics of
2759 this special case where .prefix_length != strlen (.prefix). */
2760 { ".stabstr", 5, 3, SHT_STRTAB, 0 },
2761 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2762 };
2763
2764 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_t[] =
2765 {
2766 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".text"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
2767 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2768 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_TLS },
2769 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2770 };
2771
2772 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section special_sections_z[] =
2773 {
2774 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_line"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2775 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_info"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2776 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_abbrev"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2777 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".zdebug_aranges"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, 0 },
2778 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
2779 };
2780
2781 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section * const special_sections[] =
2782 {
2783 special_sections_b, /* 'b' */
2784 special_sections_c, /* 'c' */
2785 special_sections_d, /* 'd' */
2786 NULL, /* 'e' */
2787 special_sections_f, /* 'f' */
2788 special_sections_g, /* 'g' */
2789 special_sections_h, /* 'h' */
2790 special_sections_i, /* 'i' */
2791 NULL, /* 'j' */
2792 NULL, /* 'k' */
2793 special_sections_l, /* 'l' */
2794 NULL, /* 'm' */
2795 special_sections_n, /* 'n' */
2796 NULL, /* 'o' */
2797 special_sections_p, /* 'p' */
2798 NULL, /* 'q' */
2799 special_sections_r, /* 'r' */
2800 special_sections_s, /* 's' */
2801 special_sections_t, /* 't' */
2802 NULL, /* 'u' */
2803 NULL, /* 'v' */
2804 NULL, /* 'w' */
2805 NULL, /* 'x' */
2806 NULL, /* 'y' */
2807 special_sections_z /* 'z' */
2808 };
2809
2810 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2811 _bfd_elf_get_special_section (const char *name,
2812 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec,
2813 unsigned int rela)
2814 {
2815 int i;
2816 int len;
2817
2818 len = strlen (name);
2819
2820 for (i = 0; spec[i].prefix != NULL; i++)
2821 {
2822 int suffix_len;
2823 int prefix_len = spec[i].prefix_length;
2824
2825 if (len < prefix_len)
2826 continue;
2827 if (memcmp (name, spec[i].prefix, prefix_len) != 0)
2828 continue;
2829
2830 suffix_len = spec[i].suffix_length;
2831 if (suffix_len <= 0)
2832 {
2833 if (name[prefix_len] != 0)
2834 {
2835 if (suffix_len == 0)
2836 continue;
2837 if (name[prefix_len] != '.'
2838 && (suffix_len == -2
2839 || (rela && spec[i].type == SHT_REL)))
2840 continue;
2841 }
2842 }
2843 else
2844 {
2845 if (len < prefix_len + suffix_len)
2846 continue;
2847 if (memcmp (name + len - suffix_len,
2848 spec[i].prefix + prefix_len,
2849 suffix_len) != 0)
2850 continue;
2851 }
2852 return &spec[i];
2853 }
2854
2855 return NULL;
2856 }
2857
2858 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
2859 _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2860 {
2861 int i;
2862 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *spec;
2863 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2864
2865 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
2866 if (sec->name == NULL)
2867 return NULL;
2868
2869 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2870 spec = bed->special_sections;
2871 if (spec)
2872 {
2873 spec = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name,
2874 bed->special_sections,
2875 sec->use_rela_p);
2876 if (spec != NULL)
2877 return spec;
2878 }
2879
2880 if (sec->name[0] != '.')
2881 return NULL;
2882
2883 i = sec->name[1] - 'b';
2884 if (i < 0 || i > 'z' - 'b')
2885 return NULL;
2886
2887 spec = special_sections[i];
2888
2889 if (spec == NULL)
2890 return NULL;
2891
2892 return _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, spec, sec->use_rela_p);
2893 }
2894
2895 bfd_boolean
2896 _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
2897 {
2898 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sdata;
2899 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
2900 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
2901
2902 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) sec->used_by_bfd;
2903 if (sdata == NULL)
2904 {
2905 sdata = (struct bfd_elf_section_data *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
2906 sizeof (*sdata));
2907 if (sdata == NULL)
2908 return FALSE;
2909 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
2910 }
2911
2912 /* Indicate whether or not this section should use RELA relocations. */
2913 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
2914 sec->use_rela_p = bed->default_use_rela_p;
2915
2916 /* Set up ELF section type and flags for newly created sections, if
2917 there is an ABI mandated section. */
2918 ssect = (*bed->get_sec_type_attr) (abfd, sec);
2919 if (ssect != NULL)
2920 {
2921 elf_section_type (sec) = ssect->type;
2922 elf_section_flags (sec) = ssect->attr;
2923 }
2924
2925 return _bfd_generic_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
2926 }
2927
2928 /* Create a new bfd section from an ELF program header.
2929
2930 Since program segments have no names, we generate a synthetic name
2931 of the form segment<NUM>, where NUM is generally the index in the
2932 program header table. For segments that are split (see below) we
2933 generate the names segment<NUM>a and segment<NUM>b.
2934
2935 Note that some program segments may have a file size that is different than
2936 (less than) the memory size. All this means is that at execution the
2937 system must allocate the amount of memory specified by the memory size,
2938 but only initialize it with the first "file size" bytes read from the
2939 file. This would occur for example, with program segments consisting
2940 of combined data+bss.
2941
2942 To handle the above situation, this routine generates TWO bfd sections
2943 for the single program segment. The first has the length specified by
2944 the file size of the segment, and the second has the length specified
2945 by the difference between the two sizes. In effect, the segment is split
2946 into its initialized and uninitialized parts.
2947
2948 */
2949
2950 bfd_boolean
2951 _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd,
2952 Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr,
2953 int hdr_index,
2954 const char *type_name)
2955 {
2956 asection *newsect;
2957 char *name;
2958 char namebuf[64];
2959 size_t len;
2960 int split;
2961 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
2962
2963 split = ((hdr->p_memsz > 0)
2964 && (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2965 && (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz));
2966
2967 if (hdr->p_filesz > 0)
2968 {
2969 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "a" : "");
2970 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
2971 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
2972 if (!name)
2973 return FALSE;
2974 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
2975 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
2976 if (newsect == NULL)
2977 return FALSE;
2978 newsect->vma = hdr->p_vaddr / opb;
2979 newsect->lma = hdr->p_paddr / opb;
2980 newsect->size = hdr->p_filesz;
2981 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset;
2982 newsect->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
2983 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (hdr->p_align);
2984 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
2985 {
2986 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
2987 newsect->flags |= SEC_LOAD;
2988 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
2989 {
2990 /* FIXME: all we known is that it has execute PERMISSION,
2991 may be data. */
2992 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
2993 }
2994 }
2995 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
2996 {
2997 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
2998 }
2999 }
3000
3001 if (hdr->p_memsz > hdr->p_filesz)
3002 {
3003 bfd_vma align;
3004
3005 sprintf (namebuf, "%s%d%s", type_name, hdr_index, split ? "b" : "");
3006 len = strlen (namebuf) + 1;
3007 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
3008 if (!name)
3009 return FALSE;
3010 memcpy (name, namebuf, len);
3011 newsect = bfd_make_section (abfd, name);
3012 if (newsect == NULL)
3013 return FALSE;
3014 newsect->vma = (hdr->p_vaddr + hdr->p_filesz) / opb;
3015 newsect->lma = (hdr->p_paddr + hdr->p_filesz) / opb;
3016 newsect->size = hdr->p_memsz - hdr->p_filesz;
3017 newsect->filepos = hdr->p_offset + hdr->p_filesz;
3018 align = newsect->vma & -newsect->vma;
3019 if (align == 0 || align > hdr->p_align)
3020 align = hdr->p_align;
3021 newsect->alignment_power = bfd_log2 (align);
3022 if (hdr->p_type == PT_LOAD)
3023 {
3024 /* Hack for gdb. Segments that have not been modified do
3025 not have their contents written to a core file, on the
3026 assumption that a debugger can find the contents in the
3027 executable. We flag this case by setting the fake
3028 section size to zero. Note that "real" bss sections will
3029 always have their contents dumped to the core file. */
3030 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
3031 newsect->size = 0;
3032 newsect->flags |= SEC_ALLOC;
3033 if (hdr->p_flags & PF_X)
3034 newsect->flags |= SEC_CODE;
3035 }
3036 if (!(hdr->p_flags & PF_W))
3037 newsect->flags |= SEC_READONLY;
3038 }
3039
3040 return TRUE;
3041 }
3042
3043 static bfd_boolean
3044 _bfd_elf_core_find_build_id (bfd *templ, bfd_vma offset)
3045 {
3046 /* The return value is ignored. Build-ids are considered optional. */
3047 if (templ->xvec->flavour == bfd_target_elf_flavour)
3048 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_core_find_build_id)
3049 (templ, offset);
3050 return FALSE;
3051 }
3052
3053 bfd_boolean
3054 bfd_section_from_phdr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Phdr *hdr, int hdr_index)
3055 {
3056 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3057
3058 switch (hdr->p_type)
3059 {
3060 case PT_NULL:
3061 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "null");
3062
3063 case PT_LOAD:
3064 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "load"))
3065 return FALSE;
3066 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core && abfd->build_id == NULL)
3067 _bfd_elf_core_find_build_id (abfd, hdr->p_offset);
3068 return TRUE;
3069
3070 case PT_DYNAMIC:
3071 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "dynamic");
3072
3073 case PT_INTERP:
3074 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "interp");
3075
3076 case PT_NOTE:
3077 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "note"))
3078 return FALSE;
3079 if (! elf_read_notes (abfd, hdr->p_offset, hdr->p_filesz,
3080 hdr->p_align))
3081 return FALSE;
3082 return TRUE;
3083
3084 case PT_SHLIB:
3085 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "shlib");
3086
3087 case PT_PHDR:
3088 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "phdr");
3089
3090 case PT_GNU_EH_FRAME:
3091 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index,
3092 "eh_frame_hdr");
3093
3094 case PT_GNU_STACK:
3095 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "stack");
3096
3097 case PT_GNU_RELRO:
3098 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "relro");
3099
3100 default:
3101 /* Check for any processor-specific program segment types. */
3102 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3103 return bed->elf_backend_section_from_phdr (abfd, hdr, hdr_index, "proc");
3104 }
3105 }
3106
3107 /* Return the REL_HDR for SEC, assuming there is only a single one, either
3108 REL or RELA. */
3109
3110 Elf_Internal_Shdr *
3111 _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (asection *sec)
3112 {
3113 if (elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr)
3114 {
3115 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr == NULL);
3116 return elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
3117 }
3118 else
3119 return elf_section_data (sec)->rela.hdr;
3120 }
3121
3122 static bfd_boolean
3123 _bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (bfd *abfd,
3124 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr,
3125 const char *sec_name,
3126 bfd_boolean use_rela_p)
3127 {
3128 char *name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
3129 sizeof ".rela" + strlen (sec_name));
3130 if (name == NULL)
3131 return FALSE;
3132
3133 sprintf (name, "%s%s", use_rela_p ? ".rela" : ".rel", sec_name);
3134 rel_hdr->sh_name =
3135 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd), name,
3136 FALSE);
3137 if (rel_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3138 return FALSE;
3139
3140 return TRUE;
3141 }
3142
3143 /* Allocate and initialize a section-header for a new reloc section,
3144 containing relocations against ASECT. It is stored in RELDATA. If
3145 USE_RELA_P is TRUE, we use RELA relocations; otherwise, we use REL
3146 relocations. */
3147
3148 static bfd_boolean
3149 _bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (bfd *abfd,
3150 struct bfd_elf_section_reloc_data *reldata,
3151 const char *sec_name,
3152 bfd_boolean use_rela_p,
3153 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p)
3154 {
3155 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
3156 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3157
3158 BFD_ASSERT (reldata->hdr == NULL);
3159 rel_hdr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*rel_hdr));
3160 reldata->hdr = rel_hdr;
3161
3162 if (delay_st_name_p)
3163 rel_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3164 else if (!_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd, rel_hdr, sec_name,
3165 use_rela_p))
3166 return FALSE;
3167 rel_hdr->sh_type = use_rela_p ? SHT_RELA : SHT_REL;
3168 rel_hdr->sh_entsize = (use_rela_p
3169 ? bed->s->sizeof_rela
3170 : bed->s->sizeof_rel);
3171 rel_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
3172 rel_hdr->sh_flags = 0;
3173 rel_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3174 rel_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3175 rel_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3176
3177 return TRUE;
3178 }
3179
3180 /* Return the default section type based on the passed in section flags. */
3181
3182 int
3183 bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (flagword flags)
3184 {
3185 if ((flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_IS_COMMON)) != 0
3186 && (flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
3187 return SHT_NOBITS;
3188 return SHT_PROGBITS;
3189 }
3190
3191 struct fake_section_arg
3192 {
3193 struct bfd_link_info *link_info;
3194 bfd_boolean failed;
3195 };
3196
3197 /* Set up an ELF internal section header for a section. */
3198
3199 static void
3200 elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, asection *asect, void *fsarg)
3201 {
3202 struct fake_section_arg *arg = (struct fake_section_arg *)fsarg;
3203 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3204 struct bfd_elf_section_data *esd = elf_section_data (asect);
3205 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
3206 unsigned int sh_type;
3207 const char *name = asect->name;
3208 bfd_boolean delay_st_name_p = FALSE;
3209 bfd_vma mask;
3210
3211 if (arg->failed)
3212 {
3213 /* We already failed; just get out of the bfd_map_over_sections
3214 loop. */
3215 return;
3216 }
3217
3218 this_hdr = &esd->this_hdr;
3219
3220 if (arg->link_info)
3221 {
3222 /* ld: compress DWARF debug sections with names: .debug_*. */
3223 if ((arg->link_info->compress_debug & COMPRESS_DEBUG)
3224 && (asect->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING)
3225 && name[1] == 'd'
3226 && name[6] == '_')
3227 {
3228 /* Set SEC_ELF_COMPRESS to indicate this section should be
3229 compressed. */
3230 asect->flags |= SEC_ELF_COMPRESS;
3231 /* If this section will be compressed, delay adding section
3232 name to section name section after it is compressed in
3233 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
3234 delay_st_name_p = TRUE;
3235 }
3236 }
3237 else if ((asect->flags & SEC_ELF_RENAME))
3238 {
3239 /* objcopy: rename output DWARF debug section. */
3240 if ((abfd->flags & (BFD_DECOMPRESS | BFD_COMPRESS_GABI)))
3241 {
3242 /* When we decompress or compress with SHF_COMPRESSED,
3243 convert section name from .zdebug_* to .debug_* if
3244 needed. */
3245 if (name[1] == 'z')
3246 {
3247 char *new_name = convert_zdebug_to_debug (abfd, name);
3248 if (new_name == NULL)
3249 {
3250 arg->failed = TRUE;
3251 return;
3252 }
3253 name = new_name;
3254 }
3255 }
3256 else if (asect->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE)
3257 {
3258 /* PR binutils/18087: Compression does not always make a
3259 section smaller. So only rename the section when
3260 compression has actually taken place. If input section
3261 name is .zdebug_*, we should never compress it again. */
3262 char *new_name = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
3263 if (new_name == NULL)
3264 {
3265 arg->failed = TRUE;
3266 return;
3267 }
3268 BFD_ASSERT (name[1] != 'z');
3269 name = new_name;
3270 }
3271 }
3272
3273 if (delay_st_name_p)
3274 this_hdr->sh_name = (unsigned int) -1;
3275 else
3276 {
3277 this_hdr->sh_name
3278 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3279 name, FALSE);
3280 if (this_hdr->sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3281 {
3282 arg->failed = TRUE;
3283 return;
3284 }
3285 }
3286
3287 /* Don't clear sh_flags. Assembler may set additional bits. */
3288
3289 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3290 || asect->user_set_vma)
3291 this_hdr->sh_addr = asect->vma * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, asect);
3292 else
3293 this_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
3294
3295 this_hdr->sh_offset = 0;
3296 this_hdr->sh_size = asect->size;
3297 this_hdr->sh_link = 0;
3298 /* PR 17512: file: 0eb809fe, 8b0535ee. */
3299 if (asect->alignment_power >= (sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 1)
3300 {
3301 _bfd_error_handler
3302 /* xgettext:c-format */
3303 (_("%pB: error: alignment power %d of section `%pA' is too big"),
3304 abfd, asect->alignment_power, asect);
3305 arg->failed = TRUE;
3306 return;
3307 }
3308 /* Set sh_addralign to the highest power of two given by alignment
3309 consistent with the section VMA. Linker scripts can force VMA. */
3310 mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << asect->alignment_power) | this_hdr->sh_addr;
3311 this_hdr->sh_addralign = mask & -mask;
3312 /* The sh_entsize and sh_info fields may have been set already by
3313 copy_private_section_data. */
3314
3315 this_hdr->bfd_section = asect;
3316 this_hdr->contents = NULL;
3317
3318 /* If the section type is unspecified, we set it based on
3319 asect->flags. */
3320 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) != 0)
3321 sh_type = SHT_GROUP;
3322 else
3323 sh_type = bfd_elf_get_default_section_type (asect->flags);
3324
3325 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NULL)
3326 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3327 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
3328 && sh_type == SHT_PROGBITS
3329 && (asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3330 {
3331 /* Warn if we are changing a NOBITS section to PROGBITS, but
3332 allow the link to proceed. This can happen when users link
3333 non-bss input sections to bss output sections, or emit data
3334 to a bss output section via a linker script. */
3335 _bfd_error_handler
3336 (_("warning: section `%pA' type changed to PROGBITS"), asect);
3337 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3338 }
3339
3340 switch (this_hdr->sh_type)
3341 {
3342 default:
3343 break;
3344
3345 case SHT_STRTAB:
3346 case SHT_NOTE:
3347 case SHT_NOBITS:
3348 case SHT_PROGBITS:
3349 break;
3350
3351 case SHT_INIT_ARRAY:
3352 case SHT_FINI_ARRAY:
3353 case SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY:
3354 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
3355 break;
3356
3357 case SHT_HASH:
3358 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_hash_entry;
3359 break;
3360
3361 case SHT_DYNSYM:
3362 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
3363 break;
3364
3365 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
3366 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_dyn;
3367 break;
3368
3369 case SHT_RELA:
3370 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rela_p)
3371 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rela;
3372 break;
3373
3374 case SHT_REL:
3375 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->may_use_rel_p)
3376 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_rel;
3377 break;
3378
3379 case SHT_GNU_versym:
3380 this_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Versym);
3381 break;
3382
3383 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
3384 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3385 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3386 cverdefs. The linker will set cverdefs, but sh_info will be
3387 zero. */
3388 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3389 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs;
3390 else
3391 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs == 0
3392 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs);
3393 break;
3394
3395 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
3396 this_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
3397 /* objcopy or strip will copy over sh_info, but may not set
3398 cverrefs. The linker will set cverrefs, but sh_info will be
3399 zero. */
3400 if (this_hdr->sh_info == 0)
3401 this_hdr->sh_info = elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs;
3402 else
3403 BFD_ASSERT (elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs == 0
3404 || this_hdr->sh_info == elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs);
3405 break;
3406
3407 case SHT_GROUP:
3408 this_hdr->sh_entsize = GRP_ENTRY_SIZE;
3409 break;
3410
3411 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
3412 this_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
3413 break;
3414 }
3415
3416 if ((asect->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
3417 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
3418 if ((asect->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
3419 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_WRITE;
3420 if ((asect->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
3421 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXECINSTR;
3422 if ((asect->flags & SEC_MERGE) != 0)
3423 {
3424 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MERGE;
3425 this_hdr->sh_entsize = asect->entsize;
3426 }
3427 if ((asect->flags & SEC_STRINGS) != 0)
3428 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_STRINGS;
3429 if ((asect->flags & SEC_GROUP) == 0 && elf_group_name (asect) != NULL)
3430 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3431 if ((asect->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
3432 {
3433 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_TLS;
3434 if (asect->size == 0
3435 && (asect->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
3436 {
3437 struct bfd_link_order *o = asect->map_tail.link_order;
3438
3439 this_hdr->sh_size = 0;
3440 if (o != NULL)
3441 {
3442 this_hdr->sh_size = o->offset + o->size;
3443 if (this_hdr->sh_size != 0)
3444 this_hdr->sh_type = SHT_NOBITS;
3445 }
3446 }
3447 }
3448 if ((asect->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_EXCLUDE)) == SEC_EXCLUDE)
3449 this_hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_EXCLUDE;
3450
3451 /* If the section has relocs, set up a section header for the
3452 SHT_REL[A] section. If two relocation sections are required for
3453 this section, it is up to the processor-specific back-end to
3454 create the other. */
3455 if ((asect->flags & SEC_RELOC) != 0)
3456 {
3457 /* When doing a relocatable link, create both REL and RELA sections if
3458 needed. */
3459 if (arg->link_info
3460 /* Do the normal setup if we wouldn't create any sections here. */
3461 && esd->rel.count + esd->rela.count > 0
3462 && (bfd_link_relocatable (arg->link_info)
3463 || arg->link_info->emitrelocations))
3464 {
3465 if (esd->rel.count && esd->rel.hdr == NULL
3466 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rel, name,
3467 FALSE, delay_st_name_p))
3468 {
3469 arg->failed = TRUE;
3470 return;
3471 }
3472 if (esd->rela.count && esd->rela.hdr == NULL
3473 && !_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd, &esd->rela, name,
3474 TRUE, delay_st_name_p))
3475 {
3476 arg->failed = TRUE;
3477 return;
3478 }
3479 }
3480 else if (!_bfd_elf_init_reloc_shdr (abfd,
3481 (asect->use_rela_p
3482 ? &esd->rela : &esd->rel),
3483 name,
3484 asect->use_rela_p,
3485 delay_st_name_p))
3486 {
3487 arg->failed = TRUE;
3488 return;
3489 }
3490 }
3491
3492 /* Check for processor-specific section types. */
3493 sh_type = this_hdr->sh_type;
3494 if (bed->elf_backend_fake_sections
3495 && !(*bed->elf_backend_fake_sections) (abfd, this_hdr, asect))
3496 {
3497 arg->failed = TRUE;
3498 return;
3499 }
3500
3501 if (sh_type == SHT_NOBITS && asect->size != 0)
3502 {
3503 /* Don't change the header type from NOBITS if we are being
3504 called for objcopy --only-keep-debug. */
3505 this_hdr->sh_type = sh_type;
3506 }
3507 }
3508
3509 /* Fill in the contents of a SHT_GROUP section. Called from
3510 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions for gas, objcopy, and
3511 when ELF targets use the generic linker, ld. Called for ld -r
3512 from bfd_elf_final_link. */
3513
3514 void
3515 bfd_elf_set_group_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, void *failedptrarg)
3516 {
3517 bfd_boolean *failedptr = (bfd_boolean *) failedptrarg;
3518 asection *elt, *first;
3519 unsigned char *loc;
3520 bfd_boolean gas;
3521
3522 /* Ignore linker created group section. See elfNN_ia64_object_p in
3523 elfxx-ia64.c. */
3524 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_GROUP | SEC_LINKER_CREATED)) != SEC_GROUP
3525 || sec->size == 0
3526 || *failedptr)
3527 return;
3528
3529 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == 0)
3530 {
3531 unsigned long symindx = 0;
3532
3533 /* elf_group_id will have been set up by objcopy and the
3534 generic linker. */
3535 if (elf_group_id (sec) != NULL)
3536 symindx = elf_group_id (sec)->udata.i;
3537
3538 if (symindx == 0)
3539 {
3540 /* If called from the assembler, swap_out_syms will have set up
3541 elf_section_syms.
3542 PR 25699: A corrupt input file could contain bogus group info. */
3543 if (elf_section_syms (abfd) == NULL)
3544 {
3545 *failedptr = TRUE;
3546 return;
3547 }
3548 symindx = elf_section_syms (abfd)[sec->index]->udata.i;
3549 }
3550 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = symindx;
3551 }
3552 else if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info == (unsigned int) -2)
3553 {
3554 /* The ELF backend linker sets sh_info to -2 when the group
3555 signature symbol is global, and thus the index can't be
3556 set until all local symbols are output. */
3557 asection *igroup;
3558 struct bfd_elf_section_data *sec_data;
3559 unsigned long symndx;
3560 unsigned long extsymoff;
3561 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3562
3563 /* The point of this little dance to the first SHF_GROUP section
3564 then back to the SHT_GROUP section is that this gets us to
3565 the SHT_GROUP in the input object. */
3566 igroup = elf_sec_group (elf_next_in_group (sec));
3567 sec_data = elf_section_data (igroup);
3568 symndx = sec_data->this_hdr.sh_info;
3569 extsymoff = 0;
3570 if (!elf_bad_symtab (igroup->owner))
3571 {
3572 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
3573
3574 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (igroup->owner)->symtab_hdr;
3575 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
3576 }
3577 h = elf_sym_hashes (igroup->owner)[symndx - extsymoff];
3578 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
3579 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
3580 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
3581
3582 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.sh_info = h->indx;
3583 }
3584
3585 /* The contents won't be allocated for "ld -r" or objcopy. */
3586 gas = TRUE;
3587 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3588 {
3589 gas = FALSE;
3590 sec->contents = (unsigned char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sec->size);
3591
3592 /* Arrange for the section to be written out. */
3593 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = sec->contents;
3594 if (sec->contents == NULL)
3595 {
3596 *failedptr = TRUE;
3597 return;
3598 }
3599 }
3600
3601 loc = sec->contents + sec->size;
3602
3603 /* Get the pointer to the first section in the group that gas
3604 squirreled away here. objcopy arranges for this to be set to the
3605 start of the input section group. */
3606 first = elt = elf_next_in_group (sec);
3607
3608 /* First element is a flag word. Rest of section is elf section
3609 indices for all the sections of the group. Write them backwards
3610 just to keep the group in the same order as given in .section
3611 directives, not that it matters. */
3612 while (elt != NULL)
3613 {
3614 asection *s;
3615
3616 s = elt;
3617 if (!gas)
3618 s = s->output_section;
3619 if (s != NULL
3620 && !bfd_is_abs_section (s))
3621 {
3622 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
3623 struct bfd_elf_section_data *input_elf_sec = elf_section_data (elt);
3624
3625 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3626 && (gas
3627 || (input_elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
3628 && input_elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3629 {
3630 elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3631 loc -= 4;
3632 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rel.idx, loc);
3633 }
3634 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3635 && (gas
3636 || (input_elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
3637 && input_elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0))
3638 {
3639 elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_GROUP;
3640 loc -= 4;
3641 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->rela.idx, loc);
3642 }
3643 loc -= 4;
3644 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_sec->this_idx, loc);
3645 }
3646 elt = elf_next_in_group (elt);
3647 if (elt == first)
3648 break;
3649 }
3650
3651 loc -= 4;
3652 BFD_ASSERT (loc == sec->contents);
3653
3654 H_PUT_32 (abfd, sec->flags & SEC_LINK_ONCE ? GRP_COMDAT : 0, loc);
3655 }
3656
3657 /* Given NAME, the name of a relocation section stripped of its
3658 .rel/.rela prefix, return the section in ABFD to which the
3659 relocations apply. */
3660
3661 asection *
3662 _bfd_elf_plt_get_reloc_section (bfd *abfd, const char *name)
3663 {
3664 /* If a target needs .got.plt section, relocations in rela.plt/rel.plt
3665 section likely apply to .got.plt or .got section. */
3666 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->want_got_plt
3667 && strcmp (name, ".plt") == 0)
3668 {
3669 asection *sec;
3670
3671 name = ".got.plt";
3672 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3673 if (sec != NULL)
3674 return sec;
3675 name = ".got";
3676 }
3677
3678 return bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name);
3679 }
3680
3681 /* Return the section to which RELOC_SEC applies. */
3682
3683 static asection *
3684 elf_get_reloc_section (asection *reloc_sec)
3685 {
3686 const char *name;
3687 unsigned int type;
3688 bfd *abfd;
3689 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3690
3691 type = elf_section_data (reloc_sec)->this_hdr.sh_type;
3692 if (type != SHT_REL && type != SHT_RELA)
3693 return NULL;
3694
3695 /* We look up the section the relocs apply to by name. */
3696 name = reloc_sec->name;
3697 if (strncmp (name, ".rel", 4) != 0)
3698 return NULL;
3699 name += 4;
3700 if (type == SHT_RELA && *name++ != 'a')
3701 return NULL;
3702
3703 abfd = reloc_sec->owner;
3704 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3705 return bed->get_reloc_section (abfd, name);
3706 }
3707
3708 /* Assign all ELF section numbers. The dummy first section is handled here
3709 too. The link/info pointers for the standard section types are filled
3710 in here too, while we're at it. */
3711
3712 static bfd_boolean
3713 assign_section_numbers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
3714 {
3715 struct elf_obj_tdata *t = elf_tdata (abfd);
3716 asection *sec;
3717 unsigned int section_number;
3718 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
3719 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
3720 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
3721 size_t amt;
3722
3723 section_number = 1;
3724
3725 _bfd_elf_strtab_clear_all_refs (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
3726
3727 /* SHT_GROUP sections are in relocatable files only. */
3728 if (link_info == NULL || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
3729 {
3730 size_t reloc_count = 0;
3731
3732 /* Put SHT_GROUP sections first. */
3733 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
3734 {
3735 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3736
3737 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_GROUP)
3738 {
3739 if (sec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED)
3740 {
3741 /* Remove the linker created SHT_GROUP sections. */
3742 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, sec);
3743 abfd->section_count--;
3744 }
3745 else
3746 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3747 }
3748
3749 /* Count relocations. */
3750 reloc_count += sec->reloc_count;
3751 }
3752
3753 /* Clear HAS_RELOC if there are no relocations. */
3754 if (reloc_count == 0)
3755 abfd->flags &= ~HAS_RELOC;
3756 }
3757
3758 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3759 {
3760 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3761
3762 if (d->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_GROUP)
3763 d->this_idx = section_number++;
3764 if (d->this_hdr.sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3765 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->this_hdr.sh_name);
3766 if (d->rel.hdr)
3767 {
3768 d->rel.idx = section_number++;
3769 if (d->rel.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3770 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rel.hdr->sh_name);
3771 }
3772 else
3773 d->rel.idx = 0;
3774
3775 if (d->rela.hdr)
3776 {
3777 d->rela.idx = section_number++;
3778 if (d->rela.hdr->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
3779 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), d->rela.hdr->sh_name);
3780 }
3781 else
3782 d->rela.idx = 0;
3783 }
3784
3785 need_symtab = (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
3786 || (link_info == NULL
3787 && ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
3788 == HAS_RELOC)));
3789 if (need_symtab)
3790 {
3791 elf_onesymtab (abfd) = section_number++;
3792 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->symtab_hdr.sh_name);
3793 if (section_number > ((SHN_LORESERVE - 2) & 0xFFFF))
3794 {
3795 elf_section_list *entry;
3796
3797 BFD_ASSERT (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) == NULL);
3798
3799 entry = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
3800 entry->ndx = section_number++;
3801 elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) = entry;
3802 entry->hdr.sh_name
3803 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
3804 ".symtab_shndx", FALSE);
3805 if (entry->hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
3806 return FALSE;
3807 }
3808 elf_strtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3809 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->strtab_hdr.sh_name);
3810 }
3811
3812 elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd) = section_number++;
3813 _bfd_elf_strtab_addref (elf_shstrtab (abfd), t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name);
3814 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shstrndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
3815
3816 if (section_number >= SHN_LORESERVE)
3817 {
3818 /* xgettext:c-format */
3819 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: too many sections: %u"),
3820 abfd, section_number);
3821 return FALSE;
3822 }
3823
3824 elf_numsections (abfd) = section_number;
3825 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_shnum = section_number;
3826
3827 /* Set up the list of section header pointers, in agreement with the
3828 indices. */
3829 amt = section_number * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr *);
3830 i_shdrp = (Elf_Internal_Shdr **) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
3831 if (i_shdrp == NULL)
3832 return FALSE;
3833
3834 i_shdrp[0] = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
3835 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Shdr));
3836 if (i_shdrp[0] == NULL)
3837 {
3838 bfd_release (abfd, i_shdrp);
3839 return FALSE;
3840 }
3841
3842 elf_elfsections (abfd) = i_shdrp;
3843
3844 i_shdrp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->shstrtab_hdr;
3845 if (need_symtab)
3846 {
3847 i_shdrp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)] = &t->symtab_hdr;
3848 if (elf_numsections (abfd) > (SHN_LORESERVE & 0xFFFF))
3849 {
3850 elf_section_list * entry = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd);
3851 BFD_ASSERT (entry != NULL);
3852 i_shdrp[entry->ndx] = & entry->hdr;
3853 entry->hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3854 }
3855 i_shdrp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)] = &t->strtab_hdr;
3856 t->symtab_hdr.sh_link = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
3857 }
3858
3859 for (sec = abfd->sections; sec; sec = sec->next)
3860 {
3861 asection *s;
3862
3863 d = elf_section_data (sec);
3864
3865 i_shdrp[d->this_idx] = &d->this_hdr;
3866 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3867 i_shdrp[d->rel.idx] = d->rel.hdr;
3868 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3869 i_shdrp[d->rela.idx] = d->rela.hdr;
3870
3871 /* Fill in the sh_link and sh_info fields while we're at it. */
3872
3873 /* sh_link of a reloc section is the section index of the symbol
3874 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to which
3875 the relocation entries apply. */
3876 if (d->rel.idx != 0)
3877 {
3878 d->rel.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3879 d->rel.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3880 d->rel.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3881 }
3882 if (d->rela.idx != 0)
3883 {
3884 d->rela.hdr->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
3885 d->rela.hdr->sh_info = d->this_idx;
3886 d->rela.hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3887 }
3888
3889 /* We need to set up sh_link for SHF_LINK_ORDER. */
3890 if ((d->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
3891 {
3892 s = elf_linked_to_section (sec);
3893 if (s)
3894 {
3895 /* elf_linked_to_section points to the input section. */
3896 if (link_info != NULL)
3897 {
3898 /* Check discarded linkonce section. */
3899 if (discarded_section (s))
3900 {
3901 asection *kept;
3902 _bfd_error_handler
3903 /* xgettext:c-format */
3904 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3905 " discarded section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3906 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section,
3907 s, s->owner);
3908 /* Point to the kept section if it has the same
3909 size as the discarded one. */
3910 kept = _bfd_elf_check_kept_section (s, link_info);
3911 if (kept == NULL)
3912 {
3913 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3914 return FALSE;
3915 }
3916 s = kept;
3917 }
3918
3919 s = s->output_section;
3920 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3921 }
3922 else
3923 {
3924 /* Handle objcopy. */
3925 if (s->output_section == NULL)
3926 {
3927 _bfd_error_handler
3928 /* xgettext:c-format */
3929 (_("%pB: sh_link of section `%pA' points to"
3930 " removed section `%pA' of `%pB'"),
3931 abfd, d->this_hdr.bfd_section, s, s->owner);
3932 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3933 return FALSE;
3934 }
3935 s = s->output_section;
3936 }
3937 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3938 }
3939 else
3940 {
3941 /* PR 290:
3942 The Intel C compiler generates SHT_IA_64_UNWIND with
3943 SHF_LINK_ORDER. But it doesn't set the sh_link or
3944 sh_info fields. Hence we could get the situation
3945 where s is NULL. */
3946 const struct elf_backend_data *bed
3947 = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
3948 bed->link_order_error_handler
3949 /* xgettext:c-format */
3950 (_("%pB: warning: sh_link not set for section `%pA'"),
3951 abfd, sec);
3952 }
3953 }
3954
3955 switch (d->this_hdr.sh_type)
3956 {
3957 case SHT_REL:
3958 case SHT_RELA:
3959 /* A reloc section which we are treating as a normal BFD
3960 section. sh_link is the section index of the symbol
3961 table. sh_info is the section index of the section to
3962 which the relocation entries apply. We assume that an
3963 allocated reloc section uses the dynamic symbol table.
3964 FIXME: How can we be sure? */
3965 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
3966 if (s != NULL)
3967 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3968
3969 s = elf_get_reloc_section (sec);
3970 if (s != NULL)
3971 {
3972 d->this_hdr.sh_info = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
3973 d->this_hdr.sh_flags |= SHF_INFO_LINK;
3974 }
3975 break;
3976
3977 case SHT_STRTAB:
3978 /* We assume that a section named .stab*str is a stabs
3979 string section. We look for a section with the same name
3980 but without the trailing ``str'', and set its sh_link
3981 field to point to this section. */
3982 if (CONST_STRNEQ (sec->name, ".stab")
3983 && strcmp (sec->name + strlen (sec->name) - 3, "str") == 0)
3984 {
3985 size_t len;
3986 char *alc;
3987
3988 len = strlen (sec->name);
3989 alc = (char *) bfd_malloc (len - 2);
3990 if (alc == NULL)
3991 return FALSE;
3992 memcpy (alc, sec->name, len - 3);
3993 alc[len - 3] = '\0';
3994 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, alc);
3995 free (alc);
3996 if (s != NULL)
3997 {
3998 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link = d->this_idx;
3999
4000 /* This is a .stab section. */
4001 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize == 0)
4002 elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
4003 = 4 + 2 * bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 8;
4004 }
4005 }
4006 break;
4007
4008 case SHT_DYNAMIC:
4009 case SHT_DYNSYM:
4010 case SHT_GNU_verneed:
4011 case SHT_GNU_verdef:
4012 /* sh_link is the section header index of the string table
4013 used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or the
4014 version strings. */
4015 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
4016 if (s != NULL)
4017 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
4018 break;
4019
4020 case SHT_GNU_LIBLIST:
4021 /* sh_link is the section header index of the prelink library
4022 list used for the dynamic entries, or the symbol table, or
4023 the version strings. */
4024 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC)
4025 ? ".dynstr" : ".gnu.libstr");
4026 if (s != NULL)
4027 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
4028 break;
4029
4030 case SHT_HASH:
4031 case SHT_GNU_HASH:
4032 case SHT_GNU_versym:
4033 /* sh_link is the section header index of the symbol table
4034 this hash table or version table is for. */
4035 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
4036 if (s != NULL)
4037 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_section_data (s)->this_idx;
4038 break;
4039
4040 case SHT_GROUP:
4041 d->this_hdr.sh_link = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
4042 }
4043 }
4044
4045 /* Delay setting sh_name to _bfd_elf_write_object_contents so that
4046 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load can convert DWARF
4047 debug section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_* if needed. */
4048
4049 return TRUE;
4050 }
4051
4052 static bfd_boolean
4053 sym_is_global (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
4054 {
4055 /* If the backend has a special mapping, use it. */
4056 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4057 if (bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global)
4058 return (*bed->elf_backend_sym_is_global) (abfd, sym);
4059
4060 return ((sym->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK | BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)) != 0
4061 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_asymbol_section (sym))
4062 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_asymbol_section (sym)));
4063 }
4064
4065 /* Filter global symbols of ABFD to include in the import library. All
4066 SYMCOUNT symbols of ABFD can be examined from their pointers in
4067 SYMS. Pointers of symbols to keep should be stored contiguously at
4068 the beginning of that array.
4069
4070 Returns the number of symbols to keep. */
4071
4072 unsigned int
4073 _bfd_elf_filter_global_symbols (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4074 asymbol **syms, long symcount)
4075 {
4076 long src_count, dst_count = 0;
4077
4078 for (src_count = 0; src_count < symcount; src_count++)
4079 {
4080 asymbol *sym = syms[src_count];
4081 char *name = (char *) bfd_asymbol_name (sym);
4082 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
4083
4084 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4085 continue;
4086
4087 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, name, FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
4088 if (h == NULL)
4089 continue;
4090 if (h->type != bfd_link_hash_defined && h->type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4091 continue;
4092 if (h->linker_def || h->ldscript_def)
4093 continue;
4094
4095 syms[dst_count++] = sym;
4096 }
4097
4098 syms[dst_count] = NULL;
4099
4100 return dst_count;
4101 }
4102
4103 /* Don't output section symbols for sections that are not going to be
4104 output, that are duplicates or there is no BFD section. */
4105
4106 static bfd_boolean
4107 ignore_section_sym (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
4108 {
4109 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
4110
4111 if (sym == NULL)
4112 return FALSE;
4113
4114 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0)
4115 return FALSE;
4116
4117 if (sym->section == NULL)
4118 return TRUE;
4119
4120 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, sym);
4121 return ((type_ptr != NULL
4122 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
4123 && bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4124 || !(sym->section->owner == abfd
4125 || (sym->section->output_section != NULL
4126 && sym->section->output_section->owner == abfd
4127 && sym->section->output_offset == 0)
4128 || bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section)));
4129 }
4130
4131 /* Map symbol from it's internal number to the external number, moving
4132 all local symbols to be at the head of the list. */
4133
4134 static bfd_boolean
4135 elf_map_symbols (bfd *abfd, unsigned int *pnum_locals)
4136 {
4137 unsigned int symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
4138 asymbol **syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
4139 asymbol **sect_syms;
4140 unsigned int num_locals = 0;
4141 unsigned int num_globals = 0;
4142 unsigned int num_locals2 = 0;
4143 unsigned int num_globals2 = 0;
4144 unsigned int max_index = 0;
4145 unsigned int idx;
4146 asection *asect;
4147 asymbol **new_syms;
4148 size_t amt;
4149
4150 #ifdef DEBUG
4151 fprintf (stderr, "elf_map_symbols\n");
4152 fflush (stderr);
4153 #endif
4154
4155 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4156 {
4157 if (max_index < asect->index)
4158 max_index = asect->index;
4159 }
4160
4161 max_index++;
4162 amt = max_index * sizeof (asymbol *);
4163 sect_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4164 if (sect_syms == NULL)
4165 return FALSE;
4166 elf_section_syms (abfd) = sect_syms;
4167 elf_num_section_syms (abfd) = max_index;
4168
4169 /* Init sect_syms entries for any section symbols we have already
4170 decided to output. */
4171 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4172 {
4173 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4174
4175 if ((sym->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0
4176 && sym->value == 0
4177 && !ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym)
4178 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sym->section))
4179 {
4180 asection *sec = sym->section;
4181
4182 if (sec->owner != abfd)
4183 sec = sec->output_section;
4184
4185 sect_syms[sec->index] = syms[idx];
4186 }
4187 }
4188
4189 /* Classify all of the symbols. */
4190 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4191 {
4192 if (sym_is_global (abfd, syms[idx]))
4193 num_globals++;
4194 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, syms[idx]))
4195 num_locals++;
4196 }
4197
4198 /* We will be adding a section symbol for each normal BFD section. Most
4199 sections will already have a section symbol in outsymbols, but
4200 eg. SHT_GROUP sections will not, and we need the section symbol mapped
4201 at least in that case. */
4202 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4203 {
4204 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4205 {
4206 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, asect->symbol))
4207 num_locals++;
4208 else
4209 num_globals++;
4210 }
4211 }
4212
4213 /* Now sort the symbols so the local symbols are first. */
4214 amt = (num_locals + num_globals) * sizeof (asymbol *);
4215 new_syms = (asymbol **) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
4216 if (new_syms == NULL)
4217 return FALSE;
4218
4219 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount; idx++)
4220 {
4221 asymbol *sym = syms[idx];
4222 unsigned int i;
4223
4224 if (sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4225 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4226 else if (!ignore_section_sym (abfd, sym))
4227 i = num_locals2++;
4228 else
4229 continue;
4230 new_syms[i] = sym;
4231 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4232 }
4233 for (asect = abfd->sections; asect; asect = asect->next)
4234 {
4235 if (sect_syms[asect->index] == NULL)
4236 {
4237 asymbol *sym = asect->symbol;
4238 unsigned int i;
4239
4240 sect_syms[asect->index] = sym;
4241 if (!sym_is_global (abfd, sym))
4242 i = num_locals2++;
4243 else
4244 i = num_locals + num_globals2++;
4245 new_syms[i] = sym;
4246 sym->udata.i = i + 1;
4247 }
4248 }
4249
4250 bfd_set_symtab (abfd, new_syms, num_locals + num_globals);
4251
4252 *pnum_locals = num_locals;
4253 return TRUE;
4254 }
4255
4256 /* Align to the maximum file alignment that could be required for any
4257 ELF data structure. */
4258
4259 static inline file_ptr
4260 align_file_position (file_ptr off, int align)
4261 {
4262 return (off + align - 1) & ~(align - 1);
4263 }
4264
4265 /* Assign a file position to a section, optionally aligning to the
4266 required section alignment. */
4267
4268 file_ptr
4269 _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (Elf_Internal_Shdr *i_shdrp,
4270 file_ptr offset,
4271 bfd_boolean align)
4272 {
4273 if (align && i_shdrp->sh_addralign > 1)
4274 offset = BFD_ALIGN (offset, i_shdrp->sh_addralign);
4275 i_shdrp->sh_offset = offset;
4276 if (i_shdrp->bfd_section != NULL)
4277 i_shdrp->bfd_section->filepos = offset;
4278 if (i_shdrp->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
4279 offset += i_shdrp->sh_size;
4280 return offset;
4281 }
4282
4283 /* Compute the file positions we are going to put the sections at, and
4284 otherwise prepare to begin writing out the ELF file. If LINK_INFO
4285 is not NULL, this is being called by the ELF backend linker. */
4286
4287 bfd_boolean
4288 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (bfd *abfd,
4289 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
4290 {
4291 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4292 struct fake_section_arg fsargs;
4293 bfd_boolean failed;
4294 struct elf_strtab_hash *strtab = NULL;
4295 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shstrtab_hdr;
4296 bfd_boolean need_symtab;
4297
4298 if (abfd->output_has_begun)
4299 return TRUE;
4300
4301 /* Do any elf backend specific processing first. */
4302 if (bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing)
4303 (*bed->elf_backend_begin_write_processing) (abfd, link_info);
4304
4305 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_init_file_header) (abfd, link_info))
4306 return FALSE;
4307
4308 fsargs.failed = FALSE;
4309 fsargs.link_info = link_info;
4310 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, elf_fake_sections, &fsargs);
4311 if (fsargs.failed)
4312 return FALSE;
4313
4314 if (!assign_section_numbers (abfd, link_info))
4315 return FALSE;
4316
4317 /* The backend linker builds symbol table information itself. */
4318 need_symtab = (link_info == NULL
4319 && (bfd_get_symcount (abfd) > 0
4320 || ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC | HAS_RELOC))
4321 == HAS_RELOC)));
4322 if (need_symtab)
4323 {
4324 /* Non-zero if doing a relocatable link. */
4325 int relocatable_p = ! (abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC));
4326
4327 if (! swap_out_syms (abfd, &strtab, relocatable_p))
4328 return FALSE;
4329 }
4330
4331 failed = FALSE;
4332 if (link_info == NULL)
4333 {
4334 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bfd_elf_set_group_contents, &failed);
4335 if (failed)
4336 return FALSE;
4337 }
4338
4339 shstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
4340 /* sh_name was set in init_file_header. */
4341 shstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
4342 shstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
4343 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
4344 /* sh_size is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4345 shstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
4346 shstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
4347 shstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
4348 /* sh_offset is set in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load. */
4349 shstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
4350
4351 if (!assign_file_positions_except_relocs (abfd, link_info))
4352 return FALSE;
4353
4354 if (need_symtab)
4355 {
4356 file_ptr off;
4357 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
4358
4359 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
4360
4361 hdr = & elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
4362 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4363
4364 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL)
4365 {
4366 hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
4367 if (hdr->sh_size != 0)
4368 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4369 /* FIXME: What about other symtab_shndx sections in the list ? */
4370 }
4371
4372 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
4373 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
4374
4375 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
4376
4377 /* Now that we know where the .strtab section goes, write it
4378 out. */
4379 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
4380 || ! _bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, strtab))
4381 return FALSE;
4382 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (strtab);
4383 }
4384
4385 abfd->output_has_begun = TRUE;
4386
4387 return TRUE;
4388 }
4389
4390 /* Make an initial estimate of the size of the program header. If we
4391 get the number wrong here, we'll redo section placement. */
4392
4393 static bfd_size_type
4394 get_program_header_size (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4395 {
4396 size_t segs;
4397 asection *s;
4398 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4399
4400 /* Assume we will need exactly two PT_LOAD segments: one for text
4401 and one for data. */
4402 segs = 2;
4403
4404 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4405 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0 && s->size != 0)
4406 {
4407 /* If we have a loadable interpreter section, we need a
4408 PT_INTERP segment. In this case, assume we also need a
4409 PT_PHDR segment, although that may not be true for all
4410 targets. */
4411 segs += 2;
4412 }
4413
4414 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL)
4415 {
4416 /* We need a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4417 ++segs;
4418 }
4419
4420 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
4421 {
4422 /* We need a PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
4423 ++segs;
4424 }
4425
4426 if (elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd))
4427 {
4428 /* We need a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME segment. */
4429 ++segs;
4430 }
4431
4432 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
4433 {
4434 /* We need a PT_GNU_STACK segment. */
4435 ++segs;
4436 }
4437
4438 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
4439 NOTE_GNU_PROPERTY_SECTION_NAME);
4440 if (s != NULL && s->size != 0)
4441 {
4442 /* We need a PT_GNU_PROPERTY segment. */
4443 ++segs;
4444 }
4445
4446 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4447 {
4448 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4449 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE)
4450 {
4451 unsigned int alignment_power;
4452 /* We need a PT_NOTE segment. */
4453 ++segs;
4454 /* Try to create just one PT_NOTE segment for all adjacent
4455 loadable SHT_NOTE sections. gABI requires that within a
4456 PT_NOTE segment (and also inside of each SHT_NOTE section)
4457 each note should have the same alignment. So we check
4458 whether the sections are correctly aligned. */
4459 alignment_power = s->alignment_power;
4460 while (s->next != NULL
4461 && s->next->alignment_power == alignment_power
4462 && (s->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
4463 && elf_section_type (s->next) == SHT_NOTE)
4464 s = s->next;
4465 }
4466 }
4467
4468 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4469 {
4470 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4471 {
4472 /* We need a PT_TLS segment. */
4473 ++segs;
4474 break;
4475 }
4476 }
4477
4478 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4479
4480 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4481 && (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_mbind) != 0)
4482 {
4483 /* Add a PT_GNU_MBIND segment for each mbind section. */
4484 unsigned int page_align_power = bfd_log2 (bed->commonpagesize);
4485 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4486 if (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
4487 {
4488 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info > PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM)
4489 {
4490 _bfd_error_handler
4491 /* xgettext:c-format */
4492 (_("%pB: GNU_MBIND section `%pA' has invalid "
4493 "sh_info field: %d"),
4494 abfd, s, elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
4495 continue;
4496 }
4497 /* Align mbind section to page size. */
4498 if (s->alignment_power < page_align_power)
4499 s->alignment_power = page_align_power;
4500 segs ++;
4501 }
4502 }
4503
4504 /* Let the backend count up any program headers it might need. */
4505 if (bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers)
4506 {
4507 int a;
4508
4509 a = (*bed->elf_backend_additional_program_headers) (abfd, info);
4510 if (a == -1)
4511 abort ();
4512 segs += a;
4513 }
4514
4515 return segs * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
4516 }
4517
4518 /* Find the segment that contains the output_section of section. */
4519
4520 Elf_Internal_Phdr *
4521 _bfd_elf_find_segment_containing_section (bfd * abfd, asection * section)
4522 {
4523 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4524 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
4525
4526 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
4527 m != NULL;
4528 m = m->next, p++)
4529 {
4530 int i;
4531
4532 for (i = m->count - 1; i >= 0; i--)
4533 if (m->sections[i] == section)
4534 return p;
4535 }
4536
4537 return NULL;
4538 }
4539
4540 /* Create a mapping from a set of sections to a program segment. */
4541
4542 static struct elf_segment_map *
4543 make_mapping (bfd *abfd,
4544 asection **sections,
4545 unsigned int from,
4546 unsigned int to,
4547 bfd_boolean phdr)
4548 {
4549 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4550 unsigned int i;
4551 asection **hdrpp;
4552 size_t amt;
4553
4554 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
4555 amt += (to - from) * sizeof (asection *);
4556 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4557 if (m == NULL)
4558 return NULL;
4559 m->next = NULL;
4560 m->p_type = PT_LOAD;
4561 for (i = from, hdrpp = sections + from; i < to; i++, hdrpp++)
4562 m->sections[i - from] = *hdrpp;
4563 m->count = to - from;
4564
4565 if (from == 0 && phdr)
4566 {
4567 /* Include the headers in the first PT_LOAD segment. */
4568 m->includes_filehdr = 1;
4569 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4570 }
4571
4572 return m;
4573 }
4574
4575 /* Create the PT_DYNAMIC segment, which includes DYNSEC. Returns NULL
4576 on failure. */
4577
4578 struct elf_segment_map *
4579 _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (bfd *abfd, asection *dynsec)
4580 {
4581 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4582
4583 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd,
4584 sizeof (struct elf_segment_map));
4585 if (m == NULL)
4586 return NULL;
4587 m->next = NULL;
4588 m->p_type = PT_DYNAMIC;
4589 m->count = 1;
4590 m->sections[0] = dynsec;
4591
4592 return m;
4593 }
4594
4595 /* Possibly add or remove segments from the segment map. */
4596
4597 static bfd_boolean
4598 elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
4599 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4600 bfd_boolean remove_empty_load)
4601 {
4602 struct elf_segment_map **m;
4603 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
4604
4605 /* The placement algorithm assumes that non allocated sections are
4606 not in PT_LOAD segments. We ensure this here by removing such
4607 sections from the segment map. We also remove excluded
4608 sections. Finally, any PT_LOAD segment without sections is
4609 removed. */
4610 m = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
4611 while (*m)
4612 {
4613 unsigned int i, new_count;
4614
4615 for (new_count = 0, i = 0; i < (*m)->count; i++)
4616 {
4617 if (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
4618 && (((*m)->sections[i]->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
4619 || (*m)->p_type != PT_LOAD))
4620 {
4621 (*m)->sections[new_count] = (*m)->sections[i];
4622 new_count++;
4623 }
4624 }
4625 (*m)->count = new_count;
4626
4627 if (remove_empty_load
4628 && (*m)->p_type == PT_LOAD
4629 && (*m)->count == 0
4630 && !(*m)->includes_phdrs)
4631 *m = (*m)->next;
4632 else
4633 m = &(*m)->next;
4634 }
4635
4636 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4637 if (bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map != NULL)
4638 {
4639 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_segment_map) (abfd, info))
4640 return FALSE;
4641 }
4642
4643 return TRUE;
4644 }
4645
4646 #define IS_TBSS(s) \
4647 ((s->flags & (SEC_THREAD_LOCAL | SEC_LOAD)) == SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
4648
4649 /* Set up a mapping from BFD sections to program segments. */
4650
4651 bfd_boolean
4652 _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4653 {
4654 unsigned int count;
4655 struct elf_segment_map *m;
4656 asection **sections = NULL;
4657 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
4658 bfd_boolean no_user_phdrs;
4659
4660 no_user_phdrs = elf_seg_map (abfd) == NULL;
4661
4662 if (info != NULL)
4663 info->user_phdrs = !no_user_phdrs;
4664
4665 if (no_user_phdrs && bfd_count_sections (abfd) != 0)
4666 {
4667 asection *s;
4668 unsigned int i;
4669 struct elf_segment_map *mfirst;
4670 struct elf_segment_map **pm;
4671 asection *last_hdr;
4672 bfd_vma last_size;
4673 unsigned int hdr_index;
4674 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
4675 asection **hdrpp;
4676 bfd_boolean phdr_in_segment;
4677 bfd_boolean writable;
4678 bfd_boolean executable;
4679 unsigned int tls_count = 0;
4680 asection *first_tls = NULL;
4681 asection *first_mbind = NULL;
4682 asection *dynsec, *eh_frame_hdr;
4683 size_t amt;
4684 bfd_vma addr_mask, wrap_to = 0; /* Bytes. */
4685 bfd_size_type phdr_size; /* Octets/bytes. */
4686 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
4687
4688 /* Select the allocated sections, and sort them. */
4689
4690 amt = bfd_count_sections (abfd) * sizeof (asection *);
4691 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc (amt);
4692 if (sections == NULL)
4693 goto error_return;
4694
4695 /* Calculate top address, avoiding undefined behaviour of shift
4696 left operator when shift count is equal to size of type
4697 being shifted. */
4698 addr_mask = ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) - 1)) - 1;
4699 addr_mask = (addr_mask << 1) + 1;
4700
4701 i = 0;
4702 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
4703 {
4704 if ((s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
4705 {
4706 /* target_index is unused until bfd_elf_final_link
4707 starts output of section symbols. Use it to make
4708 qsort stable. */
4709 s->target_index = i;
4710 sections[i] = s;
4711 ++i;
4712 /* A wrapping section potentially clashes with header. */
4713 if (((s->lma + s->size / opb) & addr_mask) < (s->lma & addr_mask))
4714 wrap_to = (s->lma + s->size / opb) & addr_mask;
4715 }
4716 }
4717 BFD_ASSERT (i <= bfd_count_sections (abfd));
4718 count = i;
4719
4720 qsort (sections, (size_t) count, sizeof (asection *), elf_sort_sections);
4721
4722 phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
4723 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
4724 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
4725 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
4726 /* phdr_size is compared to LMA values which are in bytes. */
4727 phdr_size /= opb;
4728 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
4729 if (maxpagesize == 0)
4730 maxpagesize = 1;
4731 phdr_in_segment = info != NULL && info->load_phdrs;
4732 if (count != 0
4733 && (((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) & (maxpagesize - 1))
4734 >= (phdr_size & (maxpagesize - 1))))
4735 /* For compatibility with old scripts that may not be using
4736 SIZEOF_HEADERS, add headers when it looks like space has
4737 been left for them. */
4738 phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4739
4740 /* Build the mapping. */
4741 mfirst = NULL;
4742 pm = &mfirst;
4743
4744 /* If we have a .interp section, then create a PT_PHDR segment for
4745 the program headers and a PT_INTERP segment for the .interp
4746 section. */
4747 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp");
4748 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0 && s->size != 0)
4749 {
4750 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4751 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4752 if (m == NULL)
4753 goto error_return;
4754 m->next = NULL;
4755 m->p_type = PT_PHDR;
4756 m->p_flags = PF_R;
4757 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
4758 m->includes_phdrs = 1;
4759 phdr_in_segment = TRUE;
4760 *pm = m;
4761 pm = &m->next;
4762
4763 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
4764 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
4765 if (m == NULL)
4766 goto error_return;
4767 m->next = NULL;
4768 m->p_type = PT_INTERP;
4769 m->count = 1;
4770 m->sections[0] = s;
4771
4772 *pm = m;
4773 pm = &m->next;
4774 }
4775
4776 /* Look through the sections. We put sections in the same program
4777 segment when the start of the second section can be placed within
4778 a few bytes of the end of the first section. */
4779 last_hdr = NULL;
4780 last_size = 0;
4781 hdr_index = 0;
4782 writable = FALSE;
4783 executable = FALSE;
4784 dynsec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
4785 if (dynsec != NULL
4786 && (dynsec->flags & SEC_LOAD) == 0)
4787 dynsec = NULL;
4788
4789 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4790 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4791
4792 /* Deal with -Ttext or something similar such that the first section
4793 is not adjacent to the program headers. This is an
4794 approximation, since at this point we don't know exactly how many
4795 program headers we will need. */
4796 if (phdr_in_segment && count > 0)
4797 {
4798 bfd_vma phdr_lma; /* Bytes. */
4799 bfd_boolean separate_phdr = FALSE;
4800
4801 phdr_lma = (sections[0]->lma - phdr_size) & addr_mask & -maxpagesize;
4802 if (info != NULL
4803 && info->separate_code
4804 && (sections[0]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4805 {
4806 /* If data sections should be separate from code and
4807 thus not executable, and the first section is
4808 executable then put the file and program headers in
4809 their own PT_LOAD. */
4810 separate_phdr = TRUE;
4811 if ((((phdr_lma + phdr_size - 1) & addr_mask & -maxpagesize)
4812 == (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask & -maxpagesize)))
4813 {
4814 /* The file and program headers are currently on the
4815 same page as the first section. Put them on the
4816 previous page if we can. */
4817 if (phdr_lma >= maxpagesize)
4818 phdr_lma -= maxpagesize;
4819 else
4820 separate_phdr = FALSE;
4821 }
4822 }
4823 if ((sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_lma
4824 || (sections[0]->lma & addr_mask) < phdr_size)
4825 /* If file and program headers would be placed at the end
4826 of memory then it's probably better to omit them. */
4827 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4828 else if (phdr_lma < wrap_to)
4829 /* If a section wraps around to where we'll be placing
4830 file and program headers, then the headers will be
4831 overwritten. */
4832 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4833 else if (separate_phdr)
4834 {
4835 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, 0, 0, phdr_in_segment);
4836 if (m == NULL)
4837 goto error_return;
4838 m->p_paddr = phdr_lma * opb;
4839 m->p_vaddr_offset
4840 = (sections[0]->vma - phdr_size) & addr_mask & -maxpagesize;
4841 m->p_paddr_valid = 1;
4842 *pm = m;
4843 pm = &m->next;
4844 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4845 }
4846 }
4847
4848 for (i = 0, hdrpp = sections; i < count; i++, hdrpp++)
4849 {
4850 asection *hdr;
4851 bfd_boolean new_segment;
4852
4853 hdr = *hdrpp;
4854
4855 /* See if this section and the last one will fit in the same
4856 segment. */
4857
4858 if (last_hdr == NULL)
4859 {
4860 /* If we don't have a segment yet, then we don't need a new
4861 one (we build the last one after this loop). */
4862 new_segment = FALSE;
4863 }
4864 else if (last_hdr->lma - last_hdr->vma != hdr->lma - hdr->vma)
4865 {
4866 /* If this section has a different relation between the
4867 virtual address and the load address, then we need a new
4868 segment. */
4869 new_segment = TRUE;
4870 }
4871 else if (hdr->lma < last_hdr->lma + last_size
4872 || last_hdr->lma + last_size < last_hdr->lma)
4873 {
4874 /* If this section has a load address that makes it overlap
4875 the previous section, then we need a new segment. */
4876 new_segment = TRUE;
4877 }
4878 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
4879 && (((last_hdr->lma + last_size - 1) & -maxpagesize)
4880 == (hdr->lma & -maxpagesize)))
4881 {
4882 /* If we are demand paged then we can't map two disk
4883 pages onto the same memory page. */
4884 new_segment = FALSE;
4885 }
4886 /* In the next test we have to be careful when last_hdr->lma is close
4887 to the end of the address space. If the aligned address wraps
4888 around to the start of the address space, then there are no more
4889 pages left in memory and it is OK to assume that the current
4890 section can be included in the current segment. */
4891 else if ((BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4892 + maxpagesize > last_hdr->lma)
4893 && (BFD_ALIGN (last_hdr->lma + last_size, maxpagesize)
4894 + maxpagesize <= hdr->lma))
4895 {
4896 /* If putting this section in this segment would force us to
4897 skip a page in the segment, then we need a new segment. */
4898 new_segment = TRUE;
4899 }
4900 else if ((last_hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0
4901 && (hdr->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) != 0)
4902 {
4903 /* We don't want to put a loaded section after a
4904 nonloaded (ie. bss style) section in the same segment
4905 as that will force the non-loaded section to be loaded.
4906 Consider .tbss sections as loaded for this purpose. */
4907 new_segment = TRUE;
4908 }
4909 else if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0)
4910 {
4911 /* If the file is not demand paged, which means that we
4912 don't require the sections to be correctly aligned in the
4913 file, then there is no other reason for a new segment. */
4914 new_segment = FALSE;
4915 }
4916 else if (info != NULL
4917 && info->separate_code
4918 && executable != ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0))
4919 {
4920 new_segment = TRUE;
4921 }
4922 else if (! writable
4923 && (hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4924 {
4925 /* We don't want to put a writable section in a read only
4926 segment. */
4927 new_segment = TRUE;
4928 }
4929 else
4930 {
4931 /* Otherwise, we can use the same segment. */
4932 new_segment = FALSE;
4933 }
4934
4935 /* Allow interested parties a chance to override our decision. */
4936 if (last_hdr != NULL
4937 && info != NULL
4938 && info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment != NULL)
4939 new_segment
4940 = info->callbacks->override_segment_assignment (info, abfd, hdr,
4941 last_hdr,
4942 new_segment);
4943
4944 if (! new_segment)
4945 {
4946 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4947 writable = TRUE;
4948 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
4949 executable = TRUE;
4950 last_hdr = hdr;
4951 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4952 last_size = (!IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0) / opb;
4953 continue;
4954 }
4955
4956 /* We need a new program segment. We must create a new program
4957 header holding all the sections from hdr_index until hdr. */
4958
4959 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, hdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4960 if (m == NULL)
4961 goto error_return;
4962
4963 *pm = m;
4964 pm = &m->next;
4965
4966 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
4967 writable = TRUE;
4968 else
4969 writable = FALSE;
4970
4971 if ((hdr->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
4972 executable = FALSE;
4973 else
4974 executable = TRUE;
4975
4976 last_hdr = hdr;
4977 /* .tbss sections effectively have zero size. */
4978 last_size = (!IS_TBSS (hdr) ? hdr->size : 0) / opb;
4979 hdr_index = i;
4980 phdr_in_segment = FALSE;
4981 }
4982
4983 /* Create a final PT_LOAD program segment, but not if it's just
4984 for .tbss. */
4985 if (last_hdr != NULL
4986 && (i - hdr_index != 1
4987 || !IS_TBSS (last_hdr)))
4988 {
4989 m = make_mapping (abfd, sections, hdr_index, i, phdr_in_segment);
4990 if (m == NULL)
4991 goto error_return;
4992
4993 *pm = m;
4994 pm = &m->next;
4995 }
4996
4997 /* If there is a .dynamic section, throw in a PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
4998 if (dynsec != NULL)
4999 {
5000 m = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_segment (abfd, dynsec);
5001 if (m == NULL)
5002 goto error_return;
5003 *pm = m;
5004 pm = &m->next;
5005 }
5006
5007 /* For each batch of consecutive loadable SHT_NOTE sections,
5008 add a PT_NOTE segment. We don't use bfd_get_section_by_name,
5009 because if we link together nonloadable .note sections and
5010 loadable .note sections, we will generate two .note sections
5011 in the output file. */
5012 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5013 {
5014 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
5015 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE)
5016 {
5017 asection *s2;
5018 unsigned int alignment_power = s->alignment_power;
5019
5020 count = 1;
5021 for (s2 = s; s2->next != NULL; s2 = s2->next)
5022 {
5023 if (s2->next->alignment_power == alignment_power
5024 && (s2->next->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
5025 && elf_section_type (s2->next) == SHT_NOTE
5026 && align_power (s2->lma + s2->size / opb,
5027 alignment_power)
5028 == s2->next->lma)
5029 count++;
5030 else
5031 break;
5032 }
5033 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
5034 amt += count * sizeof (asection *);
5035 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5036 if (m == NULL)
5037 goto error_return;
5038 m->next = NULL;
5039 m->p_type = PT_NOTE;
5040 m->count = count;
5041 while (count > 1)
5042 {
5043 m->sections[m->count - count--] = s;
5044 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
5045 s = s->next;
5046 }
5047 m->sections[m->count - 1] = s;
5048 BFD_ASSERT ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0);
5049 *pm = m;
5050 pm = &m->next;
5051 }
5052 if (s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
5053 {
5054 if (! tls_count)
5055 first_tls = s;
5056 tls_count++;
5057 }
5058 if (first_mbind == NULL
5059 && (elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0)
5060 first_mbind = s;
5061 }
5062
5063 /* If there are any SHF_TLS output sections, add PT_TLS segment. */
5064 if (tls_count > 0)
5065 {
5066 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
5067 amt += tls_count * sizeof (asection *);
5068 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5069 if (m == NULL)
5070 goto error_return;
5071 m->next = NULL;
5072 m->p_type = PT_TLS;
5073 m->count = tls_count;
5074 /* Mandated PF_R. */
5075 m->p_flags = PF_R;
5076 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5077 s = first_tls;
5078 for (i = 0; i < tls_count; ++i)
5079 {
5080 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0)
5081 {
5082 _bfd_error_handler
5083 (_("%pB: TLS sections are not adjacent:"), abfd);
5084 s = first_tls;
5085 i = 0;
5086 while (i < tls_count)
5087 {
5088 if ((s->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
5089 {
5090 _bfd_error_handler (_(" TLS: %pA"), s);
5091 i++;
5092 }
5093 else
5094 _bfd_error_handler (_(" non-TLS: %pA"), s);
5095 s = s->next;
5096 }
5097 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5098 goto error_return;
5099 }
5100 m->sections[i] = s;
5101 s = s->next;
5102 }
5103
5104 *pm = m;
5105 pm = &m->next;
5106 }
5107
5108 if (first_mbind
5109 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
5110 && (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_mbind) != 0)
5111 for (s = first_mbind; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5112 if ((elf_section_flags (s) & SHF_GNU_MBIND) != 0
5113 && elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info <= PT_GNU_MBIND_NUM)
5114 {
5115 /* Mandated PF_R. */
5116 unsigned long p_flags = PF_R;
5117 if ((s->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
5118 p_flags |= PF_W;
5119 if ((s->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
5120 p_flags |= PF_X;
5121
5122 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) + sizeof (asection *);
5123 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5124 if (m == NULL)
5125 goto error_return;
5126 m->next = NULL;
5127 m->p_type = (PT_GNU_MBIND_LO
5128 + elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_info);
5129 m->count = 1;
5130 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5131 m->sections[0] = s;
5132 m->p_flags = p_flags;
5133
5134 *pm = m;
5135 pm = &m->next;
5136 }
5137
5138 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
5139 NOTE_GNU_PROPERTY_SECTION_NAME);
5140 if (s != NULL && s->size != 0)
5141 {
5142 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) + sizeof (asection *);
5143 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5144 if (m == NULL)
5145 goto error_return;
5146 m->next = NULL;
5147 m->p_type = PT_GNU_PROPERTY;
5148 m->count = 1;
5149 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5150 m->sections[0] = s;
5151 m->p_flags = PF_R;
5152 *pm = m;
5153 pm = &m->next;
5154 }
5155
5156 /* If there is a .eh_frame_hdr section, throw in a PT_GNU_EH_FRAME
5157 segment. */
5158 eh_frame_hdr = elf_eh_frame_hdr (abfd);
5159 if (eh_frame_hdr != NULL
5160 && (eh_frame_hdr->output_section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
5161 {
5162 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5163 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5164 if (m == NULL)
5165 goto error_return;
5166 m->next = NULL;
5167 m->p_type = PT_GNU_EH_FRAME;
5168 m->count = 1;
5169 m->sections[0] = eh_frame_hdr->output_section;
5170
5171 *pm = m;
5172 pm = &m->next;
5173 }
5174
5175 if (elf_stack_flags (abfd))
5176 {
5177 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5178 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5179 if (m == NULL)
5180 goto error_return;
5181 m->next = NULL;
5182 m->p_type = PT_GNU_STACK;
5183 m->p_flags = elf_stack_flags (abfd);
5184 m->p_align = bed->stack_align;
5185 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
5186 m->p_align_valid = m->p_align != 0;
5187 if (info->stacksize > 0)
5188 {
5189 m->p_size = info->stacksize;
5190 m->p_size_valid = 1;
5191 }
5192
5193 *pm = m;
5194 pm = &m->next;
5195 }
5196
5197 if (info != NULL && info->relro)
5198 {
5199 for (m = mfirst; m != NULL; m = m->next)
5200 {
5201 if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD
5202 && m->count != 0
5203 && m->sections[0]->vma >= info->relro_start
5204 && m->sections[0]->vma < info->relro_end)
5205 {
5206 i = m->count;
5207 while (--i != (unsigned) -1)
5208 {
5209 if (m->sections[i]->size > 0
5210 && (m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5211 == (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS))
5212 break;
5213 }
5214
5215 if (i != (unsigned) -1)
5216 break;
5217 }
5218 }
5219
5220 /* Make a PT_GNU_RELRO segment only when it isn't empty. */
5221 if (m != NULL)
5222 {
5223 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
5224 m = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
5225 if (m == NULL)
5226 goto error_return;
5227 m->next = NULL;
5228 m->p_type = PT_GNU_RELRO;
5229 *pm = m;
5230 pm = &m->next;
5231 }
5232 }
5233
5234 free (sections);
5235 elf_seg_map (abfd) = mfirst;
5236 }
5237
5238 if (!elf_modify_segment_map (abfd, info, no_user_phdrs))
5239 return FALSE;
5240
5241 for (count = 0, m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5242 ++count;
5243 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = count * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5244
5245 return TRUE;
5246
5247 error_return:
5248 if (sections != NULL)
5249 free (sections);
5250 return FALSE;
5251 }
5252
5253 /* Sort sections by address. */
5254
5255 static int
5256 elf_sort_sections (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
5257 {
5258 const asection *sec1 = *(const asection **) arg1;
5259 const asection *sec2 = *(const asection **) arg2;
5260 bfd_size_type size1, size2;
5261
5262 /* Sort by LMA first, since this is the address used to
5263 place the section into a segment. */
5264 if (sec1->lma < sec2->lma)
5265 return -1;
5266 else if (sec1->lma > sec2->lma)
5267 return 1;
5268
5269 /* Then sort by VMA. Normally the LMA and the VMA will be
5270 the same, and this will do nothing. */
5271 if (sec1->vma < sec2->vma)
5272 return -1;
5273 else if (sec1->vma > sec2->vma)
5274 return 1;
5275
5276 /* Put !SEC_LOAD sections after SEC_LOAD ones. */
5277
5278 #define TOEND(x) (((x)->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) == 0)
5279
5280 if (TOEND (sec1))
5281 {
5282 if (!TOEND (sec2))
5283 return 1;
5284 }
5285 else if (TOEND (sec2))
5286 return -1;
5287
5288 #undef TOEND
5289
5290 /* Sort by size, to put zero sized sections
5291 before others at the same address. */
5292
5293 size1 = (sec1->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec1->size : 0;
5294 size2 = (sec2->flags & SEC_LOAD) ? sec2->size : 0;
5295
5296 if (size1 < size2)
5297 return -1;
5298 if (size1 > size2)
5299 return 1;
5300
5301 return sec1->target_index - sec2->target_index;
5302 }
5303
5304 /* This qsort comparison functions sorts PT_LOAD segments first and
5305 by p_paddr, for assign_file_positions_for_load_sections. */
5306
5307 static int
5308 elf_sort_segments (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
5309 {
5310 const struct elf_segment_map *m1 = *(const struct elf_segment_map **) arg1;
5311 const struct elf_segment_map *m2 = *(const struct elf_segment_map **) arg2;
5312
5313 if (m1->p_type != m2->p_type)
5314 {
5315 if (m1->p_type == PT_NULL)
5316 return 1;
5317 if (m2->p_type == PT_NULL)
5318 return -1;
5319 return m1->p_type < m2->p_type ? -1 : 1;
5320 }
5321 if (m1->includes_filehdr != m2->includes_filehdr)
5322 return m1->includes_filehdr ? -1 : 1;
5323 if (m1->no_sort_lma != m2->no_sort_lma)
5324 return m1->no_sort_lma ? -1 : 1;
5325 if (m1->p_type == PT_LOAD && !m1->no_sort_lma)
5326 {
5327 bfd_vma lma1, lma2; /* Octets. */
5328 lma1 = 0;
5329 if (m1->p_paddr_valid)
5330 lma1 = m1->p_paddr;
5331 else if (m1->count != 0)
5332 {
5333 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (m1->sections[0]->owner,
5334 m1->sections[0]);
5335 lma1 = (m1->sections[0]->lma + m1->p_vaddr_offset) * opb;
5336 }
5337 lma2 = 0;
5338 if (m2->p_paddr_valid)
5339 lma2 = m2->p_paddr;
5340 else if (m2->count != 0)
5341 {
5342 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (m2->sections[0]->owner,
5343 m2->sections[0]);
5344 lma2 = (m2->sections[0]->lma + m2->p_vaddr_offset) * opb;
5345 }
5346 if (lma1 != lma2)
5347 return lma1 < lma2 ? -1 : 1;
5348 }
5349 if (m1->idx != m2->idx)
5350 return m1->idx < m2->idx ? -1 : 1;
5351 return 0;
5352 }
5353
5354 /* Ian Lance Taylor writes:
5355
5356 We shouldn't be using % with a negative signed number. That's just
5357 not good. We have to make sure either that the number is not
5358 negative, or that the number has an unsigned type. When the types
5359 are all the same size they wind up as unsigned. When file_ptr is a
5360 larger signed type, the arithmetic winds up as signed long long,
5361 which is wrong.
5362
5363 What we're trying to say here is something like ``increase OFF by
5364 the least amount that will cause it to be equal to the VMA modulo
5365 the page size.'' */
5366 /* In other words, something like:
5367
5368 vma_offset = m->sections[0]->vma % bed->maxpagesize;
5369 off_offset = off % bed->maxpagesize;
5370 if (vma_offset < off_offset)
5371 adjustment = vma_offset + bed->maxpagesize - off_offset;
5372 else
5373 adjustment = vma_offset - off_offset;
5374
5375 which can be collapsed into the expression below. */
5376
5377 static file_ptr
5378 vma_page_aligned_bias (bfd_vma vma, ufile_ptr off, bfd_vma maxpagesize)
5379 {
5380 /* PR binutils/16199: Handle an alignment of zero. */
5381 if (maxpagesize == 0)
5382 maxpagesize = 1;
5383 return ((vma - off) % maxpagesize);
5384 }
5385
5386 static void
5387 print_segment_map (const struct elf_segment_map *m)
5388 {
5389 unsigned int j;
5390 const char *pt = get_segment_type (m->p_type);
5391 char buf[32];
5392
5393 if (pt == NULL)
5394 {
5395 if (m->p_type >= PT_LOPROC && m->p_type <= PT_HIPROC)
5396 sprintf (buf, "LOPROC+%7.7x",
5397 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOPROC));
5398 else if (m->p_type >= PT_LOOS && m->p_type <= PT_HIOS)
5399 sprintf (buf, "LOOS+%7.7x",
5400 (unsigned int) (m->p_type - PT_LOOS));
5401 else
5402 snprintf (buf, sizeof (buf), "%8.8x",
5403 (unsigned int) m->p_type);
5404 pt = buf;
5405 }
5406 fflush (stdout);
5407 fprintf (stderr, "%s:", pt);
5408 for (j = 0; j < m->count; j++)
5409 fprintf (stderr, " %s", m->sections [j]->name);
5410 putc ('\n',stderr);
5411 fflush (stderr);
5412 }
5413
5414 static bfd_boolean
5415 write_zeros (bfd *abfd, file_ptr pos, bfd_size_type len)
5416 {
5417 void *buf;
5418 bfd_boolean ret;
5419
5420 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0)
5421 return FALSE;
5422 buf = bfd_zmalloc (len);
5423 if (buf == NULL)
5424 return FALSE;
5425 ret = bfd_bwrite (buf, len, abfd) == len;
5426 free (buf);
5427 return ret;
5428 }
5429
5430 /* Assign file positions to the sections based on the mapping from
5431 sections to segments. This function also sets up some fields in
5432 the file header. */
5433
5434 static bfd_boolean
5435 assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
5436 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
5437 {
5438 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
5439 struct elf_segment_map *m;
5440 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_load_seg;
5441 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
5442 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
5443 file_ptr off; /* Octets. */
5444 bfd_size_type maxpagesize;
5445 unsigned int alloc, actual;
5446 unsigned int i, j;
5447 struct elf_segment_map **sorted_seg_map;
5448 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
5449
5450 if (link_info == NULL
5451 && !_bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments (abfd, link_info))
5452 return FALSE;
5453
5454 alloc = 0;
5455 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
5456 m->idx = alloc++;
5457
5458 if (alloc)
5459 {
5460 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5461 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5462 }
5463 else
5464 {
5465 /* PR binutils/12467. */
5466 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = 0;
5467 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phentsize = 0;
5468 }
5469
5470 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum = alloc;
5471
5472 if (elf_program_header_size (abfd) == (bfd_size_type) -1)
5473 {
5474 actual = alloc;
5475 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = alloc * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5476 }
5477 else
5478 {
5479 actual = elf_program_header_size (abfd) / bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5480 BFD_ASSERT (elf_program_header_size (abfd)
5481 == actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr);
5482 BFD_ASSERT (actual >= alloc);
5483 }
5484
5485 if (alloc == 0)
5486 {
5487 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5488 return TRUE;
5489 }
5490
5491 /* We're writing the size in elf_program_header_size (abfd),
5492 see assign_file_positions_except_relocs, so make sure we have
5493 that amount allocated, with trailing space cleared.
5494 The variable alloc contains the computed need, while
5495 elf_program_header_size (abfd) contains the size used for the
5496 layout.
5497 See ld/emultempl/elf-generic.em:gld${EMULATION_NAME}_map_segments
5498 where the layout is forced to according to a larger size in the
5499 last iterations for the testcase ld-elf/header. */
5500 phdrs = bfd_zalloc (abfd, (actual * sizeof (*phdrs)
5501 + alloc * sizeof (*sorted_seg_map)));
5502 sorted_seg_map = (struct elf_segment_map **) (phdrs + actual);
5503 elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr = phdrs;
5504 if (phdrs == NULL)
5505 return FALSE;
5506
5507 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), j = 0; m != NULL; m = m->next, j++)
5508 {
5509 sorted_seg_map[j] = m;
5510 /* If elf_segment_map is not from map_sections_to_segments, the
5511 sections may not be correctly ordered. NOTE: sorting should
5512 not be done to the PT_NOTE section of a corefile, which may
5513 contain several pseudo-sections artificially created by bfd.
5514 Sorting these pseudo-sections breaks things badly. */
5515 if (m->count > 1
5516 && !(elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_type == ET_CORE
5517 && m->p_type == PT_NOTE))
5518 {
5519 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5520 m->sections[i]->target_index = i;
5521 qsort (m->sections, (size_t) m->count, sizeof (asection *),
5522 elf_sort_sections);
5523 }
5524 }
5525 if (alloc > 1)
5526 qsort (sorted_seg_map, alloc, sizeof (*sorted_seg_map),
5527 elf_sort_segments);
5528
5529 maxpagesize = 1;
5530 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5531 maxpagesize = bed->maxpagesize;
5532
5533 /* Sections must map to file offsets past the ELF file header. */
5534 off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5535 /* And if one of the PT_LOAD headers doesn't include the program
5536 headers then we'll be mapping program headers in the usual
5537 position after the ELF file header. */
5538 phdr_load_seg = NULL;
5539 for (j = 0; j < alloc; j++)
5540 {
5541 m = sorted_seg_map[j];
5542 if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD)
5543 break;
5544 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5545 {
5546 phdr_load_seg = m;
5547 break;
5548 }
5549 }
5550 if (phdr_load_seg == NULL)
5551 off += actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5552
5553 for (j = 0; j < alloc; j++)
5554 {
5555 asection **secpp;
5556 bfd_vma off_adjust; /* Octets. */
5557 bfd_boolean no_contents;
5558
5559 /* An ELF segment (described by Elf_Internal_Phdr) may contain a
5560 number of sections with contents contributing to both p_filesz
5561 and p_memsz, followed by a number of sections with no contents
5562 that just contribute to p_memsz. In this loop, OFF tracks next
5563 available file offset for PT_LOAD and PT_NOTE segments. */
5564 m = sorted_seg_map[j];
5565 p = phdrs + m->idx;
5566 p->p_type = m->p_type;
5567 p->p_flags = m->p_flags;
5568
5569 if (m->count == 0)
5570 p->p_vaddr = m->p_vaddr_offset * opb;
5571 else
5572 p->p_vaddr = (m->sections[0]->vma + m->p_vaddr_offset) * opb;
5573
5574 if (m->p_paddr_valid)
5575 p->p_paddr = m->p_paddr;
5576 else if (m->count == 0)
5577 p->p_paddr = 0;
5578 else
5579 p->p_paddr = (m->sections[0]->lma + m->p_vaddr_offset) * opb;
5580
5581 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5582 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0)
5583 {
5584 /* p_align in demand paged PT_LOAD segments effectively stores
5585 the maximum page size. When copying an executable with
5586 objcopy, we set m->p_align from the input file. Use this
5587 value for maxpagesize rather than bed->maxpagesize, which
5588 may be different. Note that we use maxpagesize for PT_TLS
5589 segment alignment later in this function, so we are relying
5590 on at least one PT_LOAD segment appearing before a PT_TLS
5591 segment. */
5592 if (m->p_align_valid)
5593 maxpagesize = m->p_align;
5594
5595 p->p_align = maxpagesize;
5596 }
5597 else if (m->p_align_valid)
5598 p->p_align = m->p_align;
5599 else if (m->count == 0)
5600 p->p_align = 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
5601
5602 if (m == phdr_load_seg)
5603 {
5604 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5605 p->p_offset = off;
5606 off += actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5607 }
5608
5609 no_contents = FALSE;
5610 off_adjust = 0;
5611 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5612 && m->count > 0)
5613 {
5614 bfd_size_type align; /* Bytes. */
5615 unsigned int align_power = 0;
5616
5617 if (m->p_align_valid)
5618 align = p->p_align;
5619 else
5620 {
5621 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5622 {
5623 unsigned int secalign;
5624
5625 secalign = bfd_section_alignment (*secpp);
5626 if (secalign > align_power)
5627 align_power = secalign;
5628 }
5629 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << align_power;
5630 if (align < maxpagesize)
5631 align = maxpagesize;
5632 }
5633
5634 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5635 if ((m->sections[i]->flags & (SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS)) == 0)
5636 /* If we aren't making room for this section, then
5637 it must be SHT_NOBITS regardless of what we've
5638 set via struct bfd_elf_special_section. */
5639 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOBITS;
5640
5641 /* Find out whether this segment contains any loadable
5642 sections. */
5643 no_contents = TRUE;
5644 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5645 if (elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) != SHT_NOBITS)
5646 {
5647 no_contents = FALSE;
5648 break;
5649 }
5650
5651 off_adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (p->p_vaddr, off, align * opb);
5652
5653 /* Broken hardware and/or kernel require that files do not
5654 map the same page with different permissions on some hppa
5655 processors. */
5656 if (j != 0
5657 && (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0
5658 && bed->no_page_alias
5659 && (off & (maxpagesize - 1)) != 0
5660 && ((off & -maxpagesize)
5661 == ((off + off_adjust) & -maxpagesize)))
5662 off_adjust += maxpagesize;
5663 off += off_adjust;
5664 if (no_contents)
5665 {
5666 /* We shouldn't need to align the segment on disk since
5667 the segment doesn't need file space, but the gABI
5668 arguably requires the alignment and glibc ld.so
5669 checks it. So to comply with the alignment
5670 requirement but not waste file space, we adjust
5671 p_offset for just this segment. (OFF_ADJUST is
5672 subtracted from OFF later.) This may put p_offset
5673 past the end of file, but that shouldn't matter. */
5674 }
5675 else
5676 off_adjust = 0;
5677 }
5678 /* Make sure the .dynamic section is the first section in the
5679 PT_DYNAMIC segment. */
5680 else if (p->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC
5681 && m->count > 1
5682 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") != 0)
5683 {
5684 _bfd_error_handler
5685 (_("%pB: The first section in the PT_DYNAMIC segment"
5686 " is not the .dynamic section"),
5687 abfd);
5688 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5689 return FALSE;
5690 }
5691 /* Set the note section type to SHT_NOTE. */
5692 else if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE)
5693 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5694 elf_section_type (m->sections[i]) = SHT_NOTE;
5695
5696 if (m->includes_filehdr)
5697 {
5698 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5699 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5700 p->p_filesz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5701 p->p_memsz = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5702 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5703 {
5704 if (m->count > 0)
5705 {
5706 if (p->p_vaddr < (bfd_vma) off
5707 || (!m->p_paddr_valid
5708 && p->p_paddr < (bfd_vma) off))
5709 {
5710 _bfd_error_handler
5711 (_("%pB: not enough room for program headers,"
5712 " try linking with -N"),
5713 abfd);
5714 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
5715 return FALSE;
5716 }
5717 p->p_vaddr -= off;
5718 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5719 p->p_paddr -= off;
5720 }
5721 }
5722 else if (sorted_seg_map[0]->includes_filehdr)
5723 {
5724 Elf_Internal_Phdr *filehdr = phdrs + sorted_seg_map[0]->idx;
5725 p->p_vaddr = filehdr->p_vaddr;
5726 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5727 p->p_paddr = filehdr->p_paddr;
5728 }
5729 }
5730
5731 if (m->includes_phdrs)
5732 {
5733 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5734 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5735 p->p_filesz += actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5736 p->p_memsz += actual * bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
5737 if (!m->includes_filehdr)
5738 {
5739 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5740 {
5741 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phoff = p->p_offset;
5742 if (m->count > 0)
5743 {
5744 p->p_vaddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5745 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5746 p->p_paddr -= off - p->p_offset;
5747 }
5748 }
5749 else if (phdr_load_seg != NULL)
5750 {
5751 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdr = phdrs + phdr_load_seg->idx;
5752 bfd_vma phdr_off = 0; /* Octets. */
5753 if (phdr_load_seg->includes_filehdr)
5754 phdr_off = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5755 p->p_vaddr = phdr->p_vaddr + phdr_off;
5756 if (!m->p_paddr_valid)
5757 p->p_paddr = phdr->p_paddr + phdr_off;
5758 p->p_offset = phdr->p_offset + phdr_off;
5759 }
5760 else
5761 p->p_offset = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
5762 }
5763 }
5764
5765 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5766 || (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core))
5767 {
5768 if (!m->includes_filehdr && !m->includes_phdrs)
5769 {
5770 p->p_offset = off;
5771 if (no_contents)
5772 {
5773 /* Put meaningless p_offset for PT_LOAD segments
5774 without file contents somewhere within the first
5775 page, in an attempt to not point past EOF. */
5776 bfd_size_type align = maxpagesize;
5777 if (align < p->p_align)
5778 align = p->p_align;
5779 if (align < 1)
5780 align = 1;
5781 p->p_offset = off % align;
5782 }
5783 }
5784 else
5785 {
5786 file_ptr adjust; /* Octets. */
5787
5788 adjust = off - (p->p_offset + p->p_filesz);
5789 if (!no_contents)
5790 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5791 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5792 }
5793 }
5794
5795 /* Set up p_filesz, p_memsz, p_align and p_flags from the section
5796 maps. Set filepos for sections in PT_LOAD segments, and in
5797 core files, for sections in PT_NOTE segments.
5798 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections will set filepos
5799 for other sections and update p_filesz for other segments. */
5800 for (i = 0, secpp = m->sections; i < m->count; i++, secpp++)
5801 {
5802 asection *sec;
5803 bfd_size_type align;
5804 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5805
5806 sec = *secpp;
5807 this_hdr = &elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr;
5808 align = (bfd_size_type) 1 << bfd_section_alignment (sec);
5809
5810 if ((p->p_type == PT_LOAD
5811 || p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5812 && (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
5813 || ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0
5814 && ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0
5815 || p->p_type == PT_TLS))))
5816 {
5817 bfd_vma p_start = p->p_paddr; /* Octets. */
5818 bfd_vma p_end = p_start + p->p_memsz; /* Octets. */
5819 bfd_vma s_start = sec->lma * opb; /* Octets. */
5820 bfd_vma adjust = s_start - p_end; /* Octets. */
5821
5822 if (adjust != 0
5823 && (s_start < p_end
5824 || p_end < p_start))
5825 {
5826 _bfd_error_handler
5827 /* xgettext:c-format */
5828 (_("%pB: section %pA lma %#" PRIx64 " adjusted to %#" PRIx64),
5829 abfd, sec, (uint64_t) s_start / opb,
5830 (uint64_t) p_end / opb);
5831 adjust = 0;
5832 sec->lma = p_end / opb;
5833 }
5834 p->p_memsz += adjust;
5835
5836 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5837 {
5838 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5839 {
5840 off_adjust = 0;
5841 if (p->p_filesz + adjust < p->p_memsz)
5842 {
5843 /* We have a PROGBITS section following NOBITS ones.
5844 Allocate file space for the NOBITS section(s) and
5845 zero it. */
5846 adjust = p->p_memsz - p->p_filesz;
5847 if (!write_zeros (abfd, off, adjust))
5848 return FALSE;
5849 }
5850 }
5851 /* We only adjust sh_offset in SHT_NOBITS sections
5852 as would seem proper for their address when the
5853 section is first in the segment. sh_offset
5854 doesn't really have any significance for
5855 SHT_NOBITS anyway, apart from a notional position
5856 relative to other sections. Historically we
5857 didn't bother with adjusting sh_offset and some
5858 programs depend on it not being adjusted. See
5859 pr12921 and pr25662. */
5860 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS || i == 0)
5861 {
5862 off += adjust;
5863 if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS)
5864 off_adjust += adjust;
5865 }
5866 }
5867 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5868 p->p_filesz += adjust;
5869 }
5870
5871 if (p->p_type == PT_NOTE && bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
5872 {
5873 /* The section at i == 0 is the one that actually contains
5874 everything. */
5875 if (i == 0)
5876 {
5877 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5878 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5879 p->p_filesz = this_hdr->sh_size;
5880 p->p_memsz = 0;
5881 p->p_align = 1;
5882 }
5883 else
5884 {
5885 /* The rest are fake sections that shouldn't be written. */
5886 sec->filepos = 0;
5887 sec->size = 0;
5888 sec->flags = 0;
5889 continue;
5890 }
5891 }
5892 else
5893 {
5894 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD)
5895 {
5896 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off;
5897 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5898 off += this_hdr->sh_size;
5899 }
5900 else if (this_hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
5901 && (this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) != 0
5902 && this_hdr->sh_offset == 0)
5903 {
5904 /* This is a .tbss section that didn't get a PT_LOAD.
5905 (See _bfd_elf_map_sections_to_segments "Create a
5906 final PT_LOAD".) Set sh_offset to the value it
5907 would have if we had created a zero p_filesz and
5908 p_memsz PT_LOAD header for the section. This
5909 also makes the PT_TLS header have the same
5910 p_offset value. */
5911 bfd_vma adjust = vma_page_aligned_bias (this_hdr->sh_addr,
5912 off, align);
5913 this_hdr->sh_offset = sec->filepos = off + adjust;
5914 }
5915
5916 if (this_hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
5917 {
5918 p->p_filesz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5919 /* A load section without SHF_ALLOC is something like
5920 a note section in a PT_NOTE segment. These take
5921 file space but are not loaded into memory. */
5922 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5923 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5924 }
5925 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
5926 {
5927 if (p->p_type == PT_TLS)
5928 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5929
5930 /* .tbss is special. It doesn't contribute to p_memsz of
5931 normal segments. */
5932 else if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_TLS) == 0)
5933 p->p_memsz += this_hdr->sh_size;
5934 }
5935
5936 if (align > p->p_align
5937 && !m->p_align_valid
5938 && (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
5939 || (abfd->flags & D_PAGED) == 0))
5940 p->p_align = align;
5941 }
5942
5943 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
5944 {
5945 p->p_flags |= PF_R;
5946 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXECINSTR) != 0)
5947 p->p_flags |= PF_X;
5948 if ((this_hdr->sh_flags & SHF_WRITE) != 0)
5949 p->p_flags |= PF_W;
5950 }
5951 }
5952
5953 off -= off_adjust;
5954
5955 /* PR ld/20815 - Check that the program header segment, if
5956 present, will be loaded into memory. */
5957 if (p->p_type == PT_PHDR
5958 && phdr_load_seg == NULL
5959 && !(bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr != NULL
5960 && bed->elf_backend_allow_non_load_phdr (abfd, phdrs, alloc)))
5961 {
5962 /* The fix for this error is usually to edit the linker script being
5963 used and set up the program headers manually. Either that or
5964 leave room for the headers at the start of the SECTIONS. */
5965 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: error: PHDR segment not covered"
5966 " by LOAD segment"),
5967 abfd);
5968 if (link_info == NULL)
5969 return FALSE;
5970 /* Arrange for the linker to exit with an error, deleting
5971 the output file unless --noinhibit-exec is given. */
5972 link_info->callbacks->info ("%X");
5973 }
5974
5975 /* Check that all sections are in a PT_LOAD segment.
5976 Don't check funky gdb generated core files. */
5977 if (p->p_type == PT_LOAD && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
5978 {
5979 bfd_boolean check_vma = TRUE;
5980
5981 for (i = 1; i < m->count; i++)
5982 if (m->sections[i]->vma == m->sections[i - 1]->vma
5983 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i])
5984 ->this_hdr), p) != 0
5985 && ELF_SECTION_SIZE (&(elf_section_data (m->sections[i - 1])
5986 ->this_hdr), p) != 0)
5987 {
5988 /* Looks like we have overlays packed into the segment. */
5989 check_vma = FALSE;
5990 break;
5991 }
5992
5993 for (i = 0; i < m->count; i++)
5994 {
5995 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
5996 asection *sec;
5997
5998 sec = m->sections[i];
5999 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(sec)->this_hdr);
6000 if (!ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT_1 (this_hdr, p, check_vma, 0)
6001 && !ELF_TBSS_SPECIAL (this_hdr, p))
6002 {
6003 _bfd_error_handler
6004 /* xgettext:c-format */
6005 (_("%pB: section `%pA' can't be allocated in segment %d"),
6006 abfd, sec, j);
6007 print_segment_map (m);
6008 }
6009 }
6010 }
6011 }
6012
6013 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6014
6015 if (link_info != NULL
6016 && phdr_load_seg != NULL
6017 && phdr_load_seg->includes_filehdr)
6018 {
6019 /* There is a segment that contains both the file headers and the
6020 program headers, so provide a symbol __ehdr_start pointing there.
6021 A program can use this to examine itself robustly. */
6022
6023 struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash
6024 = elf_link_hash_lookup (elf_hash_table (link_info), "__ehdr_start",
6025 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
6026 /* If the symbol was referenced and not defined, define it. */
6027 if (hash != NULL
6028 && (hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new
6029 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6030 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
6031 || hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_common))
6032 {
6033 asection *s = NULL;
6034 bfd_vma filehdr_vaddr = phdrs[phdr_load_seg->idx].p_vaddr / opb;
6035
6036 if (phdr_load_seg->count != 0)
6037 /* The segment contains sections, so use the first one. */
6038 s = phdr_load_seg->sections[0];
6039 else
6040 /* Use the first (i.e. lowest-addressed) section in any segment. */
6041 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
6042 if (m->p_type == PT_LOAD && m->count != 0)
6043 {
6044 s = m->sections[0];
6045 break;
6046 }
6047
6048 if (s != NULL)
6049 {
6050 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr - s->vma;
6051 hash->root.u.def.section = s;
6052 }
6053 else
6054 {
6055 hash->root.u.def.value = filehdr_vaddr;
6056 hash->root.u.def.section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6057 }
6058
6059 hash->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
6060 hash->def_regular = 1;
6061 hash->non_elf = 0;
6062 }
6063 }
6064
6065 return TRUE;
6066 }
6067
6068 /* Determine if a bfd is a debuginfo file. Unfortunately there
6069 is no defined method for detecting such files, so we have to
6070 use heuristics instead. */
6071
6072 bfd_boolean
6073 is_debuginfo_file (bfd *abfd)
6074 {
6075 if (abfd == NULL || bfd_get_flavour (abfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
6076 return FALSE;
6077
6078 Elf_Internal_Shdr **start_headers = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6079 Elf_Internal_Shdr **end_headers = start_headers + elf_numsections (abfd);
6080 Elf_Internal_Shdr **headerp;
6081
6082 for (headerp = start_headers; headerp < end_headers; headerp ++)
6083 {
6084 Elf_Internal_Shdr *header = * headerp;
6085
6086 /* Debuginfo files do not have any allocated SHT_PROGBITS sections.
6087 The only allocated sections are SHT_NOBITS or SHT_NOTES. */
6088 if ((header->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) == SHF_ALLOC
6089 && header->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS
6090 && header->sh_type != SHT_NOTE)
6091 return FALSE;
6092 }
6093
6094 return TRUE;
6095 }
6096
6097 /* Assign file positions for the other sections, except for compressed debugging
6098 and other sections assigned in _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load(). */
6099
6100 static bfd_boolean
6101 assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (bfd *abfd,
6102 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6103 {
6104 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6105 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrpp;
6106 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp, **end_hdrpp;
6107 Elf_Internal_Phdr *phdrs;
6108 Elf_Internal_Phdr *p;
6109 struct elf_segment_map *m;
6110 file_ptr off;
6111 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, NULL);
6112
6113 i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6114 end_hdrpp = i_shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
6115 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
6116 for (hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; hdrpp < end_hdrpp; hdrpp++)
6117 {
6118 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6119
6120 hdr = *hdrpp;
6121 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6122 && (hdr->bfd_section->filepos != 0
6123 || (hdr->sh_type == SHT_NOBITS
6124 && hdr->contents == NULL)))
6125 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->sh_offset == hdr->bfd_section->filepos);
6126 else if ((hdr->sh_flags & SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
6127 {
6128 if (hdr->sh_size != 0
6129 /* PR 24717 - debuginfo files are known to be not strictly
6130 compliant with the ELF standard. In particular they often
6131 have .note.gnu.property sections that are outside of any
6132 loadable segment. This is not a problem for such files,
6133 so do not warn about them. */
6134 && ! is_debuginfo_file (abfd))
6135 _bfd_error_handler
6136 /* xgettext:c-format */
6137 (_("%pB: warning: allocated section `%s' not in segment"),
6138 abfd,
6139 (hdr->bfd_section == NULL
6140 ? "*unknown*"
6141 : hdr->bfd_section->name));
6142 /* We don't need to page align empty sections. */
6143 if ((abfd->flags & D_PAGED) != 0 && hdr->sh_size != 0)
6144 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
6145 bed->maxpagesize);
6146 else
6147 off += vma_page_aligned_bias (hdr->sh_addr, off,
6148 hdr->sh_addralign);
6149 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off,
6150 FALSE);
6151 }
6152 else if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
6153 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
6154 /* We don't know the offset of these sections yet: their size has
6155 not been decided. */
6156 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6157 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
6158 || (bfd_section_is_ctf (hdr->bfd_section)
6159 && abfd->is_linker_output)))
6160 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_onesymtab (abfd)]
6161 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
6162 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
6163 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_strtab_sec (abfd)]
6164 || hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd)])
6165 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
6166 else
6167 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
6168 }
6169 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6170
6171 /* Now that we have set the section file positions, we can set up
6172 the file positions for the non PT_LOAD segments. */
6173 phdrs = elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr;
6174 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd), p = phdrs; m != NULL; m = m->next, p++)
6175 {
6176 if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
6177 {
6178 bfd_vma start, end; /* Bytes. */
6179 bfd_boolean ok;
6180
6181 if (link_info != NULL)
6182 {
6183 /* During linking the range of the RELRO segment is passed
6184 in link_info. Note that there may be padding between
6185 relro_start and the first RELRO section. */
6186 start = link_info->relro_start;
6187 end = link_info->relro_end;
6188 }
6189 else if (m->count != 0)
6190 {
6191 if (!m->p_size_valid)
6192 abort ();
6193 start = m->sections[0]->vma;
6194 end = start + m->p_size / opb;
6195 }
6196 else
6197 {
6198 start = 0;
6199 end = 0;
6200 }
6201
6202 ok = FALSE;
6203 if (start < end)
6204 {
6205 struct elf_segment_map *lm;
6206 const Elf_Internal_Phdr *lp;
6207 unsigned int i;
6208
6209 /* Find a LOAD segment containing a section in the RELRO
6210 segment. */
6211 for (lm = elf_seg_map (abfd), lp = phdrs;
6212 lm != NULL;
6213 lm = lm->next, lp++)
6214 {
6215 if (lp->p_type == PT_LOAD
6216 && lm->count != 0
6217 && (lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->vma
6218 + (!IS_TBSS (lm->sections[lm->count - 1])
6219 ? lm->sections[lm->count - 1]->size / opb
6220 : 0)) > start
6221 && lm->sections[0]->vma < end)
6222 break;
6223 }
6224
6225 if (lm != NULL)
6226 {
6227 /* Find the section starting the RELRO segment. */
6228 for (i = 0; i < lm->count; i++)
6229 {
6230 asection *s = lm->sections[i];
6231 if (s->vma >= start
6232 && s->vma < end
6233 && s->size != 0)
6234 break;
6235 }
6236
6237 if (i < lm->count)
6238 {
6239 p->p_vaddr = lm->sections[i]->vma * opb;
6240 p->p_paddr = lm->sections[i]->lma * opb;
6241 p->p_offset = lm->sections[i]->filepos;
6242 p->p_memsz = end * opb - p->p_vaddr;
6243 p->p_filesz = p->p_memsz;
6244
6245 /* The RELRO segment typically ends a few bytes
6246 into .got.plt but other layouts are possible.
6247 In cases where the end does not match any
6248 loaded section (for instance is in file
6249 padding), trim p_filesz back to correspond to
6250 the end of loaded section contents. */
6251 if (p->p_filesz > lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr)
6252 p->p_filesz = lp->p_vaddr + lp->p_filesz - p->p_vaddr;
6253
6254 /* Preserve the alignment and flags if they are
6255 valid. The gold linker generates RW/4 for
6256 the PT_GNU_RELRO section. It is better for
6257 objcopy/strip to honor these attributes
6258 otherwise gdb will choke when using separate
6259 debug files. */
6260 if (!m->p_align_valid)
6261 p->p_align = 1;
6262 if (!m->p_flags_valid)
6263 p->p_flags = PF_R;
6264 ok = TRUE;
6265 }
6266 }
6267 }
6268 if (link_info != NULL)
6269 BFD_ASSERT (ok);
6270 if (!ok)
6271 memset (p, 0, sizeof *p);
6272 }
6273 else if (p->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
6274 {
6275 if (m->p_size_valid)
6276 p->p_memsz = m->p_size;
6277 }
6278 else if (m->count != 0)
6279 {
6280 unsigned int i;
6281
6282 if (p->p_type != PT_LOAD
6283 && (p->p_type != PT_NOTE
6284 || bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core))
6285 {
6286 /* A user specified segment layout may include a PHDR
6287 segment that overlaps with a LOAD segment... */
6288 if (p->p_type == PT_PHDR)
6289 {
6290 m->count = 0;
6291 continue;
6292 }
6293
6294 if (m->includes_filehdr || m->includes_phdrs)
6295 {
6296 /* PR 17512: file: 2195325e. */
6297 _bfd_error_handler
6298 (_("%pB: error: non-load segment %d includes file header "
6299 "and/or program header"),
6300 abfd, (int) (p - phdrs));
6301 return FALSE;
6302 }
6303
6304 p->p_filesz = 0;
6305 p->p_offset = m->sections[0]->filepos;
6306 for (i = m->count; i-- != 0;)
6307 {
6308 asection *sect = m->sections[i];
6309 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_section_data (sect)->this_hdr;
6310 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
6311 {
6312 p->p_filesz = (sect->filepos - m->sections[0]->filepos
6313 + hdr->sh_size);
6314 break;
6315 }
6316 }
6317 }
6318 }
6319 }
6320
6321 return TRUE;
6322 }
6323
6324 static elf_section_list *
6325 find_section_in_list (unsigned int i, elf_section_list * list)
6326 {
6327 for (;list != NULL; list = list->next)
6328 if (list->ndx == i)
6329 break;
6330 return list;
6331 }
6332
6333 /* Work out the file positions of all the sections. This is called by
6334 _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions. All the section sizes and
6335 VMAs must be known before this is called.
6336
6337 Reloc sections come in two flavours: Those processed specially as
6338 "side-channel" data attached to a section to which they apply, and those that
6339 bfd doesn't process as relocations. The latter sort are stored in a normal
6340 bfd section by bfd_section_from_shdr. We don't consider the former sort
6341 here, unless they form part of the loadable image. Reloc sections not
6342 assigned here (and compressed debugging sections and CTF sections which
6343 nothing else in the file can rely upon) will be handled later by
6344 assign_file_positions_for_relocs.
6345
6346 We also don't set the positions of the .symtab and .strtab here. */
6347
6348 static bfd_boolean
6349 assign_file_positions_except_relocs (bfd *abfd,
6350 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6351 {
6352 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
6353 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6354 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6355 unsigned int alloc;
6356
6357 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0
6358 && bfd_get_format (abfd) != bfd_core)
6359 {
6360 Elf_Internal_Shdr ** const i_shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6361 unsigned int num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6362 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
6363 unsigned int i;
6364 file_ptr off;
6365
6366 /* Start after the ELF header. */
6367 off = i_ehdrp->e_ehsize;
6368
6369 /* We are not creating an executable, which means that we are
6370 not creating a program header, and that the actual order of
6371 the sections in the file is unimportant. */
6372 for (i = 1, hdrpp = i_shdrpp + 1; i < num_sec; i++, hdrpp++)
6373 {
6374 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
6375
6376 hdr = *hdrpp;
6377 if (((hdr->sh_type == SHT_REL || hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA)
6378 && hdr->bfd_section == NULL)
6379 /* Do not assign offsets for these sections yet: we don't know
6380 their sizes. */
6381 || (hdr->bfd_section != NULL
6382 && (hdr->bfd_section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS
6383 || (bfd_section_is_ctf (hdr->bfd_section)
6384 && abfd->is_linker_output)))
6385 || i == elf_onesymtab (abfd)
6386 || (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd) != NULL
6387 && hdr == i_shdrpp[elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx])
6388 || i == elf_strtab_sec (abfd)
6389 || i == elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd))
6390 {
6391 hdr->sh_offset = -1;
6392 }
6393 else
6394 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (hdr, off, TRUE);
6395 }
6396
6397 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6398 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = 0;
6399 }
6400 else
6401 {
6402 /* Assign file positions for the loaded sections based on the
6403 assignment of sections to segments. */
6404 if (!assign_file_positions_for_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6405 return FALSE;
6406
6407 /* And for non-load sections. */
6408 if (!assign_file_positions_for_non_load_sections (abfd, link_info))
6409 return FALSE;
6410 }
6411
6412 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_modify_headers) (abfd, link_info))
6413 return FALSE;
6414
6415 /* Write out the program headers. */
6416 alloc = i_ehdrp->e_phnum;
6417 if (alloc != 0)
6418 {
6419 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_ehdrp->e_phoff, SEEK_SET) != 0
6420 || bed->s->write_out_phdrs (abfd, tdata->phdr, alloc) != 0)
6421 return FALSE;
6422 }
6423
6424 return TRUE;
6425 }
6426
6427 bfd_boolean
6428 _bfd_elf_init_file_header (bfd *abfd,
6429 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6430 {
6431 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* Elf file header, internal form. */
6432 struct elf_strtab_hash *shstrtab;
6433 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6434
6435 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6436
6437 shstrtab = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
6438 if (shstrtab == NULL)
6439 return FALSE;
6440
6441 elf_shstrtab (abfd) = shstrtab;
6442
6443 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG0] = ELFMAG0;
6444 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG1] = ELFMAG1;
6445 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG2] = ELFMAG2;
6446 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_MAG3] = ELFMAG3;
6447
6448 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_CLASS] = bed->s->elfclass;
6449 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_DATA] =
6450 bfd_big_endian (abfd) ? ELFDATA2MSB : ELFDATA2LSB;
6451 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_VERSION] = bed->s->ev_current;
6452
6453 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
6454 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_DYN;
6455 else if ((abfd->flags & EXEC_P) != 0)
6456 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6457 else if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_core)
6458 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_CORE;
6459 else
6460 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_REL;
6461
6462 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
6463 {
6464 case bfd_arch_unknown:
6465 i_ehdrp->e_machine = EM_NONE;
6466 break;
6467
6468 /* There used to be a long list of cases here, each one setting
6469 e_machine to the same EM_* macro #defined as ELF_MACHINE_CODE
6470 in the corresponding bfd definition. To avoid duplication,
6471 the switch was removed. Machines that need special handling
6472 can generally do it in elf_backend_final_write_processing(),
6473 unless they need the information earlier than the final write.
6474 Such need can generally be supplied by replacing the tests for
6475 e_machine with the conditions used to determine it. */
6476 default:
6477 i_ehdrp->e_machine = bed->elf_machine_code;
6478 }
6479
6480 i_ehdrp->e_version = bed->s->ev_current;
6481 i_ehdrp->e_ehsize = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
6482
6483 /* No program header, for now. */
6484 i_ehdrp->e_phoff = 0;
6485 i_ehdrp->e_phentsize = 0;
6486 i_ehdrp->e_phnum = 0;
6487
6488 /* Each bfd section is section header entry. */
6489 i_ehdrp->e_entry = bfd_get_start_address (abfd);
6490 i_ehdrp->e_shentsize = bed->s->sizeof_shdr;
6491
6492 elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name =
6493 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".symtab", FALSE);
6494 elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name =
6495 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".strtab", FALSE);
6496 elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name =
6497 (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (shstrtab, ".shstrtab", FALSE);
6498 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6499 || elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1
6500 || elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr.sh_name == (unsigned int) -1)
6501 return FALSE;
6502
6503 return TRUE;
6504 }
6505
6506 /* Set e_type in ELF header to ET_EXEC for -pie -Ttext-segment=.
6507
6508 FIXME: We used to have code here to sort the PT_LOAD segments into
6509 ascending order, as per the ELF spec. But this breaks some programs,
6510 including the Linux kernel. But really either the spec should be
6511 changed or the programs updated. */
6512
6513 bfd_boolean
6514 _bfd_elf_modify_headers (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
6515 {
6516 if (link_info != NULL && bfd_link_pie (link_info))
6517 {
6518 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (obfd);
6519 unsigned int num_segments = i_ehdrp->e_phnum;
6520 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (obfd);
6521 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment = tdata->phdr;
6522 Elf_Internal_Phdr *end_segment = &segment[num_segments];
6523
6524 /* Find the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD segments. */
6525 bfd_vma p_vaddr = (bfd_vma) -1;
6526 for (; segment < end_segment; segment++)
6527 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && p_vaddr > segment->p_vaddr)
6528 p_vaddr = segment->p_vaddr;
6529
6530 /* Set e_type to ET_EXEC if the lowest p_vaddr in PT_LOAD
6531 segments is non-zero. */
6532 if (p_vaddr)
6533 i_ehdrp->e_type = ET_EXEC;
6534 }
6535 return TRUE;
6536 }
6537
6538 /* Assign file positions for all the reloc sections which are not part
6539 of the loadable file image, and the file position of section headers. */
6540
6541 static bfd_boolean
6542 _bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (bfd *abfd)
6543 {
6544 file_ptr off;
6545 Elf_Internal_Shdr **shdrpp, **end_shdrpp;
6546 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdrp;
6547 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
6548 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6549
6550 off = elf_next_file_pos (abfd);
6551
6552 shdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6553 end_shdrpp = shdrpp + elf_numsections (abfd);
6554 for (shdrpp++; shdrpp < end_shdrpp; shdrpp++)
6555 {
6556 shdrp = *shdrpp;
6557 if (shdrp->sh_offset == -1)
6558 {
6559 asection *sec = shdrp->bfd_section;
6560 bfd_boolean is_rel = (shdrp->sh_type == SHT_REL
6561 || shdrp->sh_type == SHT_RELA);
6562 bfd_boolean is_ctf = sec && bfd_section_is_ctf (sec);
6563 if (is_rel
6564 || is_ctf
6565 || (sec != NULL && (sec->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS)))
6566 {
6567 if (!is_rel && !is_ctf)
6568 {
6569 const char *name = sec->name;
6570 struct bfd_elf_section_data *d;
6571
6572 /* Compress DWARF debug sections. */
6573 if (!bfd_compress_section (abfd, sec,
6574 shdrp->contents))
6575 return FALSE;
6576
6577 if (sec->compress_status == COMPRESS_SECTION_DONE
6578 && (abfd->flags & BFD_COMPRESS_GABI) == 0)
6579 {
6580 /* If section is compressed with zlib-gnu, convert
6581 section name from .debug_* to .zdebug_*. */
6582 char *new_name
6583 = convert_debug_to_zdebug (abfd, name);
6584 if (new_name == NULL)
6585 return FALSE;
6586 name = new_name;
6587 }
6588 /* Add section name to section name section. */
6589 if (shdrp->sh_name != (unsigned int) -1)
6590 abort ();
6591 shdrp->sh_name
6592 = (unsigned int) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6593 name, FALSE);
6594 d = elf_section_data (sec);
6595
6596 /* Add reloc section name to section name section. */
6597 if (d->rel.hdr
6598 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6599 d->rel.hdr,
6600 name, FALSE))
6601 return FALSE;
6602 if (d->rela.hdr
6603 && !_bfd_elf_set_reloc_sh_name (abfd,
6604 d->rela.hdr,
6605 name, TRUE))
6606 return FALSE;
6607
6608 /* Update section size and contents. */
6609 shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
6610 shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
6611 shdrp->bfd_section->contents = NULL;
6612 }
6613 else if (is_ctf)
6614 {
6615 /* Update section size and contents. */
6616 shdrp->sh_size = sec->size;
6617 shdrp->contents = sec->contents;
6618 }
6619
6620 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp,
6621 off,
6622 TRUE);
6623 }
6624 }
6625 }
6626
6627 /* Place section name section after DWARF debug sections have been
6628 compressed. */
6629 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6630 shdrp = &elf_tdata (abfd)->shstrtab_hdr;
6631 shdrp->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
6632 off = _bfd_elf_assign_file_position_for_section (shdrp, off, TRUE);
6633
6634 /* Place the section headers. */
6635 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
6636 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6637 off = align_file_position (off, 1 << bed->s->log_file_align);
6638 i_ehdrp->e_shoff = off;
6639 off += i_ehdrp->e_shnum * i_ehdrp->e_shentsize;
6640 elf_next_file_pos (abfd) = off;
6641
6642 return TRUE;
6643 }
6644
6645 bfd_boolean
6646 _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (bfd *abfd)
6647 {
6648 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6649 Elf_Internal_Shdr **i_shdrp;
6650 bfd_boolean failed;
6651 unsigned int count, num_sec;
6652 struct elf_obj_tdata *t;
6653
6654 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
6655 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
6656 return FALSE;
6657 /* Do not rewrite ELF data when the BFD has been opened for update.
6658 abfd->output_has_begun was set to TRUE on opening, so creation of new
6659 sections, and modification of existing section sizes was restricted.
6660 This means the ELF header, program headers and section headers can't have
6661 changed.
6662 If the contents of any sections has been modified, then those changes have
6663 already been written to the BFD. */
6664 else if (abfd->direction == both_direction)
6665 {
6666 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
6667 return TRUE;
6668 }
6669
6670 i_shdrp = elf_elfsections (abfd);
6671
6672 failed = FALSE;
6673 bfd_map_over_sections (abfd, bed->s->write_relocs, &failed);
6674 if (failed)
6675 return FALSE;
6676
6677 if (!_bfd_elf_assign_file_positions_for_non_load (abfd))
6678 return FALSE;
6679
6680 /* After writing the headers, we need to write the sections too... */
6681 num_sec = elf_numsections (abfd);
6682 for (count = 1; count < num_sec; count++)
6683 {
6684 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name
6685 = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (elf_shstrtab (abfd),
6686 i_shdrp[count]->sh_name);
6687 if (bed->elf_backend_section_processing)
6688 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_section_processing) (abfd, i_shdrp[count]))
6689 return FALSE;
6690 if (i_shdrp[count]->contents)
6691 {
6692 bfd_size_type amt = i_shdrp[count]->sh_size;
6693
6694 if (bfd_seek (abfd, i_shdrp[count]->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6695 || bfd_bwrite (i_shdrp[count]->contents, amt, abfd) != amt)
6696 return FALSE;
6697 }
6698 }
6699
6700 /* Write out the section header names. */
6701 t = elf_tdata (abfd);
6702 if (elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL
6703 && (bfd_seek (abfd, t->shstrtab_hdr.sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
6704 || !_bfd_elf_strtab_emit (abfd, elf_shstrtab (abfd))))
6705 return FALSE;
6706
6707 if (!(*bed->elf_backend_final_write_processing) (abfd))
6708 return FALSE;
6709
6710 if (!bed->s->write_shdrs_and_ehdr (abfd))
6711 return FALSE;
6712
6713 /* This is last since write_shdrs_and_ehdr can touch i_shdrp[0]. */
6714 if (t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents != NULL)
6715 return (*t->o->build_id.after_write_object_contents) (abfd);
6716
6717 return TRUE;
6718 }
6719
6720 bfd_boolean
6721 _bfd_elf_write_corefile_contents (bfd *abfd)
6722 {
6723 /* Hopefully this can be done just like an object file. */
6724 return _bfd_elf_write_object_contents (abfd);
6725 }
6726
6727 /* Given a section, search the header to find them. */
6728
6729 unsigned int
6730 _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_section *asect)
6731 {
6732 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6733 unsigned int sec_index;
6734
6735 if (elf_section_data (asect) != NULL
6736 && elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx != 0)
6737 return elf_section_data (asect)->this_idx;
6738
6739 if (bfd_is_abs_section (asect))
6740 sec_index = SHN_ABS;
6741 else if (bfd_is_com_section (asect))
6742 sec_index = SHN_COMMON;
6743 else if (bfd_is_und_section (asect))
6744 sec_index = SHN_UNDEF;
6745 else
6746 sec_index = SHN_BAD;
6747
6748 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
6749 if (bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section)
6750 {
6751 int retval = sec_index;
6752
6753 if ((*bed->elf_backend_section_from_bfd_section) (abfd, asect, &retval))
6754 return retval;
6755 }
6756
6757 if (sec_index == SHN_BAD)
6758 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
6759
6760 return sec_index;
6761 }
6762
6763 /* Given a BFD symbol, return the index in the ELF symbol table, or -1
6764 on error. */
6765
6766 int
6767 _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol **asym_ptr_ptr)
6768 {
6769 asymbol *asym_ptr = *asym_ptr_ptr;
6770 int idx;
6771 flagword flags = asym_ptr->flags;
6772
6773 /* When gas creates relocations against local labels, it creates its
6774 own symbol for the section, but does put the symbol into the
6775 symbol chain, so udata is 0. When the linker is generating
6776 relocatable output, this section symbol may be for one of the
6777 input sections rather than the output section. */
6778 if (asym_ptr->udata.i == 0
6779 && (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
6780 && asym_ptr->section)
6781 {
6782 asection *sec;
6783 int indx;
6784
6785 sec = asym_ptr->section;
6786 if (sec->owner != abfd && sec->output_section != NULL)
6787 sec = sec->output_section;
6788 if (sec->owner == abfd
6789 && (indx = sec->index) < elf_num_section_syms (abfd)
6790 && elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx] != NULL)
6791 asym_ptr->udata.i = elf_section_syms (abfd)[indx]->udata.i;
6792 }
6793
6794 idx = asym_ptr->udata.i;
6795
6796 if (idx == 0)
6797 {
6798 /* This case can occur when using --strip-symbol on a symbol
6799 which is used in a relocation entry. */
6800 _bfd_error_handler
6801 /* xgettext:c-format */
6802 (_("%pB: symbol `%s' required but not present"),
6803 abfd, bfd_asymbol_name (asym_ptr));
6804 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_symbols);
6805 return -1;
6806 }
6807
6808 #if DEBUG & 4
6809 {
6810 fprintf (stderr,
6811 "elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol 0x%.8lx, name = %s, sym num = %d, flags = 0x%.8x\n",
6812 (long) asym_ptr, asym_ptr->name, idx, flags);
6813 fflush (stderr);
6814 }
6815 #endif
6816
6817 return idx;
6818 }
6819
6820 /* Rewrite program header information. */
6821
6822 static bfd_boolean
6823 rewrite_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
6824 {
6825 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
6826 struct elf_segment_map *map;
6827 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
6828 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
6829 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
6830 asection *section;
6831 unsigned int i;
6832 unsigned int num_segments;
6833 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
6834 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
6835 bfd_vma maxpagesize;
6836 struct elf_segment_map *phdr_adjust_seg = NULL;
6837 unsigned int phdr_adjust_num = 0;
6838 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
6839 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (ibfd, NULL);
6840
6841 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
6842 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
6843
6844 map_first = NULL;
6845 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
6846
6847 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
6848 maxpagesize = get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize;
6849
6850 /* Returns the end address of the segment + 1. */
6851 #define SEGMENT_END(segment, start) \
6852 (start + (segment->p_memsz > segment->p_filesz \
6853 ? segment->p_memsz : segment->p_filesz))
6854
6855 #define SECTION_SIZE(section, segment) \
6856 (((section->flags & (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6857 != SEC_THREAD_LOCAL || segment->p_type == PT_TLS) \
6858 ? section->size : 0)
6859
6860 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6861 the given segment. VMA addresses are compared. */
6862 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA(section, segment, opb) \
6863 (section->vma * (opb) >= segment->p_vaddr \
6864 && (section->vma * (opb) + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6865 <= (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr))))
6866
6867 /* Returns TRUE if the given section is contained within
6868 the given segment. LMA addresses are compared. */
6869 #define IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA(section, segment, base, opb) \
6870 (section->lma * (opb) >= base \
6871 && (section->lma + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) / (opb) >= section->lma) \
6872 && (section->lma * (opb) + SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) \
6873 <= SEGMENT_END (segment, base)))
6874
6875 /* Handle PT_NOTE segment. */
6876 #define IS_NOTE(p, s) \
6877 (p->p_type == PT_NOTE \
6878 && elf_section_type (s) == SHT_NOTE \
6879 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6880 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6881 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6882
6883 /* Special case: corefile "NOTE" section containing regs, prpsinfo
6884 etc. */
6885 #define IS_COREFILE_NOTE(p, s) \
6886 (IS_NOTE (p, s) \
6887 && bfd_get_format (ibfd) == bfd_core \
6888 && s->vma == 0 \
6889 && s->lma == 0)
6890
6891 /* The complicated case when p_vaddr is 0 is to handle the Solaris
6892 linker, which generates a PT_INTERP section with p_vaddr and
6893 p_memsz set to 0. */
6894 #define IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP(p, s) \
6895 (p->p_vaddr == 0 \
6896 && p->p_paddr == 0 \
6897 && p->p_memsz == 0 \
6898 && p->p_filesz > 0 \
6899 && (s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) != 0 \
6900 && s->size > 0 \
6901 && (bfd_vma) s->filepos >= p->p_offset \
6902 && ((bfd_vma) s->filepos + s->size \
6903 <= p->p_offset + p->p_filesz))
6904
6905 /* Decide if the given section should be included in the given segment.
6906 A section will be included if:
6907 1. It is within the address space of the segment -- we use the LMA
6908 if that is set for the segment and the VMA otherwise,
6909 2. It is an allocated section or a NOTE section in a PT_NOTE
6910 segment.
6911 3. There is an output section associated with it,
6912 4. The section has not already been allocated to a previous segment.
6913 5. PT_GNU_STACK segments do not include any sections.
6914 6. PT_TLS segment includes only SHF_TLS sections.
6915 7. SHF_TLS sections are only in PT_TLS or PT_LOAD segments.
6916 8. PT_DYNAMIC should not contain empty sections at the beginning
6917 (with the possible exception of .dynamic). */
6918 #define IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed, opb) \
6919 ((((segment->p_paddr \
6920 ? IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (section, segment, segment->p_paddr, opb) \
6921 : IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (section, segment, opb)) \
6922 && (section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0) \
6923 || IS_NOTE (segment, section)) \
6924 && segment->p_type != PT_GNU_STACK \
6925 && (segment->p_type != PT_TLS \
6926 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)) \
6927 && (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD \
6928 || segment->p_type == PT_TLS \
6929 || (section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) == 0) \
6930 && (segment->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC \
6931 || SECTION_SIZE (section, segment) > 0 \
6932 || (segment->p_paddr \
6933 ? segment->p_paddr != section->lma * (opb) \
6934 : segment->p_vaddr != section->vma * (opb)) \
6935 || (strcmp (bfd_section_name (section), ".dynamic") == 0)) \
6936 && (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD || !section->segment_mark))
6937
6938 /* If the output section of a section in the input segment is NULL,
6939 it is removed from the corresponding output segment. */
6940 #define INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT(section, segment, bed, opb) \
6941 (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed, opb) \
6942 && section->output_section != NULL)
6943
6944 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 starts after the end of seg2. */
6945 #define SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT(seg1, seg2, field) \
6946 (seg1->field >= SEGMENT_END (seg2, seg2->field))
6947
6948 /* Returns TRUE iff seg1 and seg2 overlap. Segments overlap iff both
6949 their VMA address ranges and their LMA address ranges overlap.
6950 It is possible to have overlapping VMA ranges without overlapping LMA
6951 ranges. RedBoot images for example can have both .data and .bss mapped
6952 to the same VMA range, but with the .data section mapped to a different
6953 LMA. */
6954 #define SEGMENT_OVERLAPS(seg1, seg2) \
6955 ( !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_vaddr) \
6956 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_vaddr)) \
6957 && !(SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg1, seg2, p_paddr) \
6958 || SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT (seg2, seg1, p_paddr)))
6959
6960 /* Initialise the segment mark field. */
6961 for (section = ibfd->sections; section != NULL; section = section->next)
6962 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
6963
6964 /* The Solaris linker creates program headers in which all the
6965 p_paddr fields are zero. When we try to objcopy or strip such a
6966 file, we get confused. Check for this case, and if we find it
6967 don't set the p_paddr_valid fields. */
6968 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
6969 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6970 i < num_segments;
6971 i++, segment++)
6972 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
6973 {
6974 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
6975 break;
6976 }
6977
6978 /* Scan through the segments specified in the program header
6979 of the input BFD. For this first scan we look for overlaps
6980 in the loadable segments. These can be created by weird
6981 parameters to objcopy. Also, fix some solaris weirdness. */
6982 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
6983 i < num_segments;
6984 i++, segment++)
6985 {
6986 unsigned int j;
6987 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment2;
6988
6989 if (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP)
6990 for (section = ibfd->sections; section; section = section->next)
6991 if (IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP (segment, section))
6992 {
6993 /* Mininal change so that the normal section to segment
6994 assignment code will work. */
6995 segment->p_vaddr = section->vma * opb;
6996 break;
6997 }
6998
6999 if (segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
7000 {
7001 /* Remove PT_GNU_RELRO segment. */
7002 if (segment->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO)
7003 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
7004 continue;
7005 }
7006
7007 /* Determine if this segment overlaps any previous segments. */
7008 for (j = 0, segment2 = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr; j < i; j++, segment2++)
7009 {
7010 bfd_signed_vma extra_length;
7011
7012 if (segment2->p_type != PT_LOAD
7013 || !SEGMENT_OVERLAPS (segment, segment2))
7014 continue;
7015
7016 /* Merge the two segments together. */
7017 if (segment2->p_vaddr < segment->p_vaddr)
7018 {
7019 /* Extend SEGMENT2 to include SEGMENT and then delete
7020 SEGMENT. */
7021 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr)
7022 - SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr));
7023
7024 if (extra_length > 0)
7025 {
7026 segment2->p_memsz += extra_length;
7027 segment2->p_filesz += extra_length;
7028 }
7029
7030 segment->p_type = PT_NULL;
7031
7032 /* Since we have deleted P we must restart the outer loop. */
7033 i = 0;
7034 segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7035 break;
7036 }
7037 else
7038 {
7039 /* Extend SEGMENT to include SEGMENT2 and then delete
7040 SEGMENT2. */
7041 extra_length = (SEGMENT_END (segment2, segment2->p_vaddr)
7042 - SEGMENT_END (segment, segment->p_vaddr));
7043
7044 if (extra_length > 0)
7045 {
7046 segment->p_memsz += extra_length;
7047 segment->p_filesz += extra_length;
7048 }
7049
7050 segment2->p_type = PT_NULL;
7051 }
7052 }
7053 }
7054
7055 /* The second scan attempts to assign sections to segments. */
7056 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7057 i < num_segments;
7058 i++, segment++)
7059 {
7060 unsigned int section_count;
7061 asection **sections;
7062 asection *output_section;
7063 unsigned int isec;
7064 asection *matching_lma;
7065 asection *suggested_lma;
7066 unsigned int j;
7067 size_t amt;
7068 asection *first_section;
7069
7070 if (segment->p_type == PT_NULL)
7071 continue;
7072
7073 first_section = NULL;
7074 /* Compute how many sections might be placed into this segment. */
7075 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
7076 section != NULL;
7077 section = section->next)
7078 {
7079 /* Find the first section in the input segment, which may be
7080 removed from the corresponding output segment. */
7081 if (IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed, opb))
7082 {
7083 if (first_section == NULL)
7084 first_section = section;
7085 if (section->output_section != NULL)
7086 ++section_count;
7087 }
7088 }
7089
7090 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7091 all of the sections we have selected. */
7092 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
7093 amt += section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7094 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7095 if (map == NULL)
7096 return FALSE;
7097
7098 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Default to
7099 using the physical address of the segment in the input BFD. */
7100 map->next = NULL;
7101 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7102 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7103 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7104
7105 /* If the first section in the input segment is removed, there is
7106 no need to preserve segment physical address in the corresponding
7107 output segment. */
7108 if (!first_section || first_section->output_section != NULL)
7109 {
7110 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
7111 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7112 }
7113
7114 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7115 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7116 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
7117 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
7118 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7119
7120 if (!phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
7121 {
7122 map->includes_phdrs =
7123 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7124 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
7125 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7126 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
7127
7128 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
7129 phdr_included = TRUE;
7130 }
7131
7132 if (section_count == 0)
7133 {
7134 /* Special segments, such as the PT_PHDR segment, may contain
7135 no sections, but ordinary, loadable segments should contain
7136 something. They are allowed by the ELF spec however, so only
7137 a warning is produced.
7138 There is however the valid use case of embedded systems which
7139 have segments with p_filesz of 0 and a p_memsz > 0 to initialize
7140 flash memory with zeros. No warning is shown for that case. */
7141 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
7142 && (segment->p_filesz > 0 || segment->p_memsz == 0))
7143 /* xgettext:c-format */
7144 _bfd_error_handler
7145 (_("%pB: warning: empty loadable segment detected"
7146 " at vaddr=%#" PRIx64 ", is this intentional?"),
7147 ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_vaddr);
7148
7149 map->p_vaddr_offset = segment->p_vaddr / opb;
7150 map->count = 0;
7151 *pointer_to_map = map;
7152 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7153
7154 continue;
7155 }
7156
7157 /* Now scan the sections in the input BFD again and attempt
7158 to add their corresponding output sections to the segment map.
7159 The problem here is how to handle an output section which has
7160 been moved (ie had its LMA changed). There are four possibilities:
7161
7162 1. None of the sections have been moved.
7163 In this case we can continue to use the segment LMA from the
7164 input BFD.
7165
7166 2. All of the sections have been moved by the same amount.
7167 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
7168 of the first section.
7169
7170 3. Some of the sections have been moved, others have not.
7171 In this case those sections which have not been moved can be
7172 placed in the current segment which will have to have its size,
7173 and possibly its LMA changed, and a new segment or segments will
7174 have to be created to contain the other sections.
7175
7176 4. The sections have been moved, but not by the same amount.
7177 In this case we can change the segment's LMA to match the LMA
7178 of the first section and we will have to create a new segment
7179 or segments to contain the other sections.
7180
7181 In order to save time, we allocate an array to hold the section
7182 pointers that we are interested in. As these sections get assigned
7183 to a segment, they are removed from this array. */
7184
7185 amt = section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7186 sections = (asection **) bfd_malloc (amt);
7187 if (sections == NULL)
7188 return FALSE;
7189
7190 /* Step One: Scan for segment vs section LMA conflicts.
7191 Also add the sections to the section array allocated above.
7192 Also add the sections to the current segment. In the common
7193 case, where the sections have not been moved, this means that
7194 we have completely filled the segment, and there is nothing
7195 more to do. */
7196 isec = 0;
7197 matching_lma = NULL;
7198 suggested_lma = NULL;
7199
7200 for (section = first_section, j = 0;
7201 section != NULL;
7202 section = section->next)
7203 {
7204 if (INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (section, segment, bed, opb))
7205 {
7206 output_section = section->output_section;
7207
7208 sections[j++] = section;
7209
7210 /* The Solaris native linker always sets p_paddr to 0.
7211 We try to catch that case here, and set it to the
7212 correct value. Note - some backends require that
7213 p_paddr be left as zero. */
7214 if (!p_paddr_valid
7215 && segment->p_vaddr != 0
7216 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
7217 && isec == 0
7218 && output_section->lma != 0
7219 && (align_power (segment->p_vaddr
7220 + (map->includes_filehdr
7221 ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
7222 + (map->includes_phdrs
7223 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
7224 : 0),
7225 output_section->alignment_power * opb)
7226 == (output_section->vma * opb)))
7227 map->p_paddr = segment->p_vaddr;
7228
7229 /* Match up the physical address of the segment with the
7230 LMA address of the output section. */
7231 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr,
7232 opb)
7233 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section)
7234 || (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero
7235 && IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA (output_section, segment, opb)))
7236 {
7237 if (matching_lma == NULL
7238 || output_section->lma < matching_lma->lma)
7239 matching_lma = output_section;
7240
7241 /* We assume that if the section fits within the segment
7242 then it does not overlap any other section within that
7243 segment. */
7244 map->sections[isec++] = output_section;
7245 }
7246 else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7247 suggested_lma = output_section;
7248
7249 if (j == section_count)
7250 break;
7251 }
7252 }
7253
7254 BFD_ASSERT (j == section_count);
7255
7256 /* Step Two: Adjust the physical address of the current segment,
7257 if necessary. */
7258 if (isec == section_count)
7259 {
7260 /* All of the sections fitted within the segment as currently
7261 specified. This is the default case. Add the segment to
7262 the list of built segments and carry on to process the next
7263 program header in the input BFD. */
7264 map->count = section_count;
7265 *pointer_to_map = map;
7266 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7267
7268 if (p_paddr_valid
7269 && !bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
7270 {
7271 bfd_vma hdr_size = 0;
7272 if (map->includes_filehdr)
7273 hdr_size = iehdr->e_ehsize;
7274 if (map->includes_phdrs)
7275 hdr_size += iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7276
7277 /* Account for padding before the first section in the
7278 segment. */
7279 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((map->p_paddr + hdr_size) / opb
7280 - matching_lma->lma);
7281 }
7282
7283 free (sections);
7284 continue;
7285 }
7286 else
7287 {
7288 /* Change the current segment's physical address to match
7289 the LMA of the first section that fitted, or if no
7290 section fitted, the first section. */
7291 if (matching_lma == NULL)
7292 matching_lma = suggested_lma;
7293
7294 map->p_paddr = matching_lma->lma * opb;
7295
7296 /* Offset the segment physical address from the lma
7297 to allow for space taken up by elf headers. */
7298 if (map->includes_phdrs)
7299 {
7300 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7301
7302 /* iehdr->e_phnum is just an estimate of the number
7303 of program headers that we will need. Make a note
7304 here of the number we used and the segment we chose
7305 to hold these headers, so that we can adjust the
7306 offset when we know the correct value. */
7307 phdr_adjust_num = iehdr->e_phnum;
7308 phdr_adjust_seg = map;
7309 }
7310
7311 if (map->includes_filehdr)
7312 {
7313 bfd_vma align = (bfd_vma) 1 << matching_lma->alignment_power;
7314 map->p_paddr -= iehdr->e_ehsize;
7315 /* We've subtracted off the size of headers from the
7316 first section lma, but there may have been some
7317 alignment padding before that section too. Try to
7318 account for that by adjusting the segment lma down to
7319 the same alignment. */
7320 if (segment->p_align != 0 && segment->p_align < align)
7321 align = segment->p_align;
7322 map->p_paddr &= -(align * opb);
7323 }
7324 }
7325
7326 /* Step Three: Loop over the sections again, this time assigning
7327 those that fit to the current segment and removing them from the
7328 sections array; but making sure not to leave large gaps. Once all
7329 possible sections have been assigned to the current segment it is
7330 added to the list of built segments and if sections still remain
7331 to be assigned, a new segment is constructed before repeating
7332 the loop. */
7333 isec = 0;
7334 do
7335 {
7336 map->count = 0;
7337 suggested_lma = NULL;
7338
7339 /* Fill the current segment with sections that fit. */
7340 for (j = 0; j < section_count; j++)
7341 {
7342 section = sections[j];
7343
7344 if (section == NULL)
7345 continue;
7346
7347 output_section = section->output_section;
7348
7349 BFD_ASSERT (output_section != NULL);
7350
7351 if (IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA (output_section, segment, map->p_paddr,
7352 opb)
7353 || IS_COREFILE_NOTE (segment, section))
7354 {
7355 if (map->count == 0)
7356 {
7357 /* If the first section in a segment does not start at
7358 the beginning of the segment, then something is
7359 wrong. */
7360 if (align_power (map->p_paddr
7361 + (map->includes_filehdr
7362 ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0)
7363 + (map->includes_phdrs
7364 ? iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize
7365 : 0),
7366 output_section->alignment_power * opb)
7367 != output_section->lma * opb)
7368 goto sorry;
7369 }
7370 else
7371 {
7372 asection *prev_sec;
7373
7374 prev_sec = map->sections[map->count - 1];
7375
7376 /* If the gap between the end of the previous section
7377 and the start of this section is more than
7378 maxpagesize then we need to start a new segment. */
7379 if ((BFD_ALIGN (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size,
7380 maxpagesize)
7381 < BFD_ALIGN (output_section->lma, maxpagesize))
7382 || (prev_sec->lma + prev_sec->size
7383 > output_section->lma))
7384 {
7385 if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7386 suggested_lma = output_section;
7387
7388 continue;
7389 }
7390 }
7391
7392 map->sections[map->count++] = output_section;
7393 ++isec;
7394 sections[j] = NULL;
7395 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD)
7396 section->segment_mark = TRUE;
7397 }
7398 else if (suggested_lma == NULL)
7399 suggested_lma = output_section;
7400 }
7401
7402 /* PR 23932. A corrupt input file may contain sections that cannot
7403 be assigned to any segment - because for example they have a
7404 negative size - or segments that do not contain any sections.
7405 But there are also valid reasons why a segment can be empty.
7406 So allow a count of zero. */
7407
7408 /* Add the current segment to the list of built segments. */
7409 *pointer_to_map = map;
7410 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7411
7412 if (isec < section_count)
7413 {
7414 /* We still have not allocated all of the sections to
7415 segments. Create a new segment here, initialise it
7416 and carry on looping. */
7417 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
7418 amt += section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7419 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7420 if (map == NULL)
7421 {
7422 free (sections);
7423 return FALSE;
7424 }
7425
7426 /* Initialise the fields of the segment map. Set the physical
7427 physical address to the LMA of the first section that has
7428 not yet been assigned. */
7429 map->next = NULL;
7430 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7431 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7432 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7433 map->p_paddr = suggested_lma->lma * opb;
7434 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7435 map->includes_filehdr = 0;
7436 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7437 }
7438
7439 continue;
7440 sorry:
7441 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry);
7442 free (sections);
7443 return FALSE;
7444 }
7445 while (isec < section_count);
7446
7447 free (sections);
7448 }
7449
7450 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7451
7452 /* If we had to estimate the number of program headers that were
7453 going to be needed, then check our estimate now and adjust
7454 the offset if necessary. */
7455 if (phdr_adjust_seg != NULL)
7456 {
7457 unsigned int count;
7458
7459 for (count = 0, map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7460 count++;
7461
7462 if (count > phdr_adjust_num)
7463 phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr
7464 -= (count - phdr_adjust_num) * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7465
7466 for (map = map_first; map != NULL; map = map->next)
7467 if (map->p_type == PT_PHDR)
7468 {
7469 bfd_vma adjust
7470 = phdr_adjust_seg->includes_filehdr ? iehdr->e_ehsize : 0;
7471 map->p_paddr = phdr_adjust_seg->p_paddr + adjust;
7472 break;
7473 }
7474 }
7475
7476 #undef SEGMENT_END
7477 #undef SECTION_SIZE
7478 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_VMA
7479 #undef IS_CONTAINED_BY_LMA
7480 #undef IS_NOTE
7481 #undef IS_COREFILE_NOTE
7482 #undef IS_SOLARIS_PT_INTERP
7483 #undef IS_SECTION_IN_INPUT_SEGMENT
7484 #undef INCLUDE_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT
7485 #undef SEGMENT_AFTER_SEGMENT
7486 #undef SEGMENT_OVERLAPS
7487 return TRUE;
7488 }
7489
7490 /* Copy ELF program header information. */
7491
7492 static bfd_boolean
7493 copy_elf_program_header (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7494 {
7495 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *iehdr;
7496 struct elf_segment_map *map;
7497 struct elf_segment_map *map_first;
7498 struct elf_segment_map **pointer_to_map;
7499 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7500 unsigned int i;
7501 unsigned int num_segments;
7502 bfd_boolean phdr_included = FALSE;
7503 bfd_boolean p_paddr_valid;
7504 unsigned int opb = bfd_octets_per_byte (ibfd, NULL);
7505
7506 iehdr = elf_elfheader (ibfd);
7507
7508 map_first = NULL;
7509 pointer_to_map = &map_first;
7510
7511 /* If all the segment p_paddr fields are zero, don't set
7512 map->p_paddr_valid. */
7513 p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7514 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7515 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7516 i < num_segments;
7517 i++, segment++)
7518 if (segment->p_paddr != 0)
7519 {
7520 p_paddr_valid = TRUE;
7521 break;
7522 }
7523
7524 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7525 i < num_segments;
7526 i++, segment++)
7527 {
7528 asection *section;
7529 unsigned int section_count;
7530 size_t amt;
7531 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7532 asection *first_section = NULL;
7533 asection *lowest_section;
7534
7535 /* Compute how many sections are in this segment. */
7536 for (section = ibfd->sections, section_count = 0;
7537 section != NULL;
7538 section = section->next)
7539 {
7540 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7541 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7542 {
7543 if (first_section == NULL)
7544 first_section = section;
7545 section_count++;
7546 }
7547 }
7548
7549 /* Allocate a segment map big enough to contain
7550 all of the sections we have selected. */
7551 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map) - sizeof (asection *);
7552 amt += section_count * sizeof (asection *);
7553 map = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (obfd, amt);
7554 if (map == NULL)
7555 return FALSE;
7556
7557 /* Initialize the fields of the output segment map with the
7558 input segment. */
7559 map->next = NULL;
7560 map->p_type = segment->p_type;
7561 map->p_flags = segment->p_flags;
7562 map->p_flags_valid = 1;
7563 map->p_paddr = segment->p_paddr;
7564 map->p_paddr_valid = p_paddr_valid;
7565 map->p_align = segment->p_align;
7566 map->p_align_valid = 1;
7567 map->p_vaddr_offset = 0;
7568
7569 if (map->p_type == PT_GNU_RELRO
7570 || map->p_type == PT_GNU_STACK)
7571 {
7572 /* The PT_GNU_RELRO segment may contain the first a few
7573 bytes in the .got.plt section even if the whole .got.plt
7574 section isn't in the PT_GNU_RELRO segment. We won't
7575 change the size of the PT_GNU_RELRO segment.
7576 Similarly, PT_GNU_STACK size is significant on uclinux
7577 systems. */
7578 map->p_size = segment->p_memsz;
7579 map->p_size_valid = 1;
7580 }
7581
7582 /* Determine if this segment contains the ELF file header
7583 and if it contains the program headers themselves. */
7584 map->includes_filehdr = (segment->p_offset == 0
7585 && segment->p_filesz >= iehdr->e_ehsize);
7586
7587 map->includes_phdrs = 0;
7588 if (! phdr_included || segment->p_type != PT_LOAD)
7589 {
7590 map->includes_phdrs =
7591 (segment->p_offset <= (bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7592 && (segment->p_offset + segment->p_filesz
7593 >= ((bfd_vma) iehdr->e_phoff
7594 + iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize)));
7595
7596 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD && map->includes_phdrs)
7597 phdr_included = TRUE;
7598 }
7599
7600 lowest_section = NULL;
7601 if (section_count != 0)
7602 {
7603 unsigned int isec = 0;
7604
7605 for (section = first_section;
7606 section != NULL;
7607 section = section->next)
7608 {
7609 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7610 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7611 {
7612 map->sections[isec++] = section->output_section;
7613 if ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
7614 {
7615 bfd_vma seg_off;
7616
7617 if (lowest_section == NULL
7618 || section->lma < lowest_section->lma)
7619 lowest_section = section;
7620
7621 /* Section lmas are set up from PT_LOAD header
7622 p_paddr in _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr.
7623 If this header has a p_paddr that disagrees
7624 with the section lma, flag the p_paddr as
7625 invalid. */
7626 if ((section->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
7627 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_offset - segment->p_offset;
7628 else
7629 seg_off = this_hdr->sh_addr - segment->p_vaddr;
7630 if (section->lma * opb - segment->p_paddr != seg_off)
7631 map->p_paddr_valid = FALSE;
7632 }
7633 if (isec == section_count)
7634 break;
7635 }
7636 }
7637 }
7638
7639 if (section_count == 0)
7640 map->p_vaddr_offset = segment->p_vaddr / opb;
7641 else if (map->p_paddr_valid)
7642 {
7643 /* Account for padding before the first section in the segment. */
7644 bfd_vma hdr_size = 0;
7645 if (map->includes_filehdr)
7646 hdr_size = iehdr->e_ehsize;
7647 if (map->includes_phdrs)
7648 hdr_size += iehdr->e_phnum * iehdr->e_phentsize;
7649
7650 map->p_vaddr_offset = ((map->p_paddr + hdr_size) / opb
7651 - (lowest_section ? lowest_section->lma : 0));
7652 }
7653
7654 map->count = section_count;
7655 *pointer_to_map = map;
7656 pointer_to_map = &map->next;
7657 }
7658
7659 elf_seg_map (obfd) = map_first;
7660 return TRUE;
7661 }
7662
7663 /* Copy private BFD data. This copies or rewrites ELF program header
7664 information. */
7665
7666 static bfd_boolean
7667 copy_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7668 {
7669 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7670 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7671 return TRUE;
7672
7673 if (elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr == NULL)
7674 return TRUE;
7675
7676 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7677 {
7678 /* Check to see if any sections in the input BFD
7679 covered by ELF program header have changed. */
7680 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7681 asection *section, *osec;
7682 unsigned int i, num_segments;
7683 Elf_Internal_Shdr *this_hdr;
7684 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
7685
7686 bed = get_elf_backend_data (ibfd);
7687
7688 /* Regenerate the segment map if p_paddr is set to 0. */
7689 if (bed->want_p_paddr_set_to_zero)
7690 goto rewrite;
7691
7692 /* Initialize the segment mark field. */
7693 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7694 section = section->next)
7695 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7696
7697 num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7698 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7699 i < num_segments;
7700 i++, segment++)
7701 {
7702 /* PR binutils/3535. The Solaris linker always sets the p_paddr
7703 and p_memsz fields of special segments (DYNAMIC, INTERP) to 0
7704 which severly confuses things, so always regenerate the segment
7705 map in this case. */
7706 if (segment->p_paddr == 0
7707 && segment->p_memsz == 0
7708 && (segment->p_type == PT_INTERP || segment->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC))
7709 goto rewrite;
7710
7711 for (section = ibfd->sections;
7712 section != NULL; section = section->next)
7713 {
7714 /* We mark the output section so that we know it comes
7715 from the input BFD. */
7716 osec = section->output_section;
7717 if (osec)
7718 osec->segment_mark = TRUE;
7719
7720 /* Check if this section is covered by the segment. */
7721 this_hdr = &(elf_section_data(section)->this_hdr);
7722 if (ELF_SECTION_IN_SEGMENT (this_hdr, segment))
7723 {
7724 /* FIXME: Check if its output section is changed or
7725 removed. What else do we need to check? */
7726 if (osec == NULL
7727 || section->flags != osec->flags
7728 || section->lma != osec->lma
7729 || section->vma != osec->vma
7730 || section->size != osec->size
7731 || section->rawsize != osec->rawsize
7732 || section->alignment_power != osec->alignment_power)
7733 goto rewrite;
7734 }
7735 }
7736 }
7737
7738 /* Check to see if any output section do not come from the
7739 input BFD. */
7740 for (section = obfd->sections; section != NULL;
7741 section = section->next)
7742 {
7743 if (!section->segment_mark)
7744 goto rewrite;
7745 else
7746 section->segment_mark = FALSE;
7747 }
7748
7749 return copy_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7750 }
7751
7752 rewrite:
7753 if (ibfd->xvec == obfd->xvec)
7754 {
7755 /* When rewriting program header, set the output maxpagesize to
7756 the maximum alignment of input PT_LOAD segments. */
7757 Elf_Internal_Phdr *segment;
7758 unsigned int i;
7759 unsigned int num_segments = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_phnum;
7760 bfd_vma maxpagesize = 0;
7761
7762 for (i = 0, segment = elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr;
7763 i < num_segments;
7764 i++, segment++)
7765 if (segment->p_type == PT_LOAD
7766 && maxpagesize < segment->p_align)
7767 {
7768 /* PR 17512: file: f17299af. */
7769 if (segment->p_align > (bfd_vma) 1 << ((sizeof (bfd_vma) * 8) - 2))
7770 /* xgettext:c-format */
7771 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: warning: segment alignment of %#"
7772 PRIx64 " is too large"),
7773 ibfd, (uint64_t) segment->p_align);
7774 else
7775 maxpagesize = segment->p_align;
7776 }
7777
7778 if (maxpagesize != get_elf_backend_data (obfd)->maxpagesize)
7779 bfd_emul_set_maxpagesize (bfd_get_target (obfd), maxpagesize);
7780 }
7781
7782 return rewrite_elf_program_header (ibfd, obfd);
7783 }
7784
7785 /* Initialize private output section information from input section. */
7786
7787 bfd_boolean
7788 _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7789 asection *isec,
7790 bfd *obfd,
7791 asection *osec,
7792 struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
7793
7794 {
7795 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7796 bfd_boolean final_link = (link_info != NULL
7797 && !bfd_link_relocatable (link_info));
7798
7799 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7800 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7801 return TRUE;
7802
7803 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec) != NULL);
7804
7805 /* If this is a known ABI section, ELF section type and flags may
7806 have been set up when OSEC was created. For normal sections we
7807 allow the user to override the type and flags other than
7808 SHF_MASKOS and SHF_MASKPROC. */
7809 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_PROGBITS
7810 || elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NOTE
7811 || elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NOBITS)
7812 elf_section_type (osec) = SHT_NULL;
7813 /* For objcopy and relocatable link, copy the ELF section type from
7814 the input file if the BFD section flags are the same. (If they
7815 are different the user may be doing something like
7816 "objcopy --set-section-flags .text=alloc,data".) For a final
7817 link allow some flags that the linker clears to differ. */
7818 if (elf_section_type (osec) == SHT_NULL
7819 && (osec->flags == isec->flags
7820 || (final_link
7821 && ((osec->flags ^ isec->flags)
7822 & ~(SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES | SEC_RELOC)) == 0)))
7823 elf_section_type (osec) = elf_section_type (isec);
7824
7825 /* FIXME: Is this correct for all OS/PROC specific flags? */
7826 elf_section_flags (osec) = (elf_section_flags (isec)
7827 & (SHF_MASKOS | SHF_MASKPROC));
7828
7829 /* Copy sh_info from input for mbind section. */
7830 if ((elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_mbind) != 0
7831 && elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GNU_MBIND)
7832 elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr.sh_info
7833 = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.sh_info;
7834
7835 /* Set things up for objcopy and relocatable link. The output
7836 SHT_GROUP section will have its elf_next_in_group pointing back
7837 to the input group members. Ignore linker created group section.
7838 See elfNN_ia64_object_p in elfxx-ia64.c. */
7839 if ((link_info == NULL
7840 || !link_info->resolve_section_groups)
7841 && (elf_sec_group (isec) == NULL
7842 || (elf_sec_group (isec)->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0))
7843 {
7844 if (elf_section_flags (isec) & SHF_GROUP)
7845 elf_section_flags (osec) |= SHF_GROUP;
7846 elf_next_in_group (osec) = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7847 elf_section_data (osec)->group = elf_section_data (isec)->group;
7848 }
7849
7850 /* If not decompress, preserve SHF_COMPRESSED. */
7851 if (!final_link && (ibfd->flags & BFD_DECOMPRESS) == 0)
7852 elf_section_flags (osec) |= (elf_section_flags (isec)
7853 & SHF_COMPRESSED);
7854
7855 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7856
7857 /* We need to handle elf_linked_to_section for SHF_LINK_ORDER. We
7858 don't use the output section of the linked-to section since it
7859 may be NULL at this point. */
7860 if ((ihdr->sh_flags & SHF_LINK_ORDER) != 0)
7861 {
7862 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7863 ohdr->sh_flags |= SHF_LINK_ORDER;
7864 elf_linked_to_section (osec) = elf_linked_to_section (isec);
7865 }
7866
7867 osec->use_rela_p = isec->use_rela_p;
7868
7869 return TRUE;
7870 }
7871
7872 /* Copy private section information. This copies over the entsize
7873 field, and sometimes the info field. */
7874
7875 bfd_boolean
7876 _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data (bfd *ibfd,
7877 asection *isec,
7878 bfd *obfd,
7879 asection *osec)
7880 {
7881 Elf_Internal_Shdr *ihdr, *ohdr;
7882
7883 if (ibfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7884 || obfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7885 return TRUE;
7886
7887 ihdr = &elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr;
7888 ohdr = &elf_section_data (osec)->this_hdr;
7889
7890 ohdr->sh_entsize = ihdr->sh_entsize;
7891
7892 if (ihdr->sh_type == SHT_SYMTAB
7893 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_DYNSYM
7894 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verneed
7895 || ihdr->sh_type == SHT_GNU_verdef)
7896 ohdr->sh_info = ihdr->sh_info;
7897
7898 return _bfd_elf_init_private_section_data (ibfd, isec, obfd, osec,
7899 NULL);
7900 }
7901
7902 /* Look at all the SHT_GROUP sections in IBFD, making any adjustments
7903 necessary if we are removing either the SHT_GROUP section or any of
7904 the group member sections. DISCARDED is the value that a section's
7905 output_section has if the section will be discarded, NULL when this
7906 function is called from objcopy, bfd_abs_section_ptr when called
7907 from the linker. */
7908
7909 bfd_boolean
7910 _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (bfd *ibfd, asection *discarded)
7911 {
7912 asection *isec;
7913
7914 for (isec = ibfd->sections; isec != NULL; isec = isec->next)
7915 if (elf_section_type (isec) == SHT_GROUP)
7916 {
7917 asection *first = elf_next_in_group (isec);
7918 asection *s = first;
7919 bfd_size_type removed = 0;
7920
7921 while (s != NULL)
7922 {
7923 /* If this member section is being output but the
7924 SHT_GROUP section is not, then clear the group info
7925 set up by _bfd_elf_copy_private_section_data. */
7926 if (s->output_section != discarded
7927 && isec->output_section == discarded)
7928 {
7929 elf_section_flags (s->output_section) &= ~SHF_GROUP;
7930 elf_group_name (s->output_section) = NULL;
7931 }
7932 /* Conversely, if the member section is not being output
7933 but the SHT_GROUP section is, then adjust its size. */
7934 else if (s->output_section == discarded
7935 && isec->output_section != discarded)
7936 {
7937 struct bfd_elf_section_data *elf_sec = elf_section_data (s);
7938 removed += 4;
7939 if (elf_sec->rel.hdr != NULL
7940 && (elf_sec->rel.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7941 removed += 4;
7942 if (elf_sec->rela.hdr != NULL
7943 && (elf_sec->rela.hdr->sh_flags & SHF_GROUP) != 0)
7944 removed += 4;
7945 }
7946 s = elf_next_in_group (s);
7947 if (s == first)
7948 break;
7949 }
7950 if (removed != 0)
7951 {
7952 if (discarded != NULL)
7953 {
7954 /* If we've been called for ld -r, then we need to
7955 adjust the input section size. */
7956 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
7957 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
7958 isec->size = isec->rawsize - removed;
7959 if (isec->size <= 4)
7960 {
7961 isec->size = 0;
7962 isec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7963 }
7964 }
7965 else
7966 {
7967 /* Adjust the output section size when called from
7968 objcopy. */
7969 isec->output_section->size -= removed;
7970 if (isec->output_section->size <= 4)
7971 {
7972 isec->output_section->size = 0;
7973 isec->output_section->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
7974 }
7975 }
7976 }
7977 }
7978
7979 return TRUE;
7980 }
7981
7982 /* Copy private header information. */
7983
7984 bfd_boolean
7985 _bfd_elf_copy_private_header_data (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
7986 {
7987 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
7988 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
7989 return TRUE;
7990
7991 /* Copy over private BFD data if it has not already been copied.
7992 This must be done here, rather than in the copy_private_bfd_data
7993 entry point, because the latter is called after the section
7994 contents have been set, which means that the program headers have
7995 already been worked out. */
7996 if (elf_seg_map (obfd) == NULL && elf_tdata (ibfd)->phdr != NULL)
7997 {
7998 if (! copy_private_bfd_data (ibfd, obfd))
7999 return FALSE;
8000 }
8001
8002 return _bfd_elf_fixup_group_sections (ibfd, NULL);
8003 }
8004
8005 /* Copy private symbol information. If this symbol is in a section
8006 which we did not map into a BFD section, try to map the section
8007 index correctly. We use special macro definitions for the mapped
8008 section indices; these definitions are interpreted by the
8009 swap_out_syms function. */
8010
8011 #define MAP_ONESYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 1)
8012 #define MAP_DYNSYMTAB (SHN_HIOS + 2)
8013 #define MAP_STRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 3)
8014 #define MAP_SHSTRTAB (SHN_HIOS + 4)
8015 #define MAP_SYM_SHNDX (SHN_HIOS + 5)
8016
8017 bfd_boolean
8018 _bfd_elf_copy_private_symbol_data (bfd *ibfd,
8019 asymbol *isymarg,
8020 bfd *obfd,
8021 asymbol *osymarg)
8022 {
8023 elf_symbol_type *isym, *osym;
8024
8025 if (bfd_get_flavour (ibfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour
8026 || bfd_get_flavour (obfd) != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
8027 return TRUE;
8028
8029 isym = elf_symbol_from (ibfd, isymarg);
8030 osym = elf_symbol_from (obfd, osymarg);
8031
8032 if (isym != NULL
8033 && isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0
8034 && osym != NULL
8035 && bfd_is_abs_section (isym->symbol.section))
8036 {
8037 unsigned int shndx;
8038
8039 shndx = isym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
8040 if (shndx == elf_onesymtab (ibfd))
8041 shndx = MAP_ONESYMTAB;
8042 else if (shndx == elf_dynsymtab (ibfd))
8043 shndx = MAP_DYNSYMTAB;
8044 else if (shndx == elf_strtab_sec (ibfd))
8045 shndx = MAP_STRTAB;
8046 else if (shndx == elf_shstrtab_sec (ibfd))
8047 shndx = MAP_SHSTRTAB;
8048 else if (find_section_in_list (shndx, elf_symtab_shndx_list (ibfd)))
8049 shndx = MAP_SYM_SHNDX;
8050 osym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx = shndx;
8051 }
8052
8053 return TRUE;
8054 }
8055
8056 /* Swap out the symbols. */
8057
8058 static bfd_boolean
8059 swap_out_syms (bfd *abfd,
8060 struct elf_strtab_hash **sttp,
8061 int relocatable_p)
8062 {
8063 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
8064 unsigned int symcount;
8065 asymbol **syms;
8066 struct elf_strtab_hash *stt;
8067 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
8068 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_shndx_hdr;
8069 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symstrtab_hdr;
8070 struct elf_sym_strtab *symstrtab;
8071 bfd_byte *outbound_syms;
8072 bfd_byte *outbound_shndx;
8073 unsigned long outbound_syms_index;
8074 unsigned long outbound_shndx_index;
8075 unsigned int idx;
8076 unsigned int num_locals;
8077 size_t amt;
8078 bfd_boolean name_local_sections;
8079
8080 if (!elf_map_symbols (abfd, &num_locals))
8081 return FALSE;
8082
8083 /* Dump out the symtabs. */
8084 stt = _bfd_elf_strtab_init ();
8085 if (stt == NULL)
8086 return FALSE;
8087
8088 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8089 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
8090 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8091 symtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB;
8092 symtab_hdr->sh_entsize = bed->s->sizeof_sym;
8093 symtab_hdr->sh_size = symtab_hdr->sh_entsize * (symcount + 1);
8094 symtab_hdr->sh_info = num_locals + 1;
8095 symtab_hdr->sh_addralign = (bfd_vma) 1 << bed->s->log_file_align;
8096
8097 symstrtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->strtab_hdr;
8098 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
8099
8100 /* Allocate buffer to swap out the .strtab section. */
8101 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount + 1, sizeof (*symstrtab), &amt)
8102 || (symstrtab = (struct elf_sym_strtab *) bfd_malloc (amt)) == NULL)
8103 {
8104 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
8105 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
8106 return FALSE;
8107 }
8108
8109 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount + 1, bed->s->sizeof_sym, &amt)
8110 || (outbound_syms = (bfd_byte *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt)) == NULL)
8111 {
8112 error_no_mem:
8113 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
8114 error_return:
8115 free (symstrtab);
8116 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (stt);
8117 return FALSE;
8118 }
8119 symtab_hdr->contents = outbound_syms;
8120 outbound_syms_index = 0;
8121
8122 outbound_shndx = NULL;
8123 outbound_shndx_index = 0;
8124
8125 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
8126 {
8127 symtab_shndx_hdr = & elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->hdr;
8128 if (symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_name != 0)
8129 {
8130 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (symcount + 1,
8131 sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx), &amt))
8132 goto error_no_mem;
8133 outbound_shndx = (bfd_byte *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8134 if (outbound_shndx == NULL)
8135 goto error_return;
8136
8137 symtab_shndx_hdr->contents = outbound_shndx;
8138 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_type = SHT_SYMTAB_SHNDX;
8139 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_size = amt;
8140 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_addralign = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
8141 symtab_shndx_hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx);
8142 }
8143 /* FIXME: What about any other headers in the list ? */
8144 }
8145
8146 /* Now generate the data (for "contents"). */
8147 {
8148 /* Fill in zeroth symbol and swap it out. */
8149 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
8150 sym.st_name = 0;
8151 sym.st_value = 0;
8152 sym.st_size = 0;
8153 sym.st_info = 0;
8154 sym.st_other = 0;
8155 sym.st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
8156 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
8157 symstrtab[0].sym = sym;
8158 symstrtab[0].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
8159 symstrtab[0].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
8160 outbound_syms_index++;
8161 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
8162 outbound_shndx_index++;
8163 }
8164
8165 name_local_sections
8166 = (bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols
8167 && bed->elf_backend_name_local_section_symbols (abfd));
8168
8169 syms = bfd_get_outsymbols (abfd);
8170 for (idx = 0; idx < symcount;)
8171 {
8172 Elf_Internal_Sym sym;
8173 bfd_vma value = syms[idx]->value;
8174 elf_symbol_type *type_ptr;
8175 flagword flags = syms[idx]->flags;
8176 int type;
8177
8178 if (!name_local_sections
8179 && (flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_GLOBAL)) == BSF_SECTION_SYM)
8180 {
8181 /* Local section symbols have no name. */
8182 sym.st_name = (unsigned long) -1;
8183 }
8184 else
8185 {
8186 /* Call _bfd_elf_strtab_offset after _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize
8187 to get the final offset for st_name. */
8188 sym.st_name
8189 = (unsigned long) _bfd_elf_strtab_add (stt, syms[idx]->name,
8190 FALSE);
8191 if (sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
8192 goto error_return;
8193 }
8194
8195 type_ptr = elf_symbol_from (abfd, syms[idx]);
8196
8197 if ((flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) == 0
8198 && bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
8199 {
8200 /* ELF common symbols put the alignment into the `value' field,
8201 and the size into the `size' field. This is backwards from
8202 how BFD handles it, so reverse it here. */
8203 sym.st_size = value;
8204 if (type_ptr == NULL
8205 || type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value == 0)
8206 sym.st_value = value >= 16 ? 16 : (1 << bfd_log2 (value));
8207 else
8208 sym.st_value = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_value;
8209 sym.st_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
8210 (abfd, syms[idx]->section);
8211 }
8212 else
8213 {
8214 asection *sec = syms[idx]->section;
8215 unsigned int shndx;
8216
8217 if (sec->output_section)
8218 {
8219 value += sec->output_offset;
8220 sec = sec->output_section;
8221 }
8222
8223 /* Don't add in the section vma for relocatable output. */
8224 if (! relocatable_p)
8225 value += sec->vma;
8226 sym.st_value = value;
8227 sym.st_size = type_ptr ? type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_size : 0;
8228
8229 if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec)
8230 && type_ptr != NULL
8231 && type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx != 0)
8232 {
8233 /* This symbol is in a real ELF section which we did
8234 not create as a BFD section. Undo the mapping done
8235 by copy_private_symbol_data. */
8236 shndx = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx;
8237 switch (shndx)
8238 {
8239 case MAP_ONESYMTAB:
8240 shndx = elf_onesymtab (abfd);
8241 break;
8242 case MAP_DYNSYMTAB:
8243 shndx = elf_dynsymtab (abfd);
8244 break;
8245 case MAP_STRTAB:
8246 shndx = elf_strtab_sec (abfd);
8247 break;
8248 case MAP_SHSTRTAB:
8249 shndx = elf_shstrtab_sec (abfd);
8250 break;
8251 case MAP_SYM_SHNDX:
8252 if (elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd))
8253 shndx = elf_symtab_shndx_list (abfd)->ndx;
8254 break;
8255 case SHN_COMMON:
8256 case SHN_ABS:
8257 shndx = SHN_ABS;
8258 break;
8259 default:
8260 if (shndx >= SHN_LOPROC && shndx <= SHN_HIOS)
8261 {
8262 if (bed->symbol_section_index)
8263 shndx = bed->symbol_section_index (abfd, type_ptr);
8264 /* Otherwise just leave the index alone. */
8265 }
8266 else
8267 {
8268 if (shndx > SHN_HIOS && shndx < SHN_HIRESERVE)
8269 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: \
8270 Unable to handle section index %x in ELF symbol. Using ABS instead."),
8271 abfd, shndx);
8272 shndx = SHN_ABS;
8273 }
8274 break;
8275 }
8276 }
8277 else
8278 {
8279 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
8280
8281 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
8282 {
8283 asection *sec2;
8284
8285 /* Writing this would be a hell of a lot easier if
8286 we had some decent documentation on bfd, and
8287 knew what to expect of the library, and what to
8288 demand of applications. For example, it
8289 appears that `objcopy' might not set the
8290 section of a symbol to be a section that is
8291 actually in the output file. */
8292 sec2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec->name);
8293 if (sec2 != NULL)
8294 shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec2);
8295 if (shndx == SHN_BAD)
8296 {
8297 /* xgettext:c-format */
8298 _bfd_error_handler
8299 (_("unable to find equivalent output section"
8300 " for symbol '%s' from section '%s'"),
8301 syms[idx]->name ? syms[idx]->name : "<Local sym>",
8302 sec->name);
8303 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8304 goto error_return;
8305 }
8306 }
8307 }
8308
8309 sym.st_shndx = shndx;
8310 }
8311
8312 if ((flags & BSF_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8313 type = STT_TLS;
8314 else if ((flags & BSF_GNU_INDIRECT_FUNCTION) != 0)
8315 type = STT_GNU_IFUNC;
8316 else if ((flags & BSF_FUNCTION) != 0)
8317 type = STT_FUNC;
8318 else if ((flags & BSF_OBJECT) != 0)
8319 type = STT_OBJECT;
8320 else if ((flags & BSF_RELC) != 0)
8321 type = STT_RELC;
8322 else if ((flags & BSF_SRELC) != 0)
8323 type = STT_SRELC;
8324 else
8325 type = STT_NOTYPE;
8326
8327 if (syms[idx]->section->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL)
8328 type = STT_TLS;
8329
8330 /* Processor-specific types. */
8331 if (type_ptr != NULL
8332 && bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8333 type = ((*bed->elf_backend_get_symbol_type)
8334 (&type_ptr->internal_elf_sym, type));
8335
8336 if (flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM)
8337 {
8338 if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8339 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
8340 else
8341 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_SECTION);
8342 }
8343 else if (bfd_is_com_section (syms[idx]->section))
8344 {
8345 if (type != STT_TLS)
8346 {
8347 if ((abfd->flags & BFD_CONVERT_ELF_COMMON))
8348 type = ((abfd->flags & BFD_USE_ELF_STT_COMMON)
8349 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8350 else
8351 type = ((flags & BSF_ELF_COMMON) != 0
8352 ? STT_COMMON : STT_OBJECT);
8353 }
8354 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, type);
8355 }
8356 else if (bfd_is_und_section (syms[idx]->section))
8357 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (((flags & BSF_WEAK)
8358 ? STB_WEAK
8359 : STB_GLOBAL),
8360 type);
8361 else if (flags & BSF_FILE)
8362 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FILE);
8363 else
8364 {
8365 int bind = STB_LOCAL;
8366
8367 if (flags & BSF_LOCAL)
8368 bind = STB_LOCAL;
8369 else if (flags & BSF_GNU_UNIQUE)
8370 bind = STB_GNU_UNIQUE;
8371 else if (flags & BSF_WEAK)
8372 bind = STB_WEAK;
8373 else if (flags & BSF_GLOBAL)
8374 bind = STB_GLOBAL;
8375
8376 sym.st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (bind, type);
8377 }
8378
8379 if (type_ptr != NULL)
8380 {
8381 sym.st_other = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_other;
8382 sym.st_target_internal
8383 = type_ptr->internal_elf_sym.st_target_internal;
8384 }
8385 else
8386 {
8387 sym.st_other = 0;
8388 sym.st_target_internal = 0;
8389 }
8390
8391 idx++;
8392 symstrtab[idx].sym = sym;
8393 symstrtab[idx].dest_index = outbound_syms_index;
8394 symstrtab[idx].destshndx_index = outbound_shndx_index;
8395
8396 outbound_syms_index++;
8397 if (outbound_shndx != NULL)
8398 outbound_shndx_index++;
8399 }
8400
8401 /* Finalize the .strtab section. */
8402 _bfd_elf_strtab_finalize (stt);
8403
8404 /* Swap out the .strtab section. */
8405 for (idx = 0; idx <= symcount; idx++)
8406 {
8407 struct elf_sym_strtab *elfsym = &symstrtab[idx];
8408 if (elfsym->sym.st_name == (unsigned long) -1)
8409 elfsym->sym.st_name = 0;
8410 else
8411 elfsym->sym.st_name = _bfd_elf_strtab_offset (stt,
8412 elfsym->sym.st_name);
8413 bed->s->swap_symbol_out (abfd, &elfsym->sym,
8414 (outbound_syms
8415 + (elfsym->dest_index
8416 * bed->s->sizeof_sym)),
8417 (outbound_shndx
8418 + (elfsym->destshndx_index
8419 * sizeof (Elf_External_Sym_Shndx))));
8420 }
8421 free (symstrtab);
8422
8423 *sttp = stt;
8424 symstrtab_hdr->sh_size = _bfd_elf_strtab_size (stt);
8425 symstrtab_hdr->sh_type = SHT_STRTAB;
8426 symstrtab_hdr->sh_flags = bed->elf_strtab_flags;
8427 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addr = 0;
8428 symstrtab_hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
8429 symstrtab_hdr->sh_link = 0;
8430 symstrtab_hdr->sh_info = 0;
8431 symstrtab_hdr->sh_addralign = 1;
8432
8433 return TRUE;
8434 }
8435
8436 /* Return the number of bytes required to hold the symtab vector.
8437
8438 Note that we base it on the count plus 1, since we will null terminate
8439 the vector allocated based on this size. However, the ELF symbol table
8440 always has a dummy entry as symbol #0, so it ends up even. */
8441
8442 long
8443 _bfd_elf_get_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8444 {
8445 bfd_size_type symcount;
8446 long symtab_size;
8447 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8448
8449 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8450 if (symcount >= LONG_MAX / sizeof (asymbol *))
8451 {
8452 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8453 return -1;
8454 }
8455 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8456 if (symcount > 0)
8457 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8458
8459 return symtab_size;
8460 }
8461
8462 long
8463 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_symtab_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8464 {
8465 bfd_size_type symcount;
8466 long symtab_size;
8467 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynsymtab_hdr;
8468
8469 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8470 {
8471 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8472 return -1;
8473 }
8474
8475 symcount = hdr->sh_size / get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym;
8476 if (symcount >= LONG_MAX / sizeof (asymbol *))
8477 {
8478 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8479 return -1;
8480 }
8481 symtab_size = (symcount + 1) * (sizeof (asymbol *));
8482 if (symcount > 0)
8483 symtab_size -= sizeof (asymbol *);
8484
8485 return symtab_size;
8486 }
8487
8488 long
8489 _bfd_elf_get_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8490 sec_ptr asect)
8491 {
8492 #if SIZEOF_LONG == SIZEOF_INT
8493 if (asect->reloc_count >= LONG_MAX / sizeof (arelent *))
8494 {
8495 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8496 return -1;
8497 }
8498 #endif
8499 return (asect->reloc_count + 1) * sizeof (arelent *);
8500 }
8501
8502 /* Canonicalize the relocs. */
8503
8504 long
8505 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8506 sec_ptr section,
8507 arelent **relptr,
8508 asymbol **symbols)
8509 {
8510 arelent *tblptr;
8511 unsigned int i;
8512 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8513
8514 if (! bed->s->slurp_reloc_table (abfd, section, symbols, FALSE))
8515 return -1;
8516
8517 tblptr = section->relocation;
8518 for (i = 0; i < section->reloc_count; i++)
8519 *relptr++ = tblptr++;
8520
8521 *relptr = NULL;
8522
8523 return section->reloc_count;
8524 }
8525
8526 long
8527 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_symtab (bfd *abfd, asymbol **allocation)
8528 {
8529 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8530 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, FALSE);
8531
8532 if (symcount >= 0)
8533 abfd->symcount = symcount;
8534 return symcount;
8535 }
8536
8537 long
8538 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
8539 asymbol **allocation)
8540 {
8541 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8542 long symcount = bed->s->slurp_symbol_table (abfd, allocation, TRUE);
8543
8544 if (symcount >= 0)
8545 abfd->dynsymcount = symcount;
8546 return symcount;
8547 }
8548
8549 /* Return the size required for the dynamic reloc entries. Any loadable
8550 section that was actually installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL
8551 or SHT_RELA, and uses the dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a
8552 dynamic reloc section. */
8553
8554 long
8555 _bfd_elf_get_dynamic_reloc_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
8556 {
8557 bfd_size_type count;
8558 asection *s;
8559
8560 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8561 {
8562 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8563 return -1;
8564 }
8565
8566 count = 1;
8567 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8568 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8569 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8570 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8571 {
8572 count += s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
8573 if (count > LONG_MAX / sizeof (arelent *))
8574 {
8575 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8576 return -1;
8577 }
8578 }
8579 return count * sizeof (arelent *);
8580 }
8581
8582 /* Canonicalize the dynamic relocation entries. Note that we return the
8583 dynamic relocations as a single block, although they are actually
8584 associated with particular sections; the interface, which was
8585 designed for SunOS style shared libraries, expects that there is only
8586 one set of dynamic relocs. Any loadable section that was actually
8587 installed in the BFD, and has type SHT_REL or SHT_RELA, and uses the
8588 dynamic symbol table, is considered to be a dynamic reloc section. */
8589
8590 long
8591 _bfd_elf_canonicalize_dynamic_reloc (bfd *abfd,
8592 arelent **storage,
8593 asymbol **syms)
8594 {
8595 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
8596 asection *s;
8597 long ret;
8598
8599 if (elf_dynsymtab (abfd) == 0)
8600 {
8601 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8602 return -1;
8603 }
8604
8605 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
8606 ret = 0;
8607 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
8608 {
8609 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_link == elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
8610 && (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_REL
8611 || elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_RELA))
8612 {
8613 arelent *p;
8614 long count, i;
8615
8616 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, s, syms, TRUE))
8617 return -1;
8618 count = s->size / elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_entsize;
8619 p = s->relocation;
8620 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
8621 *storage++ = p++;
8622 ret += count;
8623 }
8624 }
8625
8626 *storage = NULL;
8627
8628 return ret;
8629 }
8630 \f
8631 /* Read in the version information. */
8632
8633 bfd_boolean
8634 _bfd_elf_slurp_version_tables (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean default_imported_symver)
8635 {
8636 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
8637 unsigned int freeidx = 0;
8638 size_t amt;
8639
8640 if (elf_dynverref (abfd) != 0)
8641 {
8642 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8643 Elf_External_Verneed *everneed;
8644 Elf_Internal_Verneed *iverneed;
8645 unsigned int i;
8646 bfd_byte *contents_end;
8647
8648 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverref_hdr;
8649
8650 if (hdr->sh_info == 0
8651 || hdr->sh_info > hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed))
8652 {
8653 error_return_bad_verref:
8654 _bfd_error_handler
8655 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_r invalid entry"), abfd);
8656 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8657 error_return_verref:
8658 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = NULL;
8659 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = 0;
8660 goto error_return;
8661 }
8662
8663 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
8664 goto error_return_verref;
8665 contents = _bfd_malloc_and_read (abfd, hdr->sh_size, hdr->sh_size);
8666 if (contents == NULL)
8667 goto error_return_verref;
8668
8669 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (hdr->sh_info, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verneed), &amt))
8670 {
8671 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8672 goto error_return_verref;
8673 }
8674 elf_tdata (abfd)->verref = (Elf_Internal_Verneed *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
8675 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verref == NULL)
8676 goto error_return_verref;
8677
8678 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed)
8679 == sizeof (Elf_External_Vernaux));
8680 contents_end = contents + hdr->sh_size - sizeof (Elf_External_Verneed);
8681 everneed = (Elf_External_Verneed *) contents;
8682 iverneed = elf_tdata (abfd)->verref;
8683 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++, iverneed++)
8684 {
8685 Elf_External_Vernaux *evernaux;
8686 Elf_Internal_Vernaux *ivernaux;
8687 unsigned int j;
8688
8689 _bfd_elf_swap_verneed_in (abfd, everneed, iverneed);
8690
8691 iverneed->vn_bfd = abfd;
8692
8693 iverneed->vn_filename =
8694 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8695 iverneed->vn_file);
8696 if (iverneed->vn_filename == NULL)
8697 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8698
8699 if (iverneed->vn_cnt == 0)
8700 iverneed->vn_auxptr = NULL;
8701 else
8702 {
8703 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (iverneed->vn_cnt,
8704 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Vernaux), &amt))
8705 {
8706 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8707 goto error_return_verref;
8708 }
8709 iverneed->vn_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_vernaux *)
8710 bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
8711 if (iverneed->vn_auxptr == NULL)
8712 goto error_return_verref;
8713 }
8714
8715 if (iverneed->vn_aux
8716 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8717 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8718
8719 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8720 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_aux));
8721 ivernaux = iverneed->vn_auxptr;
8722 for (j = 0; j < iverneed->vn_cnt; j++, ivernaux++)
8723 {
8724 _bfd_elf_swap_vernaux_in (abfd, evernaux, ivernaux);
8725
8726 ivernaux->vna_nodename =
8727 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8728 ivernaux->vna_name);
8729 if (ivernaux->vna_nodename == NULL)
8730 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8731
8732 if (ivernaux->vna_other > freeidx)
8733 freeidx = ivernaux->vna_other;
8734
8735 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = NULL;
8736 if (ivernaux->vna_next == 0)
8737 {
8738 iverneed->vn_cnt = j + 1;
8739 break;
8740 }
8741 if (j + 1 < iverneed->vn_cnt)
8742 ivernaux->vna_nextptr = ivernaux + 1;
8743
8744 if (ivernaux->vna_next
8745 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) evernaux))
8746 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8747
8748 evernaux = ((Elf_External_Vernaux *)
8749 ((bfd_byte *) evernaux + ivernaux->vna_next));
8750 }
8751
8752 iverneed->vn_nextref = NULL;
8753 if (iverneed->vn_next == 0)
8754 break;
8755 if (i + 1 < hdr->sh_info)
8756 iverneed->vn_nextref = iverneed + 1;
8757
8758 if (iverneed->vn_next
8759 > (size_t) (contents_end - (bfd_byte *) everneed))
8760 goto error_return_bad_verref;
8761
8762 everneed = ((Elf_External_Verneed *)
8763 ((bfd_byte *) everneed + iverneed->vn_next));
8764 }
8765 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverrefs = i;
8766
8767 free (contents);
8768 contents = NULL;
8769 }
8770
8771 if (elf_dynverdef (abfd) != 0)
8772 {
8773 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
8774 Elf_External_Verdef *everdef;
8775 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8776 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdefarr;
8777 Elf_Internal_Verdef iverdefmem;
8778 unsigned int i;
8779 unsigned int maxidx;
8780 bfd_byte *contents_end_def, *contents_end_aux;
8781
8782 hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->dynverdef_hdr;
8783
8784 if (hdr->sh_info == 0 || hdr->sh_size < sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef))
8785 {
8786 error_return_bad_verdef:
8787 _bfd_error_handler
8788 (_("%pB: .gnu.version_d invalid entry"), abfd);
8789 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8790 error_return_verdef:
8791 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = NULL;
8792 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = 0;
8793 goto error_return;
8794 }
8795
8796 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
8797 goto error_return_verdef;
8798 contents = _bfd_malloc_and_read (abfd, hdr->sh_size, hdr->sh_size);
8799 if (contents == NULL)
8800 goto error_return_verdef;
8801
8802 BFD_ASSERT (sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef)
8803 >= sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux));
8804 contents_end_def = contents + hdr->sh_size
8805 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdef);
8806 contents_end_aux = contents + hdr->sh_size
8807 - sizeof (Elf_External_Verdaux);
8808
8809 /* We know the number of entries in the section but not the maximum
8810 index. Therefore we have to run through all entries and find
8811 the maximum. */
8812 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8813 maxidx = 0;
8814 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; ++i)
8815 {
8816 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8817
8818 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) == 0)
8819 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8820 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION)) > maxidx)
8821 maxidx = iverdefmem.vd_ndx & ((unsigned) VERSYM_VERSION);
8822
8823 if (iverdefmem.vd_next == 0)
8824 break;
8825
8826 if (iverdefmem.vd_next
8827 > (size_t) (contents_end_def - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8828 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8829
8830 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8831 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdefmem.vd_next));
8832 }
8833
8834 if (default_imported_symver)
8835 {
8836 if (freeidx > maxidx)
8837 maxidx = ++freeidx;
8838 else
8839 freeidx = ++maxidx;
8840 }
8841 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (maxidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef), &amt))
8842 {
8843 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8844 goto error_return_verdef;
8845 }
8846 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8847 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8848 goto error_return_verdef;
8849
8850 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = maxidx;
8851
8852 everdef = (Elf_External_Verdef *) contents;
8853 iverdefarr = elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef;
8854 for (i = 0; i < hdr->sh_info; i++)
8855 {
8856 Elf_External_Verdaux *everdaux;
8857 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8858 unsigned int j;
8859
8860 _bfd_elf_swap_verdef_in (abfd, everdef, &iverdefmem);
8861
8862 if ((iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) == 0)
8863 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8864
8865 iverdef = &iverdefarr[(iverdefmem.vd_ndx & VERSYM_VERSION) - 1];
8866 memcpy (iverdef, &iverdefmem, offsetof (Elf_Internal_Verdef, vd_bfd));
8867
8868 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8869
8870 if (iverdef->vd_cnt == 0)
8871 iverdef->vd_auxptr = NULL;
8872 else
8873 {
8874 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (iverdef->vd_cnt,
8875 sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux), &amt))
8876 {
8877 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8878 goto error_return_verdef;
8879 }
8880 iverdef->vd_auxptr = (struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8881 bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
8882 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8883 goto error_return_verdef;
8884 }
8885
8886 if (iverdef->vd_aux
8887 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdef))
8888 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8889
8890 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8891 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_aux));
8892 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8893 for (j = 0; j < iverdef->vd_cnt; j++, iverdaux++)
8894 {
8895 _bfd_elf_swap_verdaux_in (abfd, everdaux, iverdaux);
8896
8897 iverdaux->vda_nodename =
8898 bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (abfd, hdr->sh_link,
8899 iverdaux->vda_name);
8900 if (iverdaux->vda_nodename == NULL)
8901 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8902
8903 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = NULL;
8904 if (iverdaux->vda_next == 0)
8905 {
8906 iverdef->vd_cnt = j + 1;
8907 break;
8908 }
8909 if (j + 1 < iverdef->vd_cnt)
8910 iverdaux->vda_nextptr = iverdaux + 1;
8911
8912 if (iverdaux->vda_next
8913 > (size_t) (contents_end_aux - (bfd_byte *) everdaux))
8914 goto error_return_bad_verdef;
8915
8916 everdaux = ((Elf_External_Verdaux *)
8917 ((bfd_byte *) everdaux + iverdaux->vda_next));
8918 }
8919
8920 iverdef->vd_nodename = NULL;
8921 if (iverdef->vd_cnt)
8922 iverdef->vd_nodename = iverdef->vd_auxptr->vda_nodename;
8923
8924 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8925 if (iverdef->vd_next == 0)
8926 break;
8927 if ((size_t) (iverdef - iverdefarr) + 1 < maxidx)
8928 iverdef->vd_nextdef = iverdef + 1;
8929
8930 everdef = ((Elf_External_Verdef *)
8931 ((bfd_byte *) everdef + iverdef->vd_next));
8932 }
8933
8934 free (contents);
8935 contents = NULL;
8936 }
8937 else if (default_imported_symver)
8938 {
8939 if (freeidx < 3)
8940 freeidx = 3;
8941 else
8942 freeidx++;
8943
8944 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (freeidx, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdef), &amt))
8945 {
8946 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
8947 goto error_return;
8948 }
8949 elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef = (Elf_Internal_Verdef *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8950 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef == NULL)
8951 goto error_return;
8952
8953 elf_tdata (abfd)->cverdefs = freeidx;
8954 }
8955
8956 /* Create a default version based on the soname. */
8957 if (default_imported_symver)
8958 {
8959 Elf_Internal_Verdef *iverdef;
8960 Elf_Internal_Verdaux *iverdaux;
8961
8962 iverdef = &elf_tdata (abfd)->verdef[freeidx - 1];
8963
8964 iverdef->vd_version = VER_DEF_CURRENT;
8965 iverdef->vd_flags = 0;
8966 iverdef->vd_ndx = freeidx;
8967 iverdef->vd_cnt = 1;
8968
8969 iverdef->vd_bfd = abfd;
8970
8971 iverdef->vd_nodename = bfd_elf_get_dt_soname (abfd);
8972 if (iverdef->vd_nodename == NULL)
8973 goto error_return_verdef;
8974 iverdef->vd_nextdef = NULL;
8975 iverdef->vd_auxptr = ((struct elf_internal_verdaux *)
8976 bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (Elf_Internal_Verdaux)));
8977 if (iverdef->vd_auxptr == NULL)
8978 goto error_return_verdef;
8979
8980 iverdaux = iverdef->vd_auxptr;
8981 iverdaux->vda_nodename = iverdef->vd_nodename;
8982 }
8983
8984 return TRUE;
8985
8986 error_return:
8987 if (contents != NULL)
8988 free (contents);
8989 return FALSE;
8990 }
8991 \f
8992 asymbol *
8993 _bfd_elf_make_empty_symbol (bfd *abfd)
8994 {
8995 elf_symbol_type *newsym;
8996
8997 newsym = (elf_symbol_type *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*newsym));
8998 if (!newsym)
8999 return NULL;
9000 newsym->symbol.the_bfd = abfd;
9001 return &newsym->symbol;
9002 }
9003
9004 void
9005 _bfd_elf_get_symbol_info (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9006 asymbol *symbol,
9007 symbol_info *ret)
9008 {
9009 bfd_symbol_info (symbol, ret);
9010 }
9011
9012 /* Return whether a symbol name implies a local symbol. Most targets
9013 use this function for the is_local_label_name entry point, but some
9014 override it. */
9015
9016 bfd_boolean
9017 _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9018 const char *name)
9019 {
9020 /* Normal local symbols start with ``.L''. */
9021 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == 'L')
9022 return TRUE;
9023
9024 /* At least some SVR4 compilers (e.g., UnixWare 2.1 cc) generate
9025 DWARF debugging symbols starting with ``..''. */
9026 if (name[0] == '.' && name[1] == '.')
9027 return TRUE;
9028
9029 /* gcc will sometimes generate symbols beginning with ``_.L_'' when
9030 emitting DWARF debugging output. I suspect this is actually a
9031 small bug in gcc (it calls ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL when it should call
9032 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL, and this causes the leading
9033 underscore to be emitted on some ELF targets). For ease of use,
9034 we treat such symbols as local. */
9035 if (name[0] == '_' && name[1] == '.' && name[2] == 'L' && name[3] == '_')
9036 return TRUE;
9037
9038 /* Treat assembler generated fake symbols, dollar local labels and
9039 forward-backward labels (aka local labels) as locals.
9040 These labels have the form:
9041
9042 L0^A.* (fake symbols)
9043
9044 [.]?L[0123456789]+{^A|^B}[0123456789]* (local labels)
9045
9046 Versions which start with .L will have already been matched above,
9047 so we only need to match the rest. */
9048 if (name[0] == 'L' && ISDIGIT (name[1]))
9049 {
9050 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
9051 const char * p;
9052 char c;
9053
9054 for (p = name + 2; (c = *p); p++)
9055 {
9056 if (c == 1 || c == 2)
9057 {
9058 if (c == 1 && p == name + 2)
9059 /* A fake symbol. */
9060 return TRUE;
9061
9062 /* FIXME: We are being paranoid here and treating symbols like
9063 L0^Bfoo as if there were non-local, on the grounds that the
9064 assembler will never generate them. But can any symbol
9065 containing an ASCII value in the range 1-31 ever be anything
9066 other than some kind of local ? */
9067 ret = TRUE;
9068 }
9069
9070 if (! ISDIGIT (c))
9071 {
9072 ret = FALSE;
9073 break;
9074 }
9075 }
9076 return ret;
9077 }
9078
9079 return FALSE;
9080 }
9081
9082 alent *
9083 _bfd_elf_get_lineno (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9084 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9085 {
9086 abort ();
9087 return NULL;
9088 }
9089
9090 bfd_boolean
9091 _bfd_elf_set_arch_mach (bfd *abfd,
9092 enum bfd_architecture arch,
9093 unsigned long machine)
9094 {
9095 /* If this isn't the right architecture for this backend, and this
9096 isn't the generic backend, fail. */
9097 if (arch != get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch
9098 && arch != bfd_arch_unknown
9099 && get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->arch != bfd_arch_unknown)
9100 return FALSE;
9101
9102 return bfd_default_set_arch_mach (abfd, arch, machine);
9103 }
9104
9105 /* Find the nearest line to a particular section and offset,
9106 for error reporting. */
9107
9108 bfd_boolean
9109 _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd,
9110 asymbol **symbols,
9111 asection *section,
9112 bfd_vma offset,
9113 const char **filename_ptr,
9114 const char **functionname_ptr,
9115 unsigned int *line_ptr,
9116 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
9117 {
9118 bfd_boolean found;
9119
9120 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
9121 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
9122 line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
9123 dwarf_debug_sections,
9124 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info))
9125 return TRUE;
9126
9127 if (_bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
9128 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr, line_ptr))
9129 {
9130 if (!*functionname_ptr)
9131 _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
9132 *filename_ptr ? NULL : filename_ptr,
9133 functionname_ptr);
9134 return TRUE;
9135 }
9136
9137 if (! _bfd_stab_section_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
9138 &found, filename_ptr,
9139 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
9140 &elf_tdata (abfd)->line_info))
9141 return FALSE;
9142 if (found && (*functionname_ptr || *line_ptr))
9143 return TRUE;
9144
9145 if (symbols == NULL)
9146 return FALSE;
9147
9148 if (! _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
9149 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr))
9150 return FALSE;
9151
9152 *line_ptr = 0;
9153 return TRUE;
9154 }
9155
9156 /* Find the line for a symbol. */
9157
9158 bfd_boolean
9159 _bfd_elf_find_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols, asymbol *symbol,
9160 const char **filename_ptr, unsigned int *line_ptr)
9161 {
9162 return _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, symbol, NULL, 0,
9163 filename_ptr, NULL, line_ptr, NULL,
9164 dwarf_debug_sections,
9165 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9166 }
9167
9168 /* After a call to bfd_find_nearest_line, successive calls to
9169 bfd_find_inliner_info can be used to get source information about
9170 each level of function inlining that terminated at the address
9171 passed to bfd_find_nearest_line. Currently this is only supported
9172 for DWARF2 with appropriate DWARF3 extensions. */
9173
9174 bfd_boolean
9175 _bfd_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
9176 const char **filename_ptr,
9177 const char **functionname_ptr,
9178 unsigned int *line_ptr)
9179 {
9180 bfd_boolean found;
9181 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
9182 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
9183 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9184 return found;
9185 }
9186
9187 int
9188 _bfd_elf_sizeof_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
9189 {
9190 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
9191 int ret = bed->s->sizeof_ehdr;
9192
9193 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
9194 {
9195 bfd_size_type phdr_size = elf_program_header_size (abfd);
9196
9197 if (phdr_size == (bfd_size_type) -1)
9198 {
9199 struct elf_segment_map *m;
9200
9201 phdr_size = 0;
9202 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
9203 phdr_size += bed->s->sizeof_phdr;
9204
9205 if (phdr_size == 0)
9206 phdr_size = get_program_header_size (abfd, info);
9207 }
9208
9209 elf_program_header_size (abfd) = phdr_size;
9210 ret += phdr_size;
9211 }
9212
9213 return ret;
9214 }
9215
9216 bfd_boolean
9217 _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd,
9218 sec_ptr section,
9219 const void *location,
9220 file_ptr offset,
9221 bfd_size_type count)
9222 {
9223 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
9224 file_ptr pos;
9225
9226 if (! abfd->output_has_begun
9227 && ! _bfd_elf_compute_section_file_positions (abfd, NULL))
9228 return FALSE;
9229
9230 if (!count)
9231 return TRUE;
9232
9233 hdr = &elf_section_data (section)->this_hdr;
9234 if (hdr->sh_offset == (file_ptr) -1)
9235 {
9236 unsigned char *contents;
9237
9238 if (bfd_section_is_ctf (section))
9239 /* Nothing to do with this section: the contents are generated
9240 later. */
9241 return TRUE;
9242
9243 if ((section->flags & SEC_ELF_COMPRESS) == 0)
9244 {
9245 _bfd_error_handler
9246 (_("%pB:%pA: error: attempting to write into an unallocated compressed section"),
9247 abfd, section);
9248 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
9249 return FALSE;
9250 }
9251
9252 if ((offset + count) > hdr->sh_size)
9253 {
9254 _bfd_error_handler
9255 (_("%pB:%pA: error: attempting to write over the end of the section"),
9256 abfd, section);
9257
9258 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
9259 return FALSE;
9260 }
9261
9262 contents = hdr->contents;
9263 if (contents == NULL)
9264 {
9265 _bfd_error_handler
9266 (_("%pB:%pA: error: attempting to write section into an empty buffer"),
9267 abfd, section);
9268
9269 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
9270 return FALSE;
9271 }
9272
9273 memcpy (contents + offset, location, count);
9274 return TRUE;
9275 }
9276
9277 pos = hdr->sh_offset + offset;
9278 if (bfd_seek (abfd, pos, SEEK_SET) != 0
9279 || bfd_bwrite (location, count, abfd) != count)
9280 return FALSE;
9281
9282 return TRUE;
9283 }
9284
9285 bfd_boolean
9286 _bfd_elf_no_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9287 arelent *cache_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9288 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9289 {
9290 abort ();
9291 return FALSE;
9292 }
9293
9294 /* Try to convert a non-ELF reloc into an ELF one. */
9295
9296 bfd_boolean
9297 _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *areloc)
9298 {
9299 /* Check whether we really have an ELF howto. */
9300
9301 if ((*areloc->sym_ptr_ptr)->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec)
9302 {
9303 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code;
9304 reloc_howto_type *howto;
9305
9306 /* Alien reloc: Try to determine its type to replace it with an
9307 equivalent ELF reloc. */
9308
9309 if (areloc->howto->pc_relative)
9310 {
9311 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
9312 {
9313 case 8:
9314 code = BFD_RELOC_8_PCREL;
9315 break;
9316 case 12:
9317 code = BFD_RELOC_12_PCREL;
9318 break;
9319 case 16:
9320 code = BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL;
9321 break;
9322 case 24:
9323 code = BFD_RELOC_24_PCREL;
9324 break;
9325 case 32:
9326 code = BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL;
9327 break;
9328 case 64:
9329 code = BFD_RELOC_64_PCREL;
9330 break;
9331 default:
9332 goto fail;
9333 }
9334
9335 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
9336
9337 if (howto && areloc->howto->pcrel_offset != howto->pcrel_offset)
9338 {
9339 if (howto->pcrel_offset)
9340 areloc->addend += areloc->address;
9341 else
9342 areloc->addend -= areloc->address; /* addend is unsigned!! */
9343 }
9344 }
9345 else
9346 {
9347 switch (areloc->howto->bitsize)
9348 {
9349 case 8:
9350 code = BFD_RELOC_8;
9351 break;
9352 case 14:
9353 code = BFD_RELOC_14;
9354 break;
9355 case 16:
9356 code = BFD_RELOC_16;
9357 break;
9358 case 26:
9359 code = BFD_RELOC_26;
9360 break;
9361 case 32:
9362 code = BFD_RELOC_32;
9363 break;
9364 case 64:
9365 code = BFD_RELOC_64;
9366 break;
9367 default:
9368 goto fail;
9369 }
9370
9371 howto = bfd_reloc_type_lookup (abfd, code);
9372 }
9373
9374 if (howto)
9375 areloc->howto = howto;
9376 else
9377 goto fail;
9378 }
9379
9380 return TRUE;
9381
9382 fail:
9383 /* xgettext:c-format */
9384 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
9385 abfd, areloc->howto->name);
9386 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry);
9387 return FALSE;
9388 }
9389
9390 bfd_boolean
9391 _bfd_elf_close_and_cleanup (bfd *abfd)
9392 {
9393 struct elf_obj_tdata *tdata = elf_tdata (abfd);
9394 if (bfd_get_format (abfd) == bfd_object && tdata != NULL)
9395 {
9396 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->o != NULL && elf_shstrtab (abfd) != NULL)
9397 _bfd_elf_strtab_free (elf_shstrtab (abfd));
9398 _bfd_dwarf2_cleanup_debug_info (abfd, &tdata->dwarf2_find_line_info);
9399 }
9400
9401 return _bfd_generic_close_and_cleanup (abfd);
9402 }
9403
9404 /* For Rel targets, we encode meaningful data for BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY
9405 in the relocation's offset. Thus we cannot allow any sort of sanity
9406 range-checking to interfere. There is nothing else to do in processing
9407 this reloc. */
9408
9409 bfd_reloc_status_type
9410 _bfd_elf_rel_vtable_reloc_fn
9411 (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *re ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9412 struct bfd_symbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9413 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *is ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9414 bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, char **errmsg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9415 {
9416 return bfd_reloc_ok;
9417 }
9418 \f
9419 /* Elf core file support. Much of this only works on native
9420 toolchains, since we rely on knowing the
9421 machine-dependent procfs structure in order to pick
9422 out details about the corefile. */
9423
9424 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_PROCFS_H
9425 /* Needed for new procfs interface on sparc-solaris. */
9426 # define _STRUCTURED_PROC 1
9427 # include <sys/procfs.h>
9428 #endif
9429
9430 /* Return a PID that identifies a "thread" for threaded cores, or the
9431 PID of the main process for non-threaded cores. */
9432
9433 static int
9434 elfcore_make_pid (bfd *abfd)
9435 {
9436 int pid;
9437
9438 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid;
9439 if (pid == 0)
9440 pid = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid;
9441
9442 return pid;
9443 }
9444
9445 /* If there isn't a section called NAME, make one, using
9446 data from SECT. Note, this function will generate a
9447 reference to NAME, so you shouldn't deallocate or
9448 overwrite it. */
9449
9450 static bfd_boolean
9451 elfcore_maybe_make_sect (bfd *abfd, char *name, asection *sect)
9452 {
9453 asection *sect2;
9454
9455 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name) != NULL)
9456 return TRUE;
9457
9458 sect2 = bfd_make_section_with_flags (abfd, name, sect->flags);
9459 if (sect2 == NULL)
9460 return FALSE;
9461
9462 sect2->size = sect->size;
9463 sect2->filepos = sect->filepos;
9464 sect2->alignment_power = sect->alignment_power;
9465 return TRUE;
9466 }
9467
9468 /* Create a pseudosection containing SIZE bytes at FILEPOS. This
9469 actually creates up to two pseudosections:
9470 - For the single-threaded case, a section named NAME, unless
9471 such a section already exists.
9472 - For the multi-threaded case, a section named "NAME/PID", where
9473 PID is elfcore_make_pid (abfd).
9474 Both pseudosections have identical contents. */
9475 bfd_boolean
9476 _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9477 char *name,
9478 size_t size,
9479 ufile_ptr filepos)
9480 {
9481 char buf[100];
9482 char *threaded_name;
9483 size_t len;
9484 asection *sect;
9485
9486 /* Build the section name. */
9487
9488 sprintf (buf, "%s/%d", name, elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
9489 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
9490 threaded_name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
9491 if (threaded_name == NULL)
9492 return FALSE;
9493 memcpy (threaded_name, buf, len);
9494
9495 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, threaded_name,
9496 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9497 if (sect == NULL)
9498 return FALSE;
9499 sect->size = size;
9500 sect->filepos = filepos;
9501 sect->alignment_power = 2;
9502
9503 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, name, sect);
9504 }
9505
9506 static bfd_boolean
9507 elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note,
9508 size_t offs)
9509 {
9510 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".auxv",
9511 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
9512
9513 if (sect == NULL)
9514 return FALSE;
9515
9516 sect->size = note->descsz - offs;
9517 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offs;
9518 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
9519
9520 return TRUE;
9521 }
9522
9523 /* prstatus_t exists on:
9524 solaris 2.5+
9525 linux 2.[01] + glibc
9526 unixware 4.2
9527 */
9528
9529 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
9530
9531 static bfd_boolean
9532 elfcore_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9533 {
9534 size_t size;
9535 int offset;
9536
9537 if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus_t))
9538 {
9539 prstatus_t prstat;
9540
9541 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9542 offset = offsetof (prstatus_t, pr_reg);
9543 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9544
9545 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9546 has already been set by another thread. */
9547 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9548 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9549 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9550 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9551
9552 /* pr_who exists on:
9553 solaris 2.5+
9554 unixware 4.2
9555 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9556 linux 2.[01]
9557 */
9558 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T_PR_WHO)
9559 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9560 #else
9561 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9562 #endif
9563 }
9564 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
9565 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (prstatus32_t))
9566 {
9567 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9568 prstatus32_t prstat;
9569
9570 size = sizeof (prstat.pr_reg);
9571 offset = offsetof (prstatus32_t, pr_reg);
9572 memcpy (&prstat, note->descdata, sizeof (prstat));
9573
9574 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it
9575 has already been set by another thread. */
9576 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
9577 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = prstat.pr_cursig;
9578 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid == 0)
9579 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = prstat.pr_pid;
9580
9581 /* pr_who exists on:
9582 solaris 2.5+
9583 unixware 4.2
9584 pr_who doesn't exist on:
9585 linux 2.[01]
9586 */
9587 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T_PR_WHO)
9588 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_who;
9589 #else
9590 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = prstat.pr_pid;
9591 #endif
9592 }
9593 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T */
9594 else
9595 {
9596 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9597 note size (ie. data object type). */
9598 return TRUE;
9599 }
9600
9601 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
9602 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
9603 size, note->descpos + offset);
9604 }
9605 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T) */
9606
9607 /* Create a pseudosection containing the exact contents of NOTE. */
9608 static bfd_boolean
9609 elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (bfd *abfd,
9610 char *name,
9611 Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9612 {
9613 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, name,
9614 note->descsz, note->descpos);
9615 }
9616
9617 /* There isn't a consistent prfpregset_t across platforms,
9618 but it doesn't matter, because we don't have to pick this
9619 data structure apart. */
9620
9621 static bfd_boolean
9622 elfcore_grok_prfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9623 {
9624 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
9625 }
9626
9627 /* Linux dumps the Intel SSE regs in a note named "LINUX" with a note
9628 type of NT_PRXFPREG. Just include the whole note's contents
9629 literally. */
9630
9631 static bfd_boolean
9632 elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9633 {
9634 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
9635 }
9636
9637 /* Linux dumps the Intel XSAVE extended state in a note named "LINUX"
9638 with a note type of NT_X86_XSTATE. Just include the whole note's
9639 contents literally. */
9640
9641 static bfd_boolean
9642 elfcore_grok_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9643 {
9644 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xstate", note);
9645 }
9646
9647 static bfd_boolean
9648 elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9649 {
9650 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vmx", note);
9651 }
9652
9653 static bfd_boolean
9654 elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9655 {
9656 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-vsx", note);
9657 }
9658
9659 static bfd_boolean
9660 elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9661 {
9662 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tar", note);
9663 }
9664
9665 static bfd_boolean
9666 elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9667 {
9668 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-ppr", note);
9669 }
9670
9671 static bfd_boolean
9672 elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9673 {
9674 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-dscr", note);
9675 }
9676
9677 static bfd_boolean
9678 elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9679 {
9680 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-ebb", note);
9681 }
9682
9683 static bfd_boolean
9684 elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9685 {
9686 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-pmu", note);
9687 }
9688
9689 static bfd_boolean
9690 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9691 {
9692 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr", note);
9693 }
9694
9695 static bfd_boolean
9696 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9697 {
9698 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr", note);
9699 }
9700
9701 static bfd_boolean
9702 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9703 {
9704 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx", note);
9705 }
9706
9707 static bfd_boolean
9708 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9709 {
9710 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx", note);
9711 }
9712
9713 static bfd_boolean
9714 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9715 {
9716 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr", note);
9717 }
9718
9719 static bfd_boolean
9720 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9721 {
9722 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar", note);
9723 }
9724
9725 static bfd_boolean
9726 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9727 {
9728 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr", note);
9729 }
9730
9731 static bfd_boolean
9732 elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9733 {
9734 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr", note);
9735 }
9736
9737 static bfd_boolean
9738 elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9739 {
9740 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-high-gprs", note);
9741 }
9742
9743 static bfd_boolean
9744 elfcore_grok_s390_timer (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9745 {
9746 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-timer", note);
9747 }
9748
9749 static bfd_boolean
9750 elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9751 {
9752 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todcmp", note);
9753 }
9754
9755 static bfd_boolean
9756 elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9757 {
9758 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-todpreg", note);
9759 }
9760
9761 static bfd_boolean
9762 elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9763 {
9764 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-ctrs", note);
9765 }
9766
9767 static bfd_boolean
9768 elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9769 {
9770 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-prefix", note);
9771 }
9772
9773 static bfd_boolean
9774 elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9775 {
9776 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-last-break", note);
9777 }
9778
9779 static bfd_boolean
9780 elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9781 {
9782 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-system-call", note);
9783 }
9784
9785 static bfd_boolean
9786 elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9787 {
9788 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-tdb", note);
9789 }
9790
9791 static bfd_boolean
9792 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9793 {
9794 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low", note);
9795 }
9796
9797 static bfd_boolean
9798 elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9799 {
9800 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high", note);
9801 }
9802
9803 static bfd_boolean
9804 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9805 {
9806 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-cb", note);
9807 }
9808
9809 static bfd_boolean
9810 elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9811 {
9812 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-s390-gs-bc", note);
9813 }
9814
9815 static bfd_boolean
9816 elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9817 {
9818 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-arm-vfp", note);
9819 }
9820
9821 static bfd_boolean
9822 elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9823 {
9824 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-tls", note);
9825 }
9826
9827 static bfd_boolean
9828 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9829 {
9830 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-break", note);
9831 }
9832
9833 static bfd_boolean
9834 elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9835 {
9836 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch", note);
9837 }
9838
9839 static bfd_boolean
9840 elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9841 {
9842 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-sve", note);
9843 }
9844
9845 static bfd_boolean
9846 elfcore_grok_aarch_pauth (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9847 {
9848 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-aarch-pauth", note);
9849 }
9850
9851 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T)
9852 typedef prpsinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9853 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9854 typedef prpsinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9855 #endif
9856 #endif
9857
9858 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9859 typedef psinfo_t elfcore_psinfo_t;
9860 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T) /* Sparc64 cross Sparc32 */
9861 typedef psinfo32_t elfcore_psinfo32_t;
9862 #endif
9863 #endif
9864
9865 /* return a malloc'ed copy of a string at START which is at
9866 most MAX bytes long, possibly without a terminating '\0'.
9867 the copy will always have a terminating '\0'. */
9868
9869 char *
9870 _bfd_elfcore_strndup (bfd *abfd, char *start, size_t max)
9871 {
9872 char *dups;
9873 char *end = (char *) memchr (start, '\0', max);
9874 size_t len;
9875
9876 if (end == NULL)
9877 len = max;
9878 else
9879 len = end - start;
9880
9881 dups = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len + 1);
9882 if (dups == NULL)
9883 return NULL;
9884
9885 memcpy (dups, start, len);
9886 dups[len] = '\0';
9887
9888 return dups;
9889 }
9890
9891 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
9892 static bfd_boolean
9893 elfcore_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9894 {
9895 if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo_t))
9896 {
9897 elfcore_psinfo_t psinfo;
9898
9899 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9900
9901 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T_PR_PID)
9902 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9903 #endif
9904 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9905 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9906 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9907
9908 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9909 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9910 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9911 }
9912 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
9913 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (elfcore_psinfo32_t))
9914 {
9915 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9916 elfcore_psinfo32_t psinfo;
9917
9918 memcpy (&psinfo, note->descdata, sizeof (psinfo));
9919
9920 #if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T_PR_PID) || defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T_PR_PID)
9921 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = psinfo.pr_pid;
9922 #endif
9923 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
9924 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_fname,
9925 sizeof (psinfo.pr_fname));
9926
9927 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
9928 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, psinfo.pr_psargs,
9929 sizeof (psinfo.pr_psargs));
9930 }
9931 #endif
9932
9933 else
9934 {
9935 /* Fail - we don't know how to handle any other
9936 note size (ie. data object type). */
9937 return TRUE;
9938 }
9939
9940 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
9941 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
9942 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
9943
9944 {
9945 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
9946 int n = strlen (command);
9947
9948 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
9949 command[n - 1] = '\0';
9950 }
9951
9952 return TRUE;
9953 }
9954 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T) */
9955
9956 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
9957 static bfd_boolean
9958 elfcore_grok_pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9959 {
9960 if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus_t)
9961 #if defined (HAVE_PXSTATUS_T)
9962 || note->descsz == sizeof (pxstatus_t)
9963 #endif
9964 )
9965 {
9966 pstatus_t pstat;
9967
9968 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9969
9970 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9971 }
9972 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
9973 else if (note->descsz == sizeof (pstatus32_t))
9974 {
9975 /* 64-bit host, 32-bit corefile */
9976 pstatus32_t pstat;
9977
9978 memcpy (&pstat, note->descdata, sizeof (pstat));
9979
9980 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = pstat.pr_pid;
9981 }
9982 #endif
9983 /* Could grab some more details from the "representative"
9984 lwpstatus_t in pstat.pr_lwp, but we'll catch it all in an
9985 NT_LWPSTATUS note, presumably. */
9986
9987 return TRUE;
9988 }
9989 #endif /* defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T) */
9990
9991 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
9992 static bfd_boolean
9993 elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
9994 {
9995 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
9996 char buf[100];
9997 char *name;
9998 size_t len;
9999 asection *sect;
10000
10001 if (note->descsz != sizeof (lwpstat)
10002 #if defined (HAVE_LWPXSTATUS_T)
10003 && note->descsz != sizeof (lwpxstatus_t)
10004 #endif
10005 )
10006 return TRUE;
10007
10008 memcpy (&lwpstat, note->descdata, sizeof (lwpstat));
10009
10010 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwpstat.pr_lwpid;
10011 /* Do not overwrite the core signal if it has already been set by
10012 another thread. */
10013 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
10014 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = lwpstat.pr_cursig;
10015
10016 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
10017
10018 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
10019 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
10020 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10021 if (name == NULL)
10022 return FALSE;
10023 memcpy (name, buf, len);
10024
10025 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10026 if (sect == NULL)
10027 return FALSE;
10028
10029 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10030 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
10031 sect->filepos = note->descpos
10032 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs);
10033 #endif
10034
10035 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
10036 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg);
10037 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_reg);
10038 #endif
10039
10040 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10041
10042 if (!elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
10043 return FALSE;
10044
10045 /* Make a ".reg2/999" section */
10046
10047 sprintf (buf, ".reg2/%d", elfcore_make_pid (abfd));
10048 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
10049 name = bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10050 if (name == NULL)
10051 return FALSE;
10052 memcpy (name, buf, len);
10053
10054 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10055 if (sect == NULL)
10056 return FALSE;
10057
10058 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
10059 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
10060 sect->filepos = note->descpos
10061 + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_context.uc_mcontext.fpregs);
10062 #endif
10063
10064 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_FPREG)
10065 sect->size = sizeof (lwpstat.pr_fpreg);
10066 sect->filepos = note->descpos + offsetof (lwpstatus_t, pr_fpreg);
10067 #endif
10068
10069 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10070
10071 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg2", sect);
10072 }
10073 #endif /* defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T) */
10074
10075 static bfd_boolean
10076 elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10077 {
10078 char buf[30];
10079 char *name;
10080 size_t len;
10081 asection *sect;
10082 int type;
10083 int is_active_thread;
10084 bfd_vma base_addr;
10085
10086 if (note->descsz < 728)
10087 return TRUE;
10088
10089 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (note->namedata, "win32"))
10090 return TRUE;
10091
10092 type = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata);
10093
10094 switch (type)
10095 {
10096 case 1 /* NOTE_INFO_PROCESS */:
10097 /* FIXME: need to add ->core->command. */
10098 /* process_info.pid */
10099 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
10100 /* process_info.signal */
10101 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
10102 break;
10103
10104 case 2 /* NOTE_INFO_THREAD */:
10105 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
10106 /* thread_info.tid */
10107 sprintf (buf, ".reg/%ld", (long) bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8));
10108
10109 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
10110 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10111 if (name == NULL)
10112 return FALSE;
10113
10114 memcpy (name, buf, len);
10115
10116 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10117 if (sect == NULL)
10118 return FALSE;
10119
10120 /* sizeof (thread_info.thread_context) */
10121 sect->size = 716;
10122 /* offsetof (thread_info.thread_context) */
10123 sect->filepos = note->descpos + 12;
10124 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10125
10126 /* thread_info.is_active_thread */
10127 is_active_thread = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 8);
10128
10129 if (is_active_thread)
10130 if (! elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".reg", sect))
10131 return FALSE;
10132 break;
10133
10134 case 3 /* NOTE_INFO_MODULE */:
10135 /* Make a ".module/xxxxxxxx" section. */
10136 /* module_info.base_address */
10137 base_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 4);
10138 sprintf (buf, ".module/%08lx", (unsigned long) base_addr);
10139
10140 len = strlen (buf) + 1;
10141 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
10142 if (name == NULL)
10143 return FALSE;
10144
10145 memcpy (name, buf, len);
10146
10147 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10148
10149 if (sect == NULL)
10150 return FALSE;
10151
10152 sect->size = note->descsz;
10153 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10154 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10155 break;
10156
10157 default:
10158 return TRUE;
10159 }
10160
10161 return TRUE;
10162 }
10163
10164 static bfd_boolean
10165 elfcore_grok_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10166 {
10167 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10168
10169 switch (note->type)
10170 {
10171 default:
10172 return TRUE;
10173
10174 case NT_PRSTATUS:
10175 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus)
10176 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_prstatus) (abfd, note))
10177 return TRUE;
10178 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
10179 return elfcore_grok_prstatus (abfd, note);
10180 #else
10181 return TRUE;
10182 #endif
10183
10184 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
10185 case NT_PSTATUS:
10186 return elfcore_grok_pstatus (abfd, note);
10187 #endif
10188
10189 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
10190 case NT_LWPSTATUS:
10191 return elfcore_grok_lwpstatus (abfd, note);
10192 #endif
10193
10194 case NT_FPREGSET: /* FIXME: rename to NT_PRFPREG */
10195 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
10196
10197 case NT_WIN32PSTATUS:
10198 return elfcore_grok_win32pstatus (abfd, note);
10199
10200 case NT_PRXFPREG: /* Linux SSE extension */
10201 if (note->namesz == 6
10202 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10203 return elfcore_grok_prxfpreg (abfd, note);
10204 else
10205 return TRUE;
10206
10207 case NT_X86_XSTATE: /* Linux XSAVE extension */
10208 if (note->namesz == 6
10209 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10210 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
10211 else
10212 return TRUE;
10213
10214 case NT_PPC_VMX:
10215 if (note->namesz == 6
10216 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10217 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vmx (abfd, note);
10218 else
10219 return TRUE;
10220
10221 case NT_PPC_VSX:
10222 if (note->namesz == 6
10223 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10224 return elfcore_grok_ppc_vsx (abfd, note);
10225 else
10226 return TRUE;
10227
10228 case NT_PPC_TAR:
10229 if (note->namesz == 6
10230 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10231 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tar (abfd, note);
10232 else
10233 return TRUE;
10234
10235 case NT_PPC_PPR:
10236 if (note->namesz == 6
10237 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10238 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ppr (abfd, note);
10239 else
10240 return TRUE;
10241
10242 case NT_PPC_DSCR:
10243 if (note->namesz == 6
10244 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10245 return elfcore_grok_ppc_dscr (abfd, note);
10246 else
10247 return TRUE;
10248
10249 case NT_PPC_EBB:
10250 if (note->namesz == 6
10251 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10252 return elfcore_grok_ppc_ebb (abfd, note);
10253 else
10254 return TRUE;
10255
10256 case NT_PPC_PMU:
10257 if (note->namesz == 6
10258 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10259 return elfcore_grok_ppc_pmu (abfd, note);
10260 else
10261 return TRUE;
10262
10263 case NT_PPC_TM_CGPR:
10264 if (note->namesz == 6
10265 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10266 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd, note);
10267 else
10268 return TRUE;
10269
10270 case NT_PPC_TM_CFPR:
10271 if (note->namesz == 6
10272 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10273 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd, note);
10274 else
10275 return TRUE;
10276
10277 case NT_PPC_TM_CVMX:
10278 if (note->namesz == 6
10279 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10280 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd, note);
10281 else
10282 return TRUE;
10283
10284 case NT_PPC_TM_CVSX:
10285 if (note->namesz == 6
10286 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10287 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd, note);
10288 else
10289 return TRUE;
10290
10291 case NT_PPC_TM_SPR:
10292 if (note->namesz == 6
10293 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10294 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_spr (abfd, note);
10295 else
10296 return TRUE;
10297
10298 case NT_PPC_TM_CTAR:
10299 if (note->namesz == 6
10300 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10301 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd, note);
10302 else
10303 return TRUE;
10304
10305 case NT_PPC_TM_CPPR:
10306 if (note->namesz == 6
10307 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10308 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd, note);
10309 else
10310 return TRUE;
10311
10312 case NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR:
10313 if (note->namesz == 6
10314 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10315 return elfcore_grok_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd, note);
10316 else
10317 return TRUE;
10318
10319 case NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS:
10320 if (note->namesz == 6
10321 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10322 return elfcore_grok_s390_high_gprs (abfd, note);
10323 else
10324 return TRUE;
10325
10326 case NT_S390_TIMER:
10327 if (note->namesz == 6
10328 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10329 return elfcore_grok_s390_timer (abfd, note);
10330 else
10331 return TRUE;
10332
10333 case NT_S390_TODCMP:
10334 if (note->namesz == 6
10335 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10336 return elfcore_grok_s390_todcmp (abfd, note);
10337 else
10338 return TRUE;
10339
10340 case NT_S390_TODPREG:
10341 if (note->namesz == 6
10342 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10343 return elfcore_grok_s390_todpreg (abfd, note);
10344 else
10345 return TRUE;
10346
10347 case NT_S390_CTRS:
10348 if (note->namesz == 6
10349 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10350 return elfcore_grok_s390_ctrs (abfd, note);
10351 else
10352 return TRUE;
10353
10354 case NT_S390_PREFIX:
10355 if (note->namesz == 6
10356 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10357 return elfcore_grok_s390_prefix (abfd, note);
10358 else
10359 return TRUE;
10360
10361 case NT_S390_LAST_BREAK:
10362 if (note->namesz == 6
10363 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10364 return elfcore_grok_s390_last_break (abfd, note);
10365 else
10366 return TRUE;
10367
10368 case NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL:
10369 if (note->namesz == 6
10370 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10371 return elfcore_grok_s390_system_call (abfd, note);
10372 else
10373 return TRUE;
10374
10375 case NT_S390_TDB:
10376 if (note->namesz == 6
10377 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10378 return elfcore_grok_s390_tdb (abfd, note);
10379 else
10380 return TRUE;
10381
10382 case NT_S390_VXRS_LOW:
10383 if (note->namesz == 6
10384 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10385 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, note);
10386 else
10387 return TRUE;
10388
10389 case NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH:
10390 if (note->namesz == 6
10391 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10392 return elfcore_grok_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, note);
10393 else
10394 return TRUE;
10395
10396 case NT_S390_GS_CB:
10397 if (note->namesz == 6
10398 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10399 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_cb (abfd, note);
10400 else
10401 return TRUE;
10402
10403 case NT_S390_GS_BC:
10404 if (note->namesz == 6
10405 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10406 return elfcore_grok_s390_gs_bc (abfd, note);
10407 else
10408 return TRUE;
10409
10410 case NT_ARM_VFP:
10411 if (note->namesz == 6
10412 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10413 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10414 else
10415 return TRUE;
10416
10417 case NT_ARM_TLS:
10418 if (note->namesz == 6
10419 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10420 return elfcore_grok_aarch_tls (abfd, note);
10421 else
10422 return TRUE;
10423
10424 case NT_ARM_HW_BREAK:
10425 if (note->namesz == 6
10426 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10427 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_break (abfd, note);
10428 else
10429 return TRUE;
10430
10431 case NT_ARM_HW_WATCH:
10432 if (note->namesz == 6
10433 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10434 return elfcore_grok_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, note);
10435 else
10436 return TRUE;
10437
10438 case NT_ARM_SVE:
10439 if (note->namesz == 6
10440 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10441 return elfcore_grok_aarch_sve (abfd, note);
10442 else
10443 return TRUE;
10444
10445 case NT_ARM_PAC_MASK:
10446 if (note->namesz == 6
10447 && strcmp (note->namedata, "LINUX") == 0)
10448 return elfcore_grok_aarch_pauth (abfd, note);
10449 else
10450 return TRUE;
10451
10452 case NT_PRPSINFO:
10453 case NT_PSINFO:
10454 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo)
10455 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_psinfo) (abfd, note))
10456 return TRUE;
10457 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
10458 return elfcore_grok_psinfo (abfd, note);
10459 #else
10460 return TRUE;
10461 #endif
10462
10463 case NT_AUXV:
10464 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 0);
10465
10466 case NT_FILE:
10467 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.file",
10468 note);
10469
10470 case NT_SIGINFO:
10471 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.linuxcore.siginfo",
10472 note);
10473
10474 }
10475 }
10476
10477 static bfd_boolean
10478 elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10479 {
10480 struct bfd_build_id* build_id;
10481
10482 if (note->descsz == 0)
10483 return FALSE;
10484
10485 build_id = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (struct bfd_build_id) - 1 + note->descsz);
10486 if (build_id == NULL)
10487 return FALSE;
10488
10489 build_id->size = note->descsz;
10490 memcpy (build_id->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
10491 abfd->build_id = build_id;
10492
10493 return TRUE;
10494 }
10495
10496 static bfd_boolean
10497 elfobj_grok_gnu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10498 {
10499 switch (note->type)
10500 {
10501 default:
10502 return TRUE;
10503
10504 case NT_GNU_PROPERTY_TYPE_0:
10505 return _bfd_elf_parse_gnu_properties (abfd, note);
10506
10507 case NT_GNU_BUILD_ID:
10508 return elfobj_grok_gnu_build_id (abfd, note);
10509 }
10510 }
10511
10512 static bfd_boolean
10513 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10514 {
10515 struct sdt_note *cur =
10516 (struct sdt_note *) bfd_alloc (abfd,
10517 sizeof (struct sdt_note) + note->descsz);
10518
10519 cur->next = (struct sdt_note *) (elf_tdata (abfd))->sdt_note_head;
10520 cur->size = (bfd_size_type) note->descsz;
10521 memcpy (cur->data, note->descdata, note->descsz);
10522
10523 elf_tdata (abfd)->sdt_note_head = cur;
10524
10525 return TRUE;
10526 }
10527
10528 static bfd_boolean
10529 elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10530 {
10531 switch (note->type)
10532 {
10533 case NT_STAPSDT:
10534 return elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note_1 (abfd, note);
10535
10536 default:
10537 return TRUE;
10538 }
10539 }
10540
10541 static bfd_boolean
10542 elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10543 {
10544 size_t offset;
10545
10546 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
10547 {
10548 case ELFCLASS32:
10549 if (note->descsz < 108)
10550 return FALSE;
10551 break;
10552
10553 case ELFCLASS64:
10554 if (note->descsz < 120)
10555 return FALSE;
10556 break;
10557
10558 default:
10559 return FALSE;
10560 }
10561
10562 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10563 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
10564 return FALSE;
10565
10566 offset = 4;
10567
10568 /* Skip over pr_psinfosz. */
10569 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
10570 offset += 4;
10571 else
10572 {
10573 offset += 4; /* Padding before pr_psinfosz. */
10574 offset += 8;
10575 }
10576
10577 /* pr_fname is PRFNAMESZ (16) + 1 bytes in size. */
10578 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
10579 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 17);
10580 offset += 17;
10581
10582 /* pr_psargs is PRARGSZ (80) + 1 bytes in size. */
10583 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10584 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + offset, 81);
10585 offset += 81;
10586
10587 /* Padding before pr_pid. */
10588 offset += 2;
10589
10590 /* The pr_pid field was added in version "1a". */
10591 if (note->descsz < offset + 4)
10592 return TRUE;
10593
10594 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10595 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10596
10597 return TRUE;
10598 }
10599
10600 static bfd_boolean
10601 elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10602 {
10603 size_t offset;
10604 size_t size;
10605 size_t min_size;
10606
10607 /* Compute offset of pr_getregsz, skipping over pr_statussz.
10608 Also compute minimum size of this note. */
10609 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS])
10610 {
10611 case ELFCLASS32:
10612 offset = 4 + 4;
10613 min_size = offset + (4 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4;
10614 break;
10615
10616 case ELFCLASS64:
10617 offset = 4 + 4 + 8; /* Includes padding before pr_statussz. */
10618 min_size = offset + (8 * 2) + 4 + 4 + 4 + 4;
10619 break;
10620
10621 default:
10622 return FALSE;
10623 }
10624
10625 if (note->descsz < min_size)
10626 return FALSE;
10627
10628 /* Check for version 1 in pr_version. */
10629 if (bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata) != 1)
10630 return FALSE;
10631
10632 /* Extract size of pr_reg from pr_gregsetsz. */
10633 /* Skip over pr_gregsetsz and pr_fpregsetsz. */
10634 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
10635 {
10636 size = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10637 offset += 4 * 2;
10638 }
10639 else
10640 {
10641 size = bfd_h_get_64 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10642 offset += 8 * 2;
10643 }
10644
10645 /* Skip over pr_osreldate. */
10646 offset += 4;
10647
10648 /* Read signal from pr_cursig. */
10649 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal == 0)
10650 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10651 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10652 offset += 4;
10653
10654 /* Read TID from pr_pid. */
10655 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid
10656 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + offset);
10657 offset += 4;
10658
10659 /* Padding before pr_reg. */
10660 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
10661 offset += 4;
10662
10663 /* Make sure that there is enough data remaining in the note. */
10664 if ((note->descsz - offset) < size)
10665 return FALSE;
10666
10667 /* Make a ".reg/999" section and a ".reg" section. */
10668 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
10669 size, note->descpos + offset);
10670 }
10671
10672 static bfd_boolean
10673 elfcore_grok_freebsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10674 {
10675 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
10676
10677 switch (note->type)
10678 {
10679 case NT_PRSTATUS:
10680 if (bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus)
10681 if ((*bed->elf_backend_grok_freebsd_prstatus) (abfd, note))
10682 return TRUE;
10683 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_prstatus (abfd, note);
10684
10685 case NT_FPREGSET:
10686 return elfcore_grok_prfpreg (abfd, note);
10687
10688 case NT_PRPSINFO:
10689 return elfcore_grok_freebsd_psinfo (abfd, note);
10690
10691 case NT_FREEBSD_THRMISC:
10692 if (note->namesz == 8)
10693 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".thrmisc", note);
10694 else
10695 return TRUE;
10696
10697 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_PROC:
10698 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.proc",
10699 note);
10700
10701 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_FILES:
10702 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.files",
10703 note);
10704
10705 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_VMMAP:
10706 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.vmmap",
10707 note);
10708
10709 case NT_FREEBSD_PROCSTAT_AUXV:
10710 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 4);
10711
10712 case NT_X86_XSTATE:
10713 if (note->namesz == 8)
10714 return elfcore_grok_xstatereg (abfd, note);
10715 else
10716 return TRUE;
10717
10718 case NT_FREEBSD_PTLWPINFO:
10719 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.freebsdcore.lwpinfo",
10720 note);
10721
10722 case NT_ARM_VFP:
10723 return elfcore_grok_arm_vfp (abfd, note);
10724
10725 default:
10726 return TRUE;
10727 }
10728 }
10729
10730 static bfd_boolean
10731 elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (Elf_Internal_Note *note, int *lwpidp)
10732 {
10733 char *cp;
10734
10735 cp = strchr (note->namedata, '@');
10736 if (cp != NULL)
10737 {
10738 *lwpidp = atoi(cp + 1);
10739 return TRUE;
10740 }
10741 return FALSE;
10742 }
10743
10744 static bfd_boolean
10745 elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10746 {
10747 if (note->descsz <= 0x7c + 31)
10748 return FALSE;
10749
10750 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10751 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10752 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10753
10754 /* Process ID at offset 0x50. */
10755 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10756 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x50);
10757
10758 /* Command name at 0x7c (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10759 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10760 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x7c, 31);
10761
10762 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".note.netbsdcore.procinfo",
10763 note);
10764 }
10765
10766 static bfd_boolean
10767 elfcore_grok_netbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10768 {
10769 int lwp;
10770
10771 if (elfcore_netbsd_get_lwpid (note, &lwp))
10772 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = lwp;
10773
10774 switch (note->type)
10775 {
10776 case NT_NETBSDCORE_PROCINFO:
10777 /* NetBSD-specific core "procinfo". Note that we expect to
10778 find this note before any of the others, which is fine,
10779 since the kernel writes this note out first when it
10780 creates a core file. */
10781 return elfcore_grok_netbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10782 #ifdef NT_NETBSDCORE_AUXV
10783 case NT_NETBSDCORE_AUXV:
10784 /* NetBSD-specific Elf Auxiliary Vector data. */
10785 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 4);
10786 #endif
10787 #ifdef NT_NETBSDCORE_LWPSTATUS
10788 case NT_NETBSDCORE_LWPSTATUS:
10789 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd,
10790 ".note.netbsdcore.lwpstatus",
10791 note);
10792 #endif
10793 default:
10794 break;
10795 }
10796
10797 /* As of March 2020 there are no other machine-independent notes
10798 defined for NetBSD core files. If the note type is less
10799 than the start of the machine-dependent note types, we don't
10800 understand it. */
10801
10802 if (note->type < NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH)
10803 return TRUE;
10804
10805
10806 switch (bfd_get_arch (abfd))
10807 {
10808 /* On the Alpha, SPARC (32-bit and 64-bit), PT_GETREGS == mach+0 and
10809 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+2. */
10810
10811 case bfd_arch_aarch64:
10812 case bfd_arch_alpha:
10813 case bfd_arch_sparc:
10814 switch (note->type)
10815 {
10816 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+0:
10817 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10818
10819 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+2:
10820 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10821
10822 default:
10823 return TRUE;
10824 }
10825
10826 /* On SuperH, PT_GETREGS == mach+3 and PT_GETFPREGS == mach+5.
10827 There's also old PT___GETREGS40 == mach + 1 for old reg
10828 structure which lacks GBR. */
10829
10830 case bfd_arch_sh:
10831 switch (note->type)
10832 {
10833 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
10834 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10835
10836 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+5:
10837 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10838
10839 default:
10840 return TRUE;
10841 }
10842
10843 /* On all other arch's, PT_GETREGS == mach+1 and
10844 PT_GETFPREGS == mach+3. */
10845
10846 default:
10847 switch (note->type)
10848 {
10849 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+1:
10850 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10851
10852 case NT_NETBSDCORE_FIRSTMACH+3:
10853 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10854
10855 default:
10856 return TRUE;
10857 }
10858 }
10859 /* NOTREACHED */
10860 }
10861
10862 static bfd_boolean
10863 elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10864 {
10865 if (note->descsz <= 0x48 + 31)
10866 return FALSE;
10867
10868 /* Signal number at offset 0x08. */
10869 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal
10870 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x08);
10871
10872 /* Process ID at offset 0x20. */
10873 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
10874 = bfd_h_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) note->descdata + 0x20);
10875
10876 /* Command name at 0x48 (max 32 bytes, including nul). */
10877 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
10878 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 0x48, 31);
10879
10880 return TRUE;
10881 }
10882
10883 static bfd_boolean
10884 elfcore_grok_openbsd_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
10885 {
10886 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_PROCINFO)
10887 return elfcore_grok_openbsd_procinfo (abfd, note);
10888
10889 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_REGS)
10890 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg", note);
10891
10892 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_FPREGS)
10893 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg2", note);
10894
10895 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_XFPREGS)
10896 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg-xfp", note);
10897
10898 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_AUXV)
10899 return elfcore_make_auxv_note_section (abfd, note, 0);
10900
10901 if (note->type == NT_OPENBSD_WCOOKIE)
10902 {
10903 asection *sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".wcookie",
10904 SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10905
10906 if (sect == NULL)
10907 return FALSE;
10908 sect->size = note->descsz;
10909 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10910 sect->alignment_power = 1 + bfd_get_arch_size (abfd) / 32;
10911
10912 return TRUE;
10913 }
10914
10915 return TRUE;
10916 }
10917
10918 static bfd_boolean
10919 elfcore_grok_nto_status (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note, long *tid)
10920 {
10921 void *ddata = note->descdata;
10922 char buf[100];
10923 char *name;
10924 asection *sect;
10925 short sig;
10926 unsigned flags;
10927
10928 if (note->descsz < 16)
10929 return FALSE;
10930
10931 /* nto_procfs_status 'pid' field is at offset 0. */
10932 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata);
10933
10934 /* nto_procfs_status 'tid' field is at offset 4. Pass it back. */
10935 *tid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 4);
10936
10937 /* nto_procfs_status 'flags' field is at offset 8. */
10938 flags = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 8);
10939
10940 /* nto_procfs_status 'what' field is at offset 14. */
10941 if ((sig = bfd_get_16 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) ddata + 14)) > 0)
10942 {
10943 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = sig;
10944 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10945 }
10946
10947 /* _DEBUG_FLAG_CURTID (current thread) is 0x80. Some cores
10948 do not come from signals so we make sure we set the current
10949 thread just in case. */
10950 if (flags & 0x00000080)
10951 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = *tid;
10952
10953 /* Make a ".qnx_core_status/%d" section. */
10954 sprintf (buf, ".qnx_core_status/%ld", *tid);
10955
10956 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10957 if (name == NULL)
10958 return FALSE;
10959 strcpy (name, buf);
10960
10961 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10962 if (sect == NULL)
10963 return FALSE;
10964
10965 sect->size = note->descsz;
10966 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10967 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10968
10969 return (elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, ".qnx_core_status", sect));
10970 }
10971
10972 static bfd_boolean
10973 elfcore_grok_nto_regs (bfd *abfd,
10974 Elf_Internal_Note *note,
10975 long tid,
10976 char *base)
10977 {
10978 char buf[100];
10979 char *name;
10980 asection *sect;
10981
10982 /* Make a "(base)/%d" section. */
10983 sprintf (buf, "%s/%ld", base, tid);
10984
10985 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, strlen (buf) + 1);
10986 if (name == NULL)
10987 return FALSE;
10988 strcpy (name, buf);
10989
10990 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
10991 if (sect == NULL)
10992 return FALSE;
10993
10994 sect->size = note->descsz;
10995 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
10996 sect->alignment_power = 2;
10997
10998 /* This is the current thread. */
10999 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid == tid)
11000 return elfcore_maybe_make_sect (abfd, base, sect);
11001
11002 return TRUE;
11003 }
11004
11005 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO 7
11006 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS 8
11007 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG 9
11008 #define BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG 10
11009
11010 static bfd_boolean
11011 elfcore_grok_nto_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
11012 {
11013 /* Every GREG section has a STATUS section before it. Store the
11014 tid from the previous call to pass down to the next gregs
11015 function. */
11016 static long tid = 1;
11017
11018 switch (note->type)
11019 {
11020 case BFD_QNT_CORE_INFO:
11021 return elfcore_make_note_pseudosection (abfd, ".qnx_core_info", note);
11022 case BFD_QNT_CORE_STATUS:
11023 return elfcore_grok_nto_status (abfd, note, &tid);
11024 case BFD_QNT_CORE_GREG:
11025 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg");
11026 case BFD_QNT_CORE_FPREG:
11027 return elfcore_grok_nto_regs (abfd, note, tid, ".reg2");
11028 default:
11029 return TRUE;
11030 }
11031 }
11032
11033 static bfd_boolean
11034 elfcore_grok_spu_note (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
11035 {
11036 char *name;
11037 asection *sect;
11038 size_t len;
11039
11040 /* Use note name as section name. */
11041 len = note->namesz;
11042 name = (char *) bfd_alloc (abfd, len);
11043 if (name == NULL)
11044 return FALSE;
11045 memcpy (name, note->namedata, len);
11046 name[len - 1] = '\0';
11047
11048 sect = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, name, SEC_HAS_CONTENTS);
11049 if (sect == NULL)
11050 return FALSE;
11051
11052 sect->size = note->descsz;
11053 sect->filepos = note->descpos;
11054 sect->alignment_power = 1;
11055
11056 return TRUE;
11057 }
11058
11059 /* Function: elfcore_write_note
11060
11061 Inputs:
11062 buffer to hold note, and current size of buffer
11063 name of note
11064 type of note
11065 data for note
11066 size of data for note
11067
11068 Writes note to end of buffer. ELF64 notes are written exactly as
11069 for ELF32, despite the current (as of 2006) ELF gabi specifying
11070 that they ought to have 8-byte namesz and descsz field, and have
11071 8-byte alignment. Other writers, eg. Linux kernel, do the same.
11072
11073 Return:
11074 Pointer to realloc'd buffer, *BUFSIZ updated. */
11075
11076 char *
11077 elfcore_write_note (bfd *abfd,
11078 char *buf,
11079 int *bufsiz,
11080 const char *name,
11081 int type,
11082 const void *input,
11083 int size)
11084 {
11085 Elf_External_Note *xnp;
11086 size_t namesz;
11087 size_t newspace;
11088 char *dest;
11089
11090 namesz = 0;
11091 if (name != NULL)
11092 namesz = strlen (name) + 1;
11093
11094 newspace = 12 + ((namesz + 3) & -4) + ((size + 3) & -4);
11095
11096 buf = (char *) realloc (buf, *bufsiz + newspace);
11097 if (buf == NULL)
11098 return buf;
11099 dest = buf + *bufsiz;
11100 *bufsiz += newspace;
11101 xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) dest;
11102 H_PUT_32 (abfd, namesz, xnp->namesz);
11103 H_PUT_32 (abfd, size, xnp->descsz);
11104 H_PUT_32 (abfd, type, xnp->type);
11105 dest = xnp->name;
11106 if (name != NULL)
11107 {
11108 memcpy (dest, name, namesz);
11109 dest += namesz;
11110 while (namesz & 3)
11111 {
11112 *dest++ = '\0';
11113 ++namesz;
11114 }
11115 }
11116 memcpy (dest, input, size);
11117 dest += size;
11118 while (size & 3)
11119 {
11120 *dest++ = '\0';
11121 ++size;
11122 }
11123 return buf;
11124 }
11125
11126 /* gcc-8 warns (*) on all the strncpy calls in this function about
11127 possible string truncation. The "truncation" is not a bug. We
11128 have an external representation of structs with fields that are not
11129 necessarily NULL terminated and corresponding internal
11130 representation fields that are one larger so that they can always
11131 be NULL terminated.
11132 gcc versions between 4.2 and 4.6 do not allow pragma control of
11133 diagnostics inside functions, giving a hard error if you try to use
11134 the finer control available with later versions.
11135 gcc prior to 4.2 warns about diagnostic push and pop.
11136 gcc-5, gcc-6 and gcc-7 warn that -Wstringop-truncation is unknown,
11137 unless you also add #pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wpragma".
11138 (*) Depending on your system header files! */
11139 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
11140 # pragma GCC diagnostic push
11141 # pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Wstringop-truncation"
11142 #endif
11143 char *
11144 elfcore_write_prpsinfo (bfd *abfd,
11145 char *buf,
11146 int *bufsiz,
11147 const char *fname,
11148 const char *psargs)
11149 {
11150 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11151
11152 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
11153 {
11154 char *ret;
11155 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11156 NT_PRPSINFO, fname, psargs);
11157 if (ret != NULL)
11158 return ret;
11159 }
11160
11161 #if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
11162 # if defined (HAVE_PRPSINFO32_T) || defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
11163 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
11164 {
11165 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO32_T)
11166 psinfo32_t data;
11167 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
11168 # else
11169 prpsinfo32_t data;
11170 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
11171 # endif
11172
11173 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
11174 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
11175 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
11176 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11177 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
11178 }
11179 else
11180 # endif
11181 {
11182 # if defined (HAVE_PSINFO_T)
11183 psinfo_t data;
11184 int note_type = NT_PSINFO;
11185 # else
11186 prpsinfo_t data;
11187 int note_type = NT_PRPSINFO;
11188 # endif
11189
11190 memset (&data, 0, sizeof (data));
11191 strncpy (data.pr_fname, fname, sizeof (data.pr_fname));
11192 strncpy (data.pr_psargs, psargs, sizeof (data.pr_psargs));
11193 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11194 "CORE", note_type, &data, sizeof (data));
11195 }
11196 #endif /* PSINFO_T or PRPSINFO_T */
11197
11198 free (buf);
11199 return NULL;
11200 }
11201 #if GCC_VERSION >= 8000
11202 # pragma GCC diagnostic pop
11203 #endif
11204
11205 char *
11206 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo32
11207 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
11208 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
11209 {
11210 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16)
11211 {
11212 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16 data;
11213
11214 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
11215 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
11216 &data, sizeof (data));
11217 }
11218 else
11219 {
11220 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32 data;
11221
11222 swap_linux_prpsinfo32_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
11223 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO,
11224 &data, sizeof (data));
11225 }
11226 }
11227
11228 char *
11229 elfcore_write_linux_prpsinfo64
11230 (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
11231 const struct elf_internal_linux_prpsinfo *prpsinfo)
11232 {
11233 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16)
11234 {
11235 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16 data;
11236
11237 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid16_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
11238 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11239 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
11240 }
11241 else
11242 {
11243 struct elf_external_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32 data;
11244
11245 swap_linux_prpsinfo64_ugid32_out (abfd, prpsinfo, &data);
11246 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11247 "CORE", NT_PRPSINFO, &data, sizeof (data));
11248 }
11249 }
11250
11251 char *
11252 elfcore_write_prstatus (bfd *abfd,
11253 char *buf,
11254 int *bufsiz,
11255 long pid,
11256 int cursig,
11257 const void *gregs)
11258 {
11259 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11260
11261 if (bed->elf_backend_write_core_note != NULL)
11262 {
11263 char *ret;
11264 ret = (*bed->elf_backend_write_core_note) (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11265 NT_PRSTATUS,
11266 pid, cursig, gregs);
11267 if (ret != NULL)
11268 return ret;
11269 }
11270
11271 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS_T)
11272 #if defined (HAVE_PRSTATUS32_T)
11273 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
11274 {
11275 prstatus32_t prstat;
11276
11277 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
11278 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
11279 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
11280 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
11281 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
11282 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
11283 }
11284 else
11285 #endif
11286 {
11287 prstatus_t prstat;
11288
11289 memset (&prstat, 0, sizeof (prstat));
11290 prstat.pr_pid = pid;
11291 prstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
11292 memcpy (&prstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (prstat.pr_reg));
11293 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, "CORE",
11294 NT_PRSTATUS, &prstat, sizeof (prstat));
11295 }
11296 #endif /* HAVE_PRSTATUS_T */
11297
11298 free (buf);
11299 return NULL;
11300 }
11301
11302 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T)
11303 char *
11304 elfcore_write_lwpstatus (bfd *abfd,
11305 char *buf,
11306 int *bufsiz,
11307 long pid,
11308 int cursig,
11309 const void *gregs)
11310 {
11311 lwpstatus_t lwpstat;
11312 const char *note_name = "CORE";
11313
11314 memset (&lwpstat, 0, sizeof (lwpstat));
11315 lwpstat.pr_lwpid = pid >> 16;
11316 lwpstat.pr_cursig = cursig;
11317 #if defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_REG)
11318 memcpy (&lwpstat.pr_reg, gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_reg));
11319 #elif defined (HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T_PR_CONTEXT)
11320 #if !defined(gregs)
11321 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs,
11322 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.gregs));
11323 #else
11324 memcpy (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs,
11325 gregs, sizeof (lwpstat.pr_context.uc_mcontext.__gregs));
11326 #endif
11327 #endif
11328 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
11329 NT_LWPSTATUS, &lwpstat, sizeof (lwpstat));
11330 }
11331 #endif /* HAVE_LWPSTATUS_T */
11332
11333 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS_T)
11334 char *
11335 elfcore_write_pstatus (bfd *abfd,
11336 char *buf,
11337 int *bufsiz,
11338 long pid,
11339 int cursig ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
11340 const void *gregs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11341 {
11342 const char *note_name = "CORE";
11343 #if defined (HAVE_PSTATUS32_T)
11344 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
11345
11346 if (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS32)
11347 {
11348 pstatus32_t pstat;
11349
11350 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
11351 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
11352 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
11353 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
11354 return buf;
11355 }
11356 else
11357 #endif
11358 {
11359 pstatus_t pstat;
11360
11361 memset (&pstat, 0, sizeof (pstat));
11362 pstat.pr_pid = pid & 0xffff;
11363 buf = elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz, note_name,
11364 NT_PSTATUS, &pstat, sizeof (pstat));
11365 return buf;
11366 }
11367 }
11368 #endif /* HAVE_PSTATUS_T */
11369
11370 char *
11371 elfcore_write_prfpreg (bfd *abfd,
11372 char *buf,
11373 int *bufsiz,
11374 const void *fpregs,
11375 int size)
11376 {
11377 const char *note_name = "CORE";
11378 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11379 note_name, NT_FPREGSET, fpregs, size);
11380 }
11381
11382 char *
11383 elfcore_write_prxfpreg (bfd *abfd,
11384 char *buf,
11385 int *bufsiz,
11386 const void *xfpregs,
11387 int size)
11388 {
11389 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11390 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11391 note_name, NT_PRXFPREG, xfpregs, size);
11392 }
11393
11394 char *
11395 elfcore_write_xstatereg (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz,
11396 const void *xfpregs, int size)
11397 {
11398 char *note_name;
11399 if (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi == ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
11400 note_name = "FreeBSD";
11401 else
11402 note_name = "LINUX";
11403 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11404 note_name, NT_X86_XSTATE, xfpregs, size);
11405 }
11406
11407 char *
11408 elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (bfd *abfd,
11409 char *buf,
11410 int *bufsiz,
11411 const void *ppc_vmx,
11412 int size)
11413 {
11414 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11415 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11416 note_name, NT_PPC_VMX, ppc_vmx, size);
11417 }
11418
11419 char *
11420 elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (bfd *abfd,
11421 char *buf,
11422 int *bufsiz,
11423 const void *ppc_vsx,
11424 int size)
11425 {
11426 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11427 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11428 note_name, NT_PPC_VSX, ppc_vsx, size);
11429 }
11430
11431 char *
11432 elfcore_write_ppc_tar (bfd *abfd,
11433 char *buf,
11434 int *bufsiz,
11435 const void *ppc_tar,
11436 int size)
11437 {
11438 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11439 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11440 note_name, NT_PPC_TAR, ppc_tar, size);
11441 }
11442
11443 char *
11444 elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (bfd *abfd,
11445 char *buf,
11446 int *bufsiz,
11447 const void *ppc_ppr,
11448 int size)
11449 {
11450 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11451 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11452 note_name, NT_PPC_PPR, ppc_ppr, size);
11453 }
11454
11455 char *
11456 elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (bfd *abfd,
11457 char *buf,
11458 int *bufsiz,
11459 const void *ppc_dscr,
11460 int size)
11461 {
11462 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11463 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11464 note_name, NT_PPC_DSCR, ppc_dscr, size);
11465 }
11466
11467 char *
11468 elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (bfd *abfd,
11469 char *buf,
11470 int *bufsiz,
11471 const void *ppc_ebb,
11472 int size)
11473 {
11474 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11475 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11476 note_name, NT_PPC_EBB, ppc_ebb, size);
11477 }
11478
11479 char *
11480 elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (bfd *abfd,
11481 char *buf,
11482 int *bufsiz,
11483 const void *ppc_pmu,
11484 int size)
11485 {
11486 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11487 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11488 note_name, NT_PPC_PMU, ppc_pmu, size);
11489 }
11490
11491 char *
11492 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (bfd *abfd,
11493 char *buf,
11494 int *bufsiz,
11495 const void *ppc_tm_cgpr,
11496 int size)
11497 {
11498 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11499 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11500 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CGPR, ppc_tm_cgpr, size);
11501 }
11502
11503 char *
11504 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (bfd *abfd,
11505 char *buf,
11506 int *bufsiz,
11507 const void *ppc_tm_cfpr,
11508 int size)
11509 {
11510 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11511 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11512 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CFPR, ppc_tm_cfpr, size);
11513 }
11514
11515 char *
11516 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (bfd *abfd,
11517 char *buf,
11518 int *bufsiz,
11519 const void *ppc_tm_cvmx,
11520 int size)
11521 {
11522 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11523 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11524 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CVMX, ppc_tm_cvmx, size);
11525 }
11526
11527 char *
11528 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (bfd *abfd,
11529 char *buf,
11530 int *bufsiz,
11531 const void *ppc_tm_cvsx,
11532 int size)
11533 {
11534 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11535 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11536 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CVSX, ppc_tm_cvsx, size);
11537 }
11538
11539 char *
11540 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (bfd *abfd,
11541 char *buf,
11542 int *bufsiz,
11543 const void *ppc_tm_spr,
11544 int size)
11545 {
11546 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11547 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11548 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_SPR, ppc_tm_spr, size);
11549 }
11550
11551 char *
11552 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (bfd *abfd,
11553 char *buf,
11554 int *bufsiz,
11555 const void *ppc_tm_ctar,
11556 int size)
11557 {
11558 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11559 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11560 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CTAR, ppc_tm_ctar, size);
11561 }
11562
11563 char *
11564 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (bfd *abfd,
11565 char *buf,
11566 int *bufsiz,
11567 const void *ppc_tm_cppr,
11568 int size)
11569 {
11570 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11571 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11572 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CPPR, ppc_tm_cppr, size);
11573 }
11574
11575 char *
11576 elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (bfd *abfd,
11577 char *buf,
11578 int *bufsiz,
11579 const void *ppc_tm_cdscr,
11580 int size)
11581 {
11582 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11583 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11584 note_name, NT_PPC_TM_CDSCR, ppc_tm_cdscr, size);
11585 }
11586
11587 static char *
11588 elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (bfd *abfd,
11589 char *buf,
11590 int *bufsiz,
11591 const void *s390_high_gprs,
11592 int size)
11593 {
11594 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11595 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11596 note_name, NT_S390_HIGH_GPRS,
11597 s390_high_gprs, size);
11598 }
11599
11600 char *
11601 elfcore_write_s390_timer (bfd *abfd,
11602 char *buf,
11603 int *bufsiz,
11604 const void *s390_timer,
11605 int size)
11606 {
11607 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11608 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11609 note_name, NT_S390_TIMER, s390_timer, size);
11610 }
11611
11612 char *
11613 elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (bfd *abfd,
11614 char *buf,
11615 int *bufsiz,
11616 const void *s390_todcmp,
11617 int size)
11618 {
11619 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11620 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11621 note_name, NT_S390_TODCMP, s390_todcmp, size);
11622 }
11623
11624 char *
11625 elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (bfd *abfd,
11626 char *buf,
11627 int *bufsiz,
11628 const void *s390_todpreg,
11629 int size)
11630 {
11631 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11632 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11633 note_name, NT_S390_TODPREG, s390_todpreg, size);
11634 }
11635
11636 char *
11637 elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (bfd *abfd,
11638 char *buf,
11639 int *bufsiz,
11640 const void *s390_ctrs,
11641 int size)
11642 {
11643 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11644 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11645 note_name, NT_S390_CTRS, s390_ctrs, size);
11646 }
11647
11648 char *
11649 elfcore_write_s390_prefix (bfd *abfd,
11650 char *buf,
11651 int *bufsiz,
11652 const void *s390_prefix,
11653 int size)
11654 {
11655 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11656 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11657 note_name, NT_S390_PREFIX, s390_prefix, size);
11658 }
11659
11660 char *
11661 elfcore_write_s390_last_break (bfd *abfd,
11662 char *buf,
11663 int *bufsiz,
11664 const void *s390_last_break,
11665 int size)
11666 {
11667 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11668 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11669 note_name, NT_S390_LAST_BREAK,
11670 s390_last_break, size);
11671 }
11672
11673 char *
11674 elfcore_write_s390_system_call (bfd *abfd,
11675 char *buf,
11676 int *bufsiz,
11677 const void *s390_system_call,
11678 int size)
11679 {
11680 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11681 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11682 note_name, NT_S390_SYSTEM_CALL,
11683 s390_system_call, size);
11684 }
11685
11686 char *
11687 elfcore_write_s390_tdb (bfd *abfd,
11688 char *buf,
11689 int *bufsiz,
11690 const void *s390_tdb,
11691 int size)
11692 {
11693 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11694 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11695 note_name, NT_S390_TDB, s390_tdb, size);
11696 }
11697
11698 char *
11699 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (bfd *abfd,
11700 char *buf,
11701 int *bufsiz,
11702 const void *s390_vxrs_low,
11703 int size)
11704 {
11705 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11706 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11707 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_LOW, s390_vxrs_low, size);
11708 }
11709
11710 char *
11711 elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (bfd *abfd,
11712 char *buf,
11713 int *bufsiz,
11714 const void *s390_vxrs_high,
11715 int size)
11716 {
11717 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11718 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11719 note_name, NT_S390_VXRS_HIGH,
11720 s390_vxrs_high, size);
11721 }
11722
11723 char *
11724 elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (bfd *abfd,
11725 char *buf,
11726 int *bufsiz,
11727 const void *s390_gs_cb,
11728 int size)
11729 {
11730 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11731 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11732 note_name, NT_S390_GS_CB,
11733 s390_gs_cb, size);
11734 }
11735
11736 char *
11737 elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (bfd *abfd,
11738 char *buf,
11739 int *bufsiz,
11740 const void *s390_gs_bc,
11741 int size)
11742 {
11743 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11744 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11745 note_name, NT_S390_GS_BC,
11746 s390_gs_bc, size);
11747 }
11748
11749 char *
11750 elfcore_write_arm_vfp (bfd *abfd,
11751 char *buf,
11752 int *bufsiz,
11753 const void *arm_vfp,
11754 int size)
11755 {
11756 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11757 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11758 note_name, NT_ARM_VFP, arm_vfp, size);
11759 }
11760
11761 char *
11762 elfcore_write_aarch_tls (bfd *abfd,
11763 char *buf,
11764 int *bufsiz,
11765 const void *aarch_tls,
11766 int size)
11767 {
11768 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11769 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11770 note_name, NT_ARM_TLS, aarch_tls, size);
11771 }
11772
11773 char *
11774 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (bfd *abfd,
11775 char *buf,
11776 int *bufsiz,
11777 const void *aarch_hw_break,
11778 int size)
11779 {
11780 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11781 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11782 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_BREAK, aarch_hw_break, size);
11783 }
11784
11785 char *
11786 elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (bfd *abfd,
11787 char *buf,
11788 int *bufsiz,
11789 const void *aarch_hw_watch,
11790 int size)
11791 {
11792 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11793 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11794 note_name, NT_ARM_HW_WATCH, aarch_hw_watch, size);
11795 }
11796
11797 char *
11798 elfcore_write_aarch_sve (bfd *abfd,
11799 char *buf,
11800 int *bufsiz,
11801 const void *aarch_sve,
11802 int size)
11803 {
11804 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11805 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11806 note_name, NT_ARM_SVE, aarch_sve, size);
11807 }
11808
11809 char *
11810 elfcore_write_aarch_pauth (bfd *abfd,
11811 char *buf,
11812 int *bufsiz,
11813 const void *aarch_pauth,
11814 int size)
11815 {
11816 char *note_name = "LINUX";
11817 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
11818 note_name, NT_ARM_PAC_MASK, aarch_pauth, size);
11819 }
11820
11821 char *
11822 elfcore_write_register_note (bfd *abfd,
11823 char *buf,
11824 int *bufsiz,
11825 const char *section,
11826 const void *data,
11827 int size)
11828 {
11829 if (strcmp (section, ".reg2") == 0)
11830 return elfcore_write_prfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11831 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xfp") == 0)
11832 return elfcore_write_prxfpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11833 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-xstate") == 0)
11834 return elfcore_write_xstatereg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11835 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vmx") == 0)
11836 return elfcore_write_ppc_vmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11837 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-vsx") == 0)
11838 return elfcore_write_ppc_vsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11839 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tar") == 0)
11840 return elfcore_write_ppc_tar (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11841 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-ppr") == 0)
11842 return elfcore_write_ppc_ppr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11843 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-dscr") == 0)
11844 return elfcore_write_ppc_dscr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11845 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-ebb") == 0)
11846 return elfcore_write_ppc_ebb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11847 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-pmu") == 0)
11848 return elfcore_write_ppc_pmu (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11849 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cgpr") == 0)
11850 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cgpr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11851 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cfpr") == 0)
11852 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cfpr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11853 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvmx") == 0)
11854 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvmx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11855 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cvsx") == 0)
11856 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cvsx (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11857 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-spr") == 0)
11858 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_spr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11859 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-ctar") == 0)
11860 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_ctar (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11861 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cppr") == 0)
11862 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cppr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11863 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-ppc-tm-cdscr") == 0)
11864 return elfcore_write_ppc_tm_cdscr (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11865 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-high-gprs") == 0)
11866 return elfcore_write_s390_high_gprs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11867 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-timer") == 0)
11868 return elfcore_write_s390_timer (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11869 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todcmp") == 0)
11870 return elfcore_write_s390_todcmp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11871 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-todpreg") == 0)
11872 return elfcore_write_s390_todpreg (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11873 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-ctrs") == 0)
11874 return elfcore_write_s390_ctrs (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11875 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-prefix") == 0)
11876 return elfcore_write_s390_prefix (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11877 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-last-break") == 0)
11878 return elfcore_write_s390_last_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11879 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-system-call") == 0)
11880 return elfcore_write_s390_system_call (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11881 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-tdb") == 0)
11882 return elfcore_write_s390_tdb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11883 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-low") == 0)
11884 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_low (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11885 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-vxrs-high") == 0)
11886 return elfcore_write_s390_vxrs_high (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11887 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-cb") == 0)
11888 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_cb (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11889 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-s390-gs-bc") == 0)
11890 return elfcore_write_s390_gs_bc (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11891 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-arm-vfp") == 0)
11892 return elfcore_write_arm_vfp (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11893 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-tls") == 0)
11894 return elfcore_write_aarch_tls (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11895 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-break") == 0)
11896 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_break (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11897 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-hw-watch") == 0)
11898 return elfcore_write_aarch_hw_watch (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11899 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-sve") == 0)
11900 return elfcore_write_aarch_sve (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11901 if (strcmp (section, ".reg-aarch-pauth") == 0)
11902 return elfcore_write_aarch_pauth (abfd, buf, bufsiz, data, size);
11903 return NULL;
11904 }
11905
11906 static bfd_boolean
11907 elf_parse_notes (bfd *abfd, char *buf, size_t size, file_ptr offset,
11908 size_t align)
11909 {
11910 char *p;
11911
11912 /* NB: CORE PT_NOTE segments may have p_align values of 0 or 1.
11913 gABI specifies that PT_NOTE alignment should be aligned to 4
11914 bytes for 32-bit objects and to 8 bytes for 64-bit objects. If
11915 align is less than 4, we use 4 byte alignment. */
11916 if (align < 4)
11917 align = 4;
11918 if (align != 4 && align != 8)
11919 return FALSE;
11920
11921 p = buf;
11922 while (p < buf + size)
11923 {
11924 Elf_External_Note *xnp = (Elf_External_Note *) p;
11925 Elf_Internal_Note in;
11926
11927 if (offsetof (Elf_External_Note, name) > buf - p + size)
11928 return FALSE;
11929
11930 in.type = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->type);
11931
11932 in.namesz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->namesz);
11933 in.namedata = xnp->name;
11934 if (in.namesz > buf - in.namedata + size)
11935 return FALSE;
11936
11937 in.descsz = H_GET_32 (abfd, xnp->descsz);
11938 in.descdata = p + ELF_NOTE_DESC_OFFSET (in.namesz, align);
11939 in.descpos = offset + (in.descdata - buf);
11940 if (in.descsz != 0
11941 && (in.descdata >= buf + size
11942 || in.descsz > buf - in.descdata + size))
11943 return FALSE;
11944
11945 switch (bfd_get_format (abfd))
11946 {
11947 default:
11948 return TRUE;
11949
11950 case bfd_core:
11951 {
11952 #define GROKER_ELEMENT(S,F) {S, sizeof (S) - 1, F}
11953 struct
11954 {
11955 const char * string;
11956 size_t len;
11957 bfd_boolean (* func)(bfd *, Elf_Internal_Note *);
11958 }
11959 grokers[] =
11960 {
11961 GROKER_ELEMENT ("", elfcore_grok_note),
11962 GROKER_ELEMENT ("FreeBSD", elfcore_grok_freebsd_note),
11963 GROKER_ELEMENT ("NetBSD-CORE", elfcore_grok_netbsd_note),
11964 GROKER_ELEMENT ( "OpenBSD", elfcore_grok_openbsd_note),
11965 GROKER_ELEMENT ("QNX", elfcore_grok_nto_note),
11966 GROKER_ELEMENT ("SPU/", elfcore_grok_spu_note),
11967 GROKER_ELEMENT ("GNU", elfobj_grok_gnu_note)
11968 };
11969 #undef GROKER_ELEMENT
11970 int i;
11971
11972 for (i = ARRAY_SIZE (grokers); i--;)
11973 {
11974 if (in.namesz >= grokers[i].len
11975 && strncmp (in.namedata, grokers[i].string,
11976 grokers[i].len) == 0)
11977 {
11978 if (! grokers[i].func (abfd, & in))
11979 return FALSE;
11980 break;
11981 }
11982 }
11983 break;
11984 }
11985
11986 case bfd_object:
11987 if (in.namesz == sizeof "GNU" && strcmp (in.namedata, "GNU") == 0)
11988 {
11989 if (! elfobj_grok_gnu_note (abfd, &in))
11990 return FALSE;
11991 }
11992 else if (in.namesz == sizeof "stapsdt"
11993 && strcmp (in.namedata, "stapsdt") == 0)
11994 {
11995 if (! elfobj_grok_stapsdt_note (abfd, &in))
11996 return FALSE;
11997 }
11998 break;
11999 }
12000
12001 p += ELF_NOTE_NEXT_OFFSET (in.namesz, in.descsz, align);
12002 }
12003
12004 return TRUE;
12005 }
12006
12007 bfd_boolean
12008 elf_read_notes (bfd *abfd, file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type size,
12009 size_t align)
12010 {
12011 char *buf;
12012
12013 if (size == 0 || (size + 1) == 0)
12014 return TRUE;
12015
12016 if (bfd_seek (abfd, offset, SEEK_SET) != 0)
12017 return FALSE;
12018
12019 buf = (char *) _bfd_malloc_and_read (abfd, size + 1, size);
12020 if (buf == NULL)
12021 return FALSE;
12022
12023 /* PR 17512: file: ec08f814
12024 0-termintate the buffer so that string searches will not overflow. */
12025 buf[size] = 0;
12026
12027 if (!elf_parse_notes (abfd, buf, size, offset, align))
12028 {
12029 free (buf);
12030 return FALSE;
12031 }
12032
12033 free (buf);
12034 return TRUE;
12035 }
12036 \f
12037 /* Providing external access to the ELF program header table. */
12038
12039 /* Return an upper bound on the number of bytes required to store a
12040 copy of ABFD's program header table entries. Return -1 if an error
12041 occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
12042
12043 long
12044 bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound (bfd *abfd)
12045 {
12046 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
12047 {
12048 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
12049 return -1;
12050 }
12051
12052 return elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr);
12053 }
12054
12055 /* Copy ABFD's program header table entries to *PHDRS. The entries
12056 will be stored as an array of Elf_Internal_Phdr structures, as
12057 defined in include/elf/internal.h. To find out how large the
12058 buffer needs to be, call bfd_get_elf_phdr_upper_bound.
12059
12060 Return the number of program header table entries read, or -1 if an
12061 error occurs; bfd_get_error will return an appropriate code. */
12062
12063 int
12064 bfd_get_elf_phdrs (bfd *abfd, void *phdrs)
12065 {
12066 int num_phdrs;
12067
12068 if (abfd->xvec->flavour != bfd_target_elf_flavour)
12069 {
12070 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
12071 return -1;
12072 }
12073
12074 num_phdrs = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_phnum;
12075 if (num_phdrs != 0)
12076 memcpy (phdrs, elf_tdata (abfd)->phdr,
12077 num_phdrs * sizeof (Elf_Internal_Phdr));
12078
12079 return num_phdrs;
12080 }
12081
12082 enum elf_reloc_type_class
12083 _bfd_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12084 const asection *rel_sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12085 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12086 {
12087 return reloc_class_normal;
12088 }
12089
12090 /* For RELA architectures, return the relocation value for a
12091 relocation against a local symbol. */
12092
12093 bfd_vma
12094 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
12095 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
12096 asection **psec,
12097 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
12098 {
12099 asection *sec = *psec;
12100 bfd_vma relocation;
12101
12102 relocation = (sec->output_section->vma
12103 + sec->output_offset
12104 + sym->st_value);
12105 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
12106 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION
12107 && sec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
12108 {
12109 rel->r_addend =
12110 _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
12111 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
12112 sym->st_value + rel->r_addend);
12113 if (sec != *psec)
12114 {
12115 /* If we have changed the section, and our original section is
12116 marked with SEC_EXCLUDE, it means that the original
12117 SEC_MERGE section has been completely subsumed in some
12118 other SEC_MERGE section. In this case, we need to leave
12119 some info around for --emit-relocs. */
12120 if ((sec->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) != 0)
12121 sec->kept_section = *psec;
12122 sec = *psec;
12123 }
12124 rel->r_addend -= relocation;
12125 rel->r_addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
12126 }
12127 return relocation;
12128 }
12129
12130 bfd_vma
12131 _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (bfd *abfd,
12132 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
12133 asection **psec,
12134 bfd_vma addend)
12135 {
12136 asection *sec = *psec;
12137
12138 if (sec->sec_info_type != SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
12139 return sym->st_value + addend;
12140
12141 return _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, psec,
12142 elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
12143 sym->st_value + addend);
12144 }
12145
12146 /* Adjust an address within a section. Given OFFSET within SEC, return
12147 the new offset within the section, based upon changes made to the
12148 section. Returns -1 if the offset is now invalid.
12149 The offset (in abnd out) is in target sized bytes, however big a
12150 byte may be. */
12151
12152 bfd_vma
12153 _bfd_elf_section_offset (bfd *abfd,
12154 struct bfd_link_info *info,
12155 asection *sec,
12156 bfd_vma offset)
12157 {
12158 switch (sec->sec_info_type)
12159 {
12160 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_STABS:
12161 return _bfd_stab_section_offset (sec, elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info,
12162 offset);
12163 case SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME:
12164 return _bfd_elf_eh_frame_section_offset (abfd, info, sec, offset);
12165
12166 default:
12167 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ELF_REVERSE_COPY) != 0)
12168 {
12169 /* Reverse the offset. */
12170 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
12171 bfd_size_type address_size = bed->s->arch_size / 8;
12172
12173 /* address_size and sec->size are in octets. Convert
12174 to bytes before subtracting the original offset. */
12175 offset = ((sec->size - address_size)
12176 / bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd, sec) - offset);
12177 }
12178 return offset;
12179 }
12180 }
12181 \f
12182 /* Create a new BFD as if by bfd_openr. Rather than opening a file,
12183 reconstruct an ELF file by reading the segments out of remote memory
12184 based on the ELF file header at EHDR_VMA and the ELF program headers it
12185 points to. If not null, *LOADBASEP is filled in with the difference
12186 between the VMAs from which the segments were read, and the VMAs the
12187 file headers (and hence BFD's idea of each section's VMA) put them at.
12188
12189 The function TARGET_READ_MEMORY is called to copy LEN bytes from the
12190 remote memory at target address VMA into the local buffer at MYADDR; it
12191 should return zero on success or an `errno' code on failure. TEMPL must
12192 be a BFD for an ELF target with the word size and byte order found in
12193 the remote memory. */
12194
12195 bfd *
12196 bfd_elf_bfd_from_remote_memory
12197 (bfd *templ,
12198 bfd_vma ehdr_vma,
12199 bfd_size_type size,
12200 bfd_vma *loadbasep,
12201 int (*target_read_memory) (bfd_vma, bfd_byte *, bfd_size_type))
12202 {
12203 return (*get_elf_backend_data (templ)->elf_backend_bfd_from_remote_memory)
12204 (templ, ehdr_vma, size, loadbasep, target_read_memory);
12205 }
12206 \f
12207 long
12208 _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
12209 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12210 asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12211 long dynsymcount,
12212 asymbol **dynsyms,
12213 asymbol **ret)
12214 {
12215 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
12216 asection *relplt;
12217 asymbol *s;
12218 const char *relplt_name;
12219 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
12220 arelent *p;
12221 long count, i, n;
12222 size_t size;
12223 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
12224 char *names;
12225 asection *plt;
12226
12227 *ret = NULL;
12228
12229 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
12230 return 0;
12231
12232 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
12233 return 0;
12234
12235 if (!bed->plt_sym_val)
12236 return 0;
12237
12238 relplt_name = bed->relplt_name;
12239 if (relplt_name == NULL)
12240 relplt_name = bed->rela_plts_and_copies_p ? ".rela.plt" : ".rel.plt";
12241 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, relplt_name);
12242 if (relplt == NULL)
12243 return 0;
12244
12245 hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
12246 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd)
12247 || (hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL && hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA))
12248 return 0;
12249
12250 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
12251 if (plt == NULL)
12252 return 0;
12253
12254 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
12255 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
12256 return -1;
12257
12258 count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
12259 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
12260 p = relplt->relocation;
12261 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
12262 {
12263 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
12264 if (p->addend != 0)
12265 {
12266 #ifdef BFD64
12267 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8 + 8 * (bed->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64);
12268 #else
12269 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
12270 #endif
12271 }
12272 }
12273
12274 s = *ret = (asymbol *) bfd_malloc (size);
12275 if (s == NULL)
12276 return -1;
12277
12278 names = (char *) (s + count);
12279 p = relplt->relocation;
12280 n = 0;
12281 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
12282 {
12283 size_t len;
12284 bfd_vma addr;
12285
12286 addr = bed->plt_sym_val (i, plt, p);
12287 if (addr == (bfd_vma) -1)
12288 continue;
12289
12290 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
12291 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
12292 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
12293 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
12294 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
12295 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
12296 s->section = plt;
12297 s->value = addr - plt->vma;
12298 s->name = names;
12299 s->udata.p = NULL;
12300 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
12301 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
12302 names += len;
12303 if (p->addend != 0)
12304 {
12305 char buf[30], *a;
12306
12307 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
12308 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
12309 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, buf, p->addend);
12310 for (a = buf; *a == '0'; ++a)
12311 ;
12312 len = strlen (a);
12313 memcpy (names, a, len);
12314 names += len;
12315 }
12316 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
12317 names += sizeof ("@plt");
12318 ++s, ++n;
12319 }
12320
12321 return n;
12322 }
12323
12324 /* It is only used by x86-64 so far.
12325 ??? This repeats *COM* id of zero. sec->id is supposed to be unique,
12326 but current usage would allow all of _bfd_std_section to be zero. */
12327 static const asymbol lcomm_sym
12328 = GLOBAL_SYM_INIT ("LARGE_COMMON", &_bfd_elf_large_com_section);
12329 asection _bfd_elf_large_com_section
12330 = BFD_FAKE_SECTION (_bfd_elf_large_com_section, &lcomm_sym,
12331 "LARGE_COMMON", 0, SEC_IS_COMMON);
12332
12333 bfd_boolean
12334 _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
12335 {
12336 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp; /* ELF file header, internal form. */
12337
12338 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
12339
12340 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE)
12341 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_osabi;
12342
12343 /* Set the osabi field to ELFOSABI_GNU if the binary contains
12344 SHF_GNU_MBIND sections or symbols of STT_GNU_IFUNC type or
12345 STB_GNU_UNIQUE binding. */
12346 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi != 0)
12347 {
12348 if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] == ELFOSABI_NONE)
12349 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] = ELFOSABI_GNU;
12350 else if (i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] != ELFOSABI_GNU
12351 && i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_OSABI] != ELFOSABI_FREEBSD)
12352 {
12353 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_mbind)
12354 _bfd_error_handler (_("GNU_MBIND section is unsupported"));
12355 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_ifunc)
12356 _bfd_error_handler (_("symbol type STT_GNU_IFUNC is unsupported"));
12357 if (elf_tdata (abfd)->has_gnu_osabi & elf_gnu_osabi_unique)
12358 _bfd_error_handler (_("symbol binding STB_GNU_UNIQUE is unsupported"));
12359 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_sorry);
12360 return FALSE;
12361 }
12362 }
12363 return TRUE;
12364 }
12365
12366
12367 /* Return TRUE for ELF symbol types that represent functions.
12368 This is the default version of this function, which is sufficient for
12369 most targets. It returns true if TYPE is STT_FUNC or STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
12370
12371 bfd_boolean
12372 _bfd_elf_is_function_type (unsigned int type)
12373 {
12374 return (type == STT_FUNC
12375 || type == STT_GNU_IFUNC);
12376 }
12377
12378 /* If the ELF symbol SYM might be a function in SEC, return the
12379 function size and set *CODE_OFF to the function's entry point,
12380 otherwise return zero. */
12381
12382 bfd_size_type
12383 _bfd_elf_maybe_function_sym (const asymbol *sym, asection *sec,
12384 bfd_vma *code_off)
12385 {
12386 bfd_size_type size;
12387
12388 if ((sym->flags & (BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_FILE | BSF_OBJECT
12389 | BSF_THREAD_LOCAL | BSF_RELC | BSF_SRELC)) != 0
12390 || sym->section != sec)
12391 return 0;
12392
12393 *code_off = sym->value;
12394 size = 0;
12395 if (!(sym->flags & BSF_SYNTHETIC))
12396 size = ((elf_symbol_type *) sym)->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
12397 if (size == 0)
12398 size = 1;
12399 return size;
12400 }
12401
12402 /* Set to non-zero to enable some debug messages. */
12403 #define DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS 0
12404
12405 /* An internal-to-the-bfd-library only section type
12406 used to indicate a cached secondary reloc section. */
12407 #define SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC (SHT_LOOS + SHT_RELA)
12408
12409 /* Create a BFD section to hold a secondary reloc section. */
12410
12411 bfd_boolean
12412 _bfd_elf_init_secondary_reloc_section (bfd * abfd,
12413 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
12414 const char * name,
12415 unsigned int shindex)
12416 {
12417 /* We only support RELA secondary relocs. */
12418 if (hdr->sh_type != SHT_RELA)
12419 return FALSE;
12420
12421 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12422 fprintf (stderr, "secondary reloc section %s encountered\n", name);
12423 #endif
12424 hdr->sh_type = SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC;
12425 return _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex);
12426 }
12427
12428 /* Read in any secondary relocs associated with SEC. */
12429
12430 bfd_boolean
12431 _bfd_elf_slurp_secondary_reloc_section (bfd * abfd,
12432 asection * sec,
12433 asymbol ** symbols)
12434 {
12435 const struct elf_backend_data * const ebd = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
12436 asection * relsec;
12437 bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
12438 bfd_vma (*r_sym) (bfd_vma);
12439
12440 #if BFD_DEFAULT_TARGET_SIZE > 32
12441 if (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) != 32)
12442 r_sym = elf64_r_sym;
12443 else
12444 #endif
12445 r_sym = elf32_r_sym;
12446
12447 /* Discover if there are any secondary reloc sections
12448 associated with SEC. */
12449 for (relsec = abfd->sections; relsec != NULL; relsec = relsec->next)
12450 {
12451 Elf_Internal_Shdr * hdr = & elf_section_data (relsec)->this_hdr;
12452
12453 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC
12454 && hdr->sh_info == (unsigned) elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx)
12455 {
12456 bfd_byte * native_relocs;
12457 bfd_byte * native_reloc;
12458 arelent * internal_relocs;
12459 arelent * internal_reloc;
12460 unsigned int i;
12461 unsigned int entsize;
12462 unsigned int symcount;
12463 unsigned int reloc_count;
12464 size_t amt;
12465
12466 if (ebd->elf_info_to_howto == NULL)
12467 return FALSE;
12468
12469 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12470 fprintf (stderr, "read secondary relocs for %s from %s\n",
12471 sec->name, relsec->name);
12472 #endif
12473 entsize = hdr->sh_entsize;
12474
12475 native_relocs = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
12476 if (native_relocs == NULL)
12477 {
12478 result = FALSE;
12479 continue;
12480 }
12481
12482 reloc_count = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (hdr);
12483 if (_bfd_mul_overflow (reloc_count, sizeof (arelent), & amt))
12484 {
12485 free (native_relocs);
12486 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_file_too_big);
12487 result = FALSE;
12488 continue;
12489 }
12490
12491 internal_relocs = (arelent *) bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
12492 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
12493 {
12494 free (native_relocs);
12495 result = FALSE;
12496 continue;
12497 }
12498
12499 if (bfd_seek (abfd, hdr->sh_offset, SEEK_SET) != 0
12500 || (bfd_bread (native_relocs, hdr->sh_size, abfd)
12501 != hdr->sh_size))
12502 {
12503 free (native_relocs);
12504 /* The internal_relocs will be freed when
12505 the memory for the bfd is released. */
12506 result = FALSE;
12507 continue;
12508 }
12509
12510 symcount = bfd_get_symcount (abfd);
12511
12512 for (i = 0, internal_reloc = internal_relocs,
12513 native_reloc = native_relocs;
12514 i < reloc_count;
12515 i++, internal_reloc++, native_reloc += entsize)
12516 {
12517 bfd_boolean res;
12518 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
12519
12520 ebd->s->swap_reloca_in (abfd, native_reloc, & rela);
12521
12522 /* The address of an ELF reloc is section relative for an object
12523 file, and absolute for an executable file or shared library.
12524 The address of a normal BFD reloc is always section relative,
12525 and the address of a dynamic reloc is absolute.. */
12526 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) == 0)
12527 internal_reloc->address = rela.r_offset;
12528 else
12529 internal_reloc->address = rela.r_offset - sec->vma;
12530
12531 if (r_sym (rela.r_info) == STN_UNDEF)
12532 {
12533 /* FIXME: This and the error case below mean that we
12534 have a symbol on relocs that is not elf_symbol_type. */
12535 internal_reloc->sym_ptr_ptr =
12536 bfd_abs_section_ptr->symbol_ptr_ptr;
12537 }
12538 else if (r_sym (rela.r_info) > symcount)
12539 {
12540 _bfd_error_handler
12541 /* xgettext:c-format */
12542 (_("%pB(%pA): relocation %d has invalid symbol index %ld"),
12543 abfd, sec, i, (long) r_sym (rela.r_info));
12544 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12545 internal_reloc->sym_ptr_ptr =
12546 bfd_abs_section_ptr->symbol_ptr_ptr;
12547 result = FALSE;
12548 }
12549 else
12550 {
12551 asymbol **ps;
12552
12553 ps = symbols + r_sym (rela.r_info) - 1;
12554
12555 internal_reloc->sym_ptr_ptr = ps;
12556 /* Make sure that this symbol is not removed by strip. */
12557 (*ps)->flags |= BSF_KEEP;
12558 }
12559
12560 internal_reloc->addend = rela.r_addend;
12561
12562 res = ebd->elf_info_to_howto (abfd, internal_reloc, & rela);
12563 if (! res || internal_reloc->howto == NULL)
12564 {
12565 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12566 fprintf (stderr, "there is no howto associated with reloc %lx\n",
12567 rela.r_info);
12568 #endif
12569 result = FALSE;
12570 }
12571 }
12572
12573 free (native_relocs);
12574 /* Store the internal relocs. */
12575 elf_section_data (relsec)->sec_info = internal_relocs;
12576 }
12577 }
12578
12579 return result;
12580 }
12581
12582 /* Set the ELF section header fields of an output secondary reloc section. */
12583
12584 bfd_boolean
12585 _bfd_elf_copy_special_section_fields (const bfd * ibfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12586 bfd * obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12587 const Elf_Internal_Shdr * isection,
12588 Elf_Internal_Shdr * osection)
12589 {
12590 asection * isec;
12591 asection * osec;
12592
12593 if (isection == NULL)
12594 return FALSE;
12595
12596 if (isection->sh_type != SHT_SECONDARY_RELOC)
12597 return TRUE;
12598
12599 isec = isection->bfd_section;
12600 if (isec == NULL)
12601 return FALSE;
12602
12603 osec = osection->bfd_section;
12604 if (osec == NULL)
12605 return FALSE;
12606
12607 BFD_ASSERT (elf_section_data (osec)->sec_info == NULL);
12608 elf_section_data (osec)->sec_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
12609 osection->sh_type = SHT_RELA;
12610 osection->sh_link = elf_onesymtab (obfd);
12611 if (osection->sh_link == 0)
12612 {
12613 /* There is no symbol table - we are hosed... */
12614 _bfd_error_handler
12615 /* xgettext:c-format */
12616 (_("%pB(%pA): link section cannot be set because the output file does not have a symbol table"),
12617 obfd, osec);
12618 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12619 return FALSE;
12620 }
12621
12622 /* Find the output section that corresponds to the isection's sh_info link. */
12623 if (isection->sh_info == 0
12624 || isection->sh_info >= elf_numsections (ibfd))
12625 {
12626 _bfd_error_handler
12627 /* xgettext:c-format */
12628 (_("%pB(%pA): info section index is invalid"),
12629 obfd, osec);
12630 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12631 return FALSE;
12632 }
12633
12634 isection = elf_elfsections (ibfd)[isection->sh_info];
12635
12636 if (isection == NULL
12637 || isection->bfd_section == NULL
12638 || isection->bfd_section->output_section == NULL)
12639 {
12640 _bfd_error_handler
12641 /* xgettext:c-format */
12642 (_("%pB(%pA): info section index cannot be set because the section is not in the output"),
12643 obfd, osec);
12644 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12645 return FALSE;
12646 }
12647
12648 osection->sh_info =
12649 elf_section_data (isection->bfd_section->output_section)->this_idx;
12650
12651 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12652 fprintf (stderr, "update header of %s, sh_link = %u, sh_info = %u\n",
12653 osec->name, osection->sh_link, osection->sh_info);
12654 #endif
12655
12656 return TRUE;
12657 }
12658
12659 /* Write out a secondary reloc section. */
12660
12661 bfd_boolean
12662 _bfd_elf_write_secondary_reloc_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
12663 {
12664 const struct elf_backend_data * const ebd = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
12665 bfd_vma addr_offset;
12666 asection * relsec;
12667 bfd_vma (*r_info) (bfd_vma, bfd_vma);
12668 bfd_boolean result = TRUE;
12669
12670 if (sec == NULL)
12671 return FALSE;
12672
12673 #if BFD_DEFAULT_TARGET_SIZE > 32
12674 if (bfd_arch_bits_per_address (abfd) != 32)
12675 r_info = elf64_r_info;
12676 else
12677 #endif
12678 r_info = elf32_r_info;
12679
12680 /* The address of an ELF reloc is section relative for an object
12681 file, and absolute for an executable file or shared library.
12682 The address of a BFD reloc is always section relative. */
12683 addr_offset = 0;
12684 if ((abfd->flags & (EXEC_P | DYNAMIC)) != 0)
12685 addr_offset = sec->vma;
12686
12687 /* Discover if there are any secondary reloc sections
12688 associated with SEC. */
12689 for (relsec = abfd->sections; relsec != NULL; relsec = relsec->next)
12690 {
12691 const struct bfd_elf_section_data * const esd = elf_section_data (relsec);
12692 Elf_Internal_Shdr * const hdr = (Elf_Internal_Shdr *) & esd->this_hdr;
12693
12694 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_RELA
12695 && hdr->sh_info == (unsigned) elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx)
12696 {
12697 asymbol * last_sym;
12698 int last_sym_idx;
12699 unsigned int reloc_count;
12700 unsigned int idx;
12701 arelent * src_irel;
12702 bfd_byte * dst_rela;
12703
12704 if (hdr->contents != NULL)
12705 {
12706 _bfd_error_handler
12707 /* xgettext:c-format */
12708 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc section processed twice"),
12709 abfd, relsec);
12710 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12711 result = FALSE;
12712 continue;
12713 }
12714
12715 reloc_count = hdr->sh_size / hdr->sh_entsize;
12716 if (reloc_count <= 0)
12717 {
12718 _bfd_error_handler
12719 /* xgettext:c-format */
12720 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc section is empty!"),
12721 abfd, relsec);
12722 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12723 result = FALSE;
12724 continue;
12725 }
12726
12727 hdr->contents = bfd_alloc (abfd, hdr->sh_size);
12728 if (hdr->contents == NULL)
12729 continue;
12730
12731 #if DEBUG_SECONDARY_RELOCS
12732 fprintf (stderr, "write %u secondary relocs for %s from %s\n",
12733 reloc_count, sec->name, relsec->name);
12734 #endif
12735 last_sym = NULL;
12736 last_sym_idx = 0;
12737 dst_rela = hdr->contents;
12738 src_irel = (arelent *) esd->sec_info;
12739 if (src_irel == NULL)
12740 {
12741 _bfd_error_handler
12742 /* xgettext:c-format */
12743 (_("%pB(%pA): error: internal relocs missing for secondary reloc section"),
12744 abfd, relsec);
12745 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12746 result = FALSE;
12747 continue;
12748 }
12749
12750 for (idx = 0; idx < reloc_count; idx++, dst_rela += hdr->sh_entsize)
12751 {
12752 Elf_Internal_Rela src_rela;
12753 arelent *ptr;
12754 asymbol *sym;
12755 int n;
12756
12757 ptr = src_irel + idx;
12758 if (ptr == NULL)
12759 {
12760 _bfd_error_handler
12761 /* xgettext:c-format */
12762 (_("%pB(%pA): error: reloc table entry %u is empty"),
12763 abfd, relsec, idx);
12764 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12765 result = FALSE;
12766 break;
12767 }
12768
12769 if (ptr->sym_ptr_ptr == NULL)
12770 {
12771 /* FIXME: Is this an error ? */
12772 n = 0;
12773 }
12774 else
12775 {
12776 sym = *ptr->sym_ptr_ptr;
12777
12778 if (sym == last_sym)
12779 n = last_sym_idx;
12780 else
12781 {
12782 n = _bfd_elf_symbol_from_bfd_symbol (abfd, & sym);
12783 if (n < 0)
12784 {
12785 _bfd_error_handler
12786 /* xgettext:c-format */
12787 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc %u references a missing symbol"),
12788 abfd, relsec, idx);
12789 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12790 result = FALSE;
12791 n = 0;
12792 }
12793
12794 last_sym = sym;
12795 last_sym_idx = n;
12796 }
12797
12798 if (sym->the_bfd != NULL
12799 && sym->the_bfd->xvec != abfd->xvec
12800 && ! _bfd_elf_validate_reloc (abfd, ptr))
12801 {
12802 _bfd_error_handler
12803 /* xgettext:c-format */
12804 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc %u references a deleted symbol"),
12805 abfd, relsec, idx);
12806 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12807 result = FALSE;
12808 n = 0;
12809 }
12810 }
12811
12812 src_rela.r_offset = ptr->address + addr_offset;
12813 if (ptr->howto == NULL)
12814 {
12815 _bfd_error_handler
12816 /* xgettext:c-format */
12817 (_("%pB(%pA): error: secondary reloc %u is of an unknown type"),
12818 abfd, relsec, idx);
12819 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
12820 result = FALSE;
12821 src_rela.r_info = r_info (0, 0);
12822 }
12823 else
12824 src_rela.r_info = r_info (n, ptr->howto->type);
12825 src_rela.r_addend = ptr->addend;
12826 ebd->s->swap_reloca_out (abfd, &src_rela, dst_rela);
12827 }
12828 }
12829 }
12830
12831 return result;
12832 }
This page took 0.313682 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.